MA 1595 1 Series Owner's Manual (EO1 11152D) (ma1595om) November 2005 Owners
User Manual: MA-1595-1
Open the PDF directly: View PDF .
Page Count: 236
Download | |
Open PDF In Browser | View PDF |
TEC Electronic Cash Register MA-1595-1 SERIES Owner's Manual “This Class A digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian InterferenceCausing Equipment Regulations.” “Cet appareil numérique de la classe A respecte toutes les exigences du Règlement sur le matériel brouilleur du Canada.” FCC Notice This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference in which case the user will be required to correct the interference at his own expense. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by manufacturer for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. CAUTION! 1. This manual may not be copied in whole or in part without prior written permission of TOSHIBA TEC. 2. The contents of this manual may be changed without notification. 3. Please refer to your local Authorised Service representative with regard to any queries you may have in this manual. Copyright © 2003 by TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION All Rights Reserved 570 Ohito, Izunokuni-shi, Shizuoka-ken, JAPAN Safety Summary EO1-11152 6DIHW\6XPPDU\ Personal safety in handling or maintaining the equipment is extremely important. Warnings and Cautions necessary for safe handling are included in this manual. All warnings and cautions contained in this manual should be read and understood before handling or maintaining the equipment. Do not attempt to effect repairs or modifications to this equipment. If a fault occurs that cannot be rectified using the procedures described in this manual, turn off the power, unplug the machine, then contact your authorized TOSHIBA TEC representative for assistance. 0HDQLQJVRI(DFK6\PERO This symbol indicates warning items (including cautions). Specific warning contents are drawn inside the symbol. (The symbol on the left indicates a general caution.) This symbol indicates prohibited actions (prohibited items). Specific prohibited contents are drawn inside or near the symbol. (The symbol on the left indicates “no disassembling”.) This symbol indicates actions which must be performed. Specific instructions are drawn inside or near the ● symbol. (The symbol on the left indicates “disconnect the power cord plug from the outlet”.) :$51,1* 3URKLELWHG 3URKLELWHG 3URKLELWHG 'LVFRQQHFW WKH SOXJ This indicates that there is the risk of death or serious injury if the machines are improperly handled contrary to this indication. Do not plug in or unplug the power cord plug with wet hands as this may cause electric shock. $Q\ RWKHU WKDQ WKH VSHFLILHG $& YROWDJH LV SURKLELWHG If the machines share the same outlet with any other electrical appliances that consume large amounts of power, the voltage will fluctuate widely each time these appliances operate. Be sure to provide an exclusive outlet for the machine as this may cause fire or electric shock. Do not insert or drop metal, flammable or other foreign objects into the machines through the ventilation slits, as this may cause fire or electric shock. 3URKLELWHG 3URKLELWHG If the machines are dropped or their cabinets damaged, first turn off the power switches and disconnect the power cord plugs from the outlet, and then contact your authorized TOSHIBA TEC representative for assistance. Continued use of the machine in that condition may cause fire or electric shock. 'LVFRQQHFW WKH SOXJ (i) Do not use voltages other than the voltage (AC) specified on the rating plate, as this may cause fire or electric shock. Do not place metal objects or water-filled containers such as flower vases, flower pots or mugs, etc. on top of the machines. If metal objects or spilled liquid enter the machines, this may cause fire or electric shock. Do not scratch, damage or modify the power cords. Also, do not place heavy objects on, pull on, or excessively bend the cords, as this may cause fire or electric shock. Continued use of the machines in an abnormal condition such as when the machines are producing smoke or strange smells may cause fire or electric shock. In these cases, immediately turn off the power switches and disconnect the power cord plugs from the outlet. Then, contact your authorized TOSHIBA TEC representative for assistance. Safety Summary 'LVFRQQHFW WKH SOXJ &RQQHFW D JURXQGLQJ ZLUH EO1-11152 If foreign objects (metal fragments, water, liquids) enter the machines, first turn off the power switches and disconnect the power cord plugs from the outlet, and then contact your authorized TOSHIBA TEC representative for assistance. Continued use of the machine in that condition may cause fire or electric shock. 'LVFRQQHFW WKH SOXJ Ensure that the equipment is properly grounded. Extension cables should also be grounded. Fire or electric shock could occur on improperly grounded equipment. 1R GLVDVVHPEOLQJ When unplugging the power cords, be sure to hold and pull on the plug portion. Pulling on the cord portion may cut or expose the internal wires and cause fire or electric shock. Do not remove covers, repair or modify the machine by yourself. You may be injured by high voltage, very hot parts or sharp edges inside the machine. Unauthorized modification is prohibited. indicates that there is the risk of personal Injury or damage to objects if &$87,21This the machines are improperly handled contrary to this indication. 3UHFDXWLRQV The following precautions will help to ensure that this machine will continue to function correctly. ● Try to avoid locations that have the following adverse conditions: * Temperatures out of the specification * Direct sunlight * High humidity * Shared power source * Excessive vibration * Dust/Gas ● Do not subject the machine to sudden shocks. ● Do not press the keys too hard. Keys will operate correctly if they are touched lightly. ● Clean the cover and keyboard, etc. by wiping with a dry cloth or a cloth soaked with detergent and wrung out thoroughly. Never use thinner or other volatile solvent for cleaning. ● At the end of the day, turn the power OFF, then clean and inspect the exterior of the machine. ● Try to avoid using this equipment on the same power supply as high voltage equipment or equipment likely to cause mains interference. ● USE ONLY TOSHIBA TEC SPECIFIED consumables. ● DO NOT STORE the consumables where they might be exposed to direct sunlight, high temperatures, high humidity, dust, or gas. ● When moving the machine, take hold of the drawer and lift the machine. ● Do not place heavy objects on top of the machines, as these items may become unbalanced and fall causing injury. ● Do not block the ventilation slits of the machines, as this will cause heat to build up inside the machines and may cause fire. ● Do not lean against the machine. It may fall on you and could cause injury. ● Place the machine on a stable and level surface. 5HTXHVW 5HJDUGLQJ 0DLQWHQDQFH ● ● ● Utilize our maintenance services. After purchasing the machine, contact your authorized TOSHIBA TEC representative for assistance once a year to have the inside of the machine cleaned. Otherwise, dust will build up inside the machines and may cause a fire or a malfunction. Cleaning is particularly effective before humid rainy seasons. Our preventive maintenance service performs the periodic checks and other work required to maintain the quality and performance of the machines, preventing accidents beforehand. For details, please consult your authorized TOSHIBA TEC representative for assistance. Using insecticides and other chemicals Do not expose the machines to insecticides or other volatile solvents. This will cause the cabinet or other parts to deteriorate or cause the paint to peel. (ii) 1. STAND-ALONE LEVEL OPERATOR’S GUIDE EO1-11152 MA-1595-1 SERIES TABLE OF CONTENTS Page 1. TO OUR CUSTOMERS-------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1- 1 2. ACCESSORIES------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1- 1 3. APPEARANCE AND NOMENCLATURE--------------------------------------------------------- 3- 1 4. MODE LOCK AND MODE SELECTOR KEYS ------------------------------------------------- 4- 1 4.1 4.2 Mode Lock-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4- 1 Mode Selector Keys-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4- 1 5. DISPLAY--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5- 1 5.1 5.2 5.3 Upper Row (16-digit dot windows) -------------------------------------------------------------------- 5- 2 Lower Row (10-digit 7-segment Numeric Display)------------------------------------------------ 5- 4 Display Indicator ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 5- 4 6. OUTLINE OF PREPARATION PROCEDURE BEFORE OPERATING THE ECR---- 6- 1 6.1 Installing/Replacing the Receipt/Journal Roll ------------------------------------------------------ 6- 2 7. CASHIER SIGNING OR CASHIER KEY OPERATIONS------------------------------------- 7- 1 7.1 7.2 7.3 Cashier Code Entry -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 7- 1 Cashier Key Method ([CLK] Keys) ------------------------------------------------------------------- 7- 3 Training Mode Start and End -------------------------------------------------------------------------- 7- 4 8. KEYBOARD LAYOUT --------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8- 1 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9- 1 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT-------------------------------------- 10- 1 10.1 10.2 10.3 10.4 10.5 10.6 10.7 10.8 10.9 10.10 10.11 10.12 10.13 10.14 10.15 10.16 10.17 Receipt-Issue/Non-Issue Selection --------------------------------------------------------------- 10- 2 Store Message Display ------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 10- 2 No-Sale-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10- 3 Loan------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 10- 3 Department Entry ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10- 4 Gasoline Entry ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10- 4 PLU Entry (Manual PLU Code Entry) ------------------------------------------------------------ 10- 5 PLU Entry through Barcode Scanner ------------------------------------------------------------ 10- 5 Cigarette and Alcoholic Beverage Entry (Entry of Sales Item Restricted by Age Limit) ------------------------------------------------- 10- 5 Repeat Entry ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10- 6 Quantity Extension (Multiplication) for DEPTs/PLUs ----------------------------------------- 10- 7 Split Package Pricing -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10- 7 HI-CONE PLUs --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------10- 9 Mix & Match (M & M) Function of Split-Price PLUs ------------------------------------------ 10-11 Price Shift Entry for Split-Price PLUs------------------------------------------------------------ 10-12 Triple Multiplication ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-14 Single-Item Department or Single-Item PLU Entry------------------------------------------- 10-15 EO1-11152 MA-1595-1 SERIES Page 10.18 10.19 10.20 10.21 10.22 10.23 10.24 10.25 10.26 10.27 10.28 10.29 10.30 10.31 10.32 10.33 10.34 10.35 10.36 10.37 10.38 10.39 10.40 10.41 10.42 10.43 10.44 10.45 10.46 10.47 10.48 10.49 10.50 10.51 10.52 10.53 10.54 10.55 10.56 10.57 10.58 10.59 10.60 10.61 10.62 10.63 10.64 10.65 10.66 10.67 HASH Department Entry, HASH PLU Entry --------------------------------------------------- 10-15 Sub-Link Department Entry------------------------------------------------------------------------ 10-15 Sub-Link PLU Entry --------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-16 Urgent PLU Maintenance -------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-16 Returned Merchandise ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-17 Bottle Return ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 10-17 Dollar Discount --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-18 Percent Discount, Percent Charge -------------------------------------------------------------- 10-18 Store Coupon ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-18 Vendor Coupon--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-19 Item Correct ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-19 Void ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-20 All Void ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-20 Non-Add Number Print ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-20 Scale Entry -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-21 Listing Capacity Open ------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 10-22 Selective Itemizer (SI) Status Modification----------------------------------------------------- 10-22 Tax Status or Food Stamp Status Modification ----------------------------------------------- 10-23 Manual Tax Entry ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 10-23 Subtotal (Sale Total Pre-taxed) Read----------------------------------------------------------- 10-23 Taxable Total (Sale Total With Taxes) Read-------------------------------------------------- 10-23 Taxable Total Read and Subtotal Print --------------------------------------------------------- 10-23 Selective Itemizer (SI) Total Read --------------------------------------------------------------- 10-24 PLU Preset Price Read----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-24 Tax Calculation and Print -------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-24 Tax Exemption---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-25 Food Stampable Total Read, Food Stamp Tendering -------------------------------------- 10-25 Sale Finalization by Media Keys ----------------------------------------------------------------- 10-26 Multi-Tendering--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-27 Split Tendering --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-27 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) ---------------------------------------- 10-28 Check Cashing (No-sale cashing of a non-cash media)------------------------------------ 10-42 Sale Paid in Foreign Currencies------------------------------------------------------------------ 10-42 No-Sale Exchange from Foreign Currency to Domestic Currency ----------------------- 10-43 No-Sale Exchange from Domestic Currency to Foreign Currency ----------------------- 10-43 Received-on-Account ------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-44 Paid-Out------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 10-44 Salesperson Entry (Salesperson Sign-ON)---------------------------------------------------- 10-45 Hold & Recall ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-45 Credit Card No. Check------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 10-46 Receipt Post-Issue----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-46 Charge Posting: Previous Balance Manual Entry Type------------------------------------- 10-47 Charge Posting: Customer File Type (Check Track Memory Option) ------------------- 10-49 Function Key Entry ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-51 Endorsement Print ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-51 Comment Print---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-52 Sale Finalization by EBT (Electronic Benefit Transfer) ------------------------------------- 10-53 Validation Print --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10-54 Remote Slip Printer (hardware option) Operation -------------------------------------------- 10-55 When a Power Failure Occurs… ----------------------------------------------------------------- 10-57 EO1-11152 MA-1595-1 SERIES Page 11. JOURNAL AND RECEIPT PAPER-END DETECTOR-------------------------------------- 11- 1 12. ECR PRINTER MOTOR LOCK DETECTOR -------------------------------------------------- 11- 1 13. REMOTE SLIP PRINTER MOTOR LOCK DETECTOR ------------------------------------ 13- 1 14. PRINTER HEAD OPEN DETECTOR ------------------------------------------------------------ 13- 1 15. GENERAL MAINTENANCE------------------------------------------------------------------------ 15- 1 15.1 15.2 15.3 15.4 15.5 15.6 15.7 Cleaning the Covers---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 15- 1 Removing Jammed Paper -------------------------------------------------------------------------- 15- 1 Clearing the Cutter Error ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 15- 1 Manual Drawer Release and Lock---------------------------------------------------------------- 15- 2 Removing the Drawer-------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 15- 2 Media Slot ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 15- 3 CDC (Cash Drawer Cover; Option) Lock-------------------------------------------------------- 15- 3 16. SPECIFICATIONS ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 16- 1 1. TO OUR CUSTOMERS EO1-11152 1. TO OUR CUSTOMERS 1. TO OUR CUSTOMERS Thank you for choosing the TEC electronic cash register MA-1595 series. This instruction manual provides a description of the functions and handling of this ECR and should be read carefully to ensure optimum performance. Since every consideration has been given to safety and reliability, there is no danger of damaging the machine by incorrect operation. Please refer to this manual whenever you have any questions concerning the machine. This machine has been manufactured under strict quality control and should give you full satisfaction. However, if the machine is damaged during transport or there are any unclear points in this manual, please contact your local TOSHIBA TEC representative. • The specifications described in this manual may be modified by TOSHIBA TEC, if necessary. • Be sure to keep this manual for future reference. 2. ACCESSORIES Confirm that all the following accessories are contained in the carton. damaged, contact our nearest TOSHIBA TEC service representative. If any accessories are missing or REGMA S Owner’s Manual (1 copy) Journal Take-up Reel (1 pc.) Paper Roll (2 pcs.) Drawer Key (2 pcs.) 1- 1 Mode Selector Keys (REG key, MA key, S key: 2 pcs. each) Printer Cover Key (2 pcs.) 3. APPEARANCE AND NOMENCLATURE EO1-11152 3. APPEARANCE AND NOMENCLATURE 3. APPEARANCE AND NOMENCLATURE Interface Connectors Customer Display Printer Cover Operator Display Journal Window COM3 COM2 COM1 Receipt Outlet Mode Lock Power Switch Drawer Keyboard Power Cord Printer Cover The cover for the Receipt or Journal paper holder and the printer. Mode Lock It selects the type of register operations. (Section 4) Receipt Outlet or Journal Window The receipt for the finalized sale is issued. Or, the operator can see which items have already been entered through this window. Keyboard Used to enter sale items (Section 8) Power Switch The power switch is provided at the right-hand side of the cabinet. The AC power is turned on when the switch is pushed to ON, and turned off when the switch is pushed to OFF. Interface Connectors (RS-232C, LAN) RS-232C connectors allow a connection of a Remote Slip Printer, Bar Code Scanner, Scale, etc. LAN connectors allow a connection of a PC and building of Master-Satellite system. Display (Operator and Customer) Used to confirm the entry contents and the status of the ECR. (Section 5) 3- 1 4. MODE LOCK AND MODE SELECTOR KEYS EO1-11152 4.1 Mode Lock 4. MODE LOCK AND MODE SELECTOR KEYS 4.1 Mode Lock X (POSITION) MGR SET REG Z REG Key SET REG MA Key X MGR Z (FUNCTION) In this position, the ECR will allow programming operations. (LOCK position) The register operations are locked when the Mode Lock is in this position. Meanwhile, the Display Message and the current time are displayed. Normal cash register operations are carried out in this mode. However, the operations requiring a Manager Intervention cannot be performed in this mode. The sale totals in memory can be read and the programmed data can be verified in this position. This position allows to register all normal cash register operations to be carried out in the “REG” mode and the operations requiring a Manager Intervention. This is the “Negative Mode” which automatically processes all the entries in the reverse way, i.e. positive items into negative, and the negative into positive. It is usually used to return or cancel all the items once purchased in a sale in the “REG” or “MGR” mode. All the resettable totals and their respective counters in memory will be read and reset in this position. 4.2 Mode Selector Keys The REG Key is used by the cashier or clerk who operates the ECR. This key can access the positions of LOCK and REG of the Mode Lock. MA Key: The MA Key is used by the store manager who will daily supervise the collection of money and the printout of transactions recorded by the ECR. This key is also used when programming the ECR. This key can access the positions of SET, LOCK, REG, X, MGR, - and Z. S Key: The S Key is used by the service person from TOSHIBA TEC representative to access any position. To prevent programmed data and sales data from being changed or cleared by mistake, do not use this key without instructions of our TOSHIBA TEC representative. S MA REG REG Key: The keys may be inserted or pulled out at the “LOCK” or “REG” position. In the OPERATOR’S GUIDE, functions and operations will be described within the range of the Mode Lock positions of LOCK and REG using the REG key. Since operations requiring other positions and keys are controlled by the store manager, they are described in the MANAGER’S GUIDE. 4- 1 5. DISPLAY EO1-11152 5. DISPLAY 5. DISPLAY The operator display is located at the top of the ECR just above the keyboard. OPERATOR DISPLAY (Front Display) Upper Row DPT X Lower Row (( )) TL ST The customer display can be moved horizontally, and thus is fully adjustable according to the position of the customer. CUSTOMER DISPLAY (Rear Display) DPT X Lower Row TL ST 5- 1 5. DISPLAY EO1-11152 5.1 Upper Row (16-digit dot windows) 5.1 Upper Row (16-digit dot windows) Alphanumeric characters are displayed here as messages, sale item descriptors, prompts for the operator, etc. depending on the Mode Lock position and the operation sequence. (1) Mode Indications “LOCK” Mode If the display store message is preprogrammed, the message is displayed. Whether the message scrolls with maximum 64 characters or non-scrolls with maximum 16 characters is a program option. At the same time the current time is displayed in the lowest 5 digits of the Lower Row (example: 14-52 for the time 14:52). “REG”, “MGR”, or “ - ” Mode Initial Display The message “LOG” is displayed in the lowest 3 digits of the Upper Row. It means that the cashier has signed OFF or signed OUT and thus the ECR is not operable for sales entries. (This display indication is applicable only when the Cashier Code Entry method is selected.) A Sign-ON or Sign-IN is expected to operate through the [LOG/RECEIPT] (or [LOG]) key in this case. In the REG or MGR mode, a store message (described as the store message displayed in the LOCK mode above) can be displayed when there is no key-in operation takes place in 30 seconds. Whether it is displayed or not is a program option. Whether or not a store message is displayed during cashier key ON status or cashier sign-ON is a program option. Other Mode Initial Display The mode symbol of 1 character is displayed in the lowest digit: 4 3 2 1 SET Mode: P X Mode: X Z Mode: Z Digit No. (2) Digit Range for Various Sales Items (“REG”, “MGR”, “ - ”) 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 Department/PLU Mane (max. 16 characters) Customer File Name (Check Track) (max. 16 characters) Transaction Item Name (max. 12) 5- 2 2 1 5. DISPLAY EO1-11152 5.1 Upper Row (16-digit dot windows) (3) Error Messages (in any mode except “LOCK”) When an error occurs, an error message (programmable) is displayed, with an error buzzer generated (a long tone). 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 XX XXXX XX XX XXXX XX Error Message (max. 16) Read the Error Message, depress the [C] key to cancel the error status and tone, operate the sequence again after removing the cause of the error. The following table shows the cause of the error. If the error status cannot be cancelled or an error message not listed in the table below is displayed, please contact your nearest TOSHIBA TEC representative. ERROR MESSAGE TABLE Error Message (Standard Setting) OPERATION ERROR MANAGER REQUIRED CLOSE DRAWER COMPULSORY CODE COMP DEPOSIT SCALE REQUIRED SCALE OUT PC COMM ERROR CODE ERROR PROGRAM ERROR CALL MANAGER DRAWER LIMIT LINK PLU ERROR COMPULSORY SLIP CDV ERROR COMP CHECK NO. X/Z IN PROGRESS ALREADY RESERVED UNDER AGE COMP QUANTITY PIN ERROR NO RESPONS RECEIPT REQUIRED RESPONS NG MISC ERROR PAPER END HEAD OPEN ERROR Cause of the Error Key Sequence or Operation Procedure Error The operation requires a Manager Intervention. The drawer must be closed before the operation. No code has been entered where it is compulsory. Sub-link Department is compulsory, but not yet entered. The [SCALE] key has not been depressed where required. The scale is malfunctioning. File Receive Error (when a PC is connected). An undefined code has been entered, or the entered code has already been defined. An additional entry of new PLU or new customer file is not acceptable, because the memory of each table is full. The card is not acceptable as a result of Negative Card checking. A media pick up operation is now required. PLU linkage error such as when a sub-link PLU is not programmed in the LinkPLU Table. The operation requires a endorsement print. Check Digit Value Error Performing the negative card check is necessary before finalizing a sale by a media key which has the compulsory status of the negative card check. Read/Reset operation is unavailable during the consolidation of the communication buffer by PC (or master terminal). Read/Reset/Reserve operation was attempted when reset data remained in the communication buffer. (in case of the program option to prohibit rewriting reset data in the communication buffer) Underage person has attempted to buy cigarette or alcoholic beverage. Quantity Entry Compulsion Error (when this compulsion status is programmed to a PLU item). EFT Pin Pad Error Time-out condition on the EFT terminal Entry of new sale transaction is attempted before issuing the store receipt. Communication error between the ECR and the EFT terminal. Other errors Paper is out. Print head remains open. 5- 3 5. DISPLAY EO1-11152 5.2 Lower Row (10-digit 7-segment Numeric Display) ERROR MESSAGE TABLE (continued) Error Message (Standard Setting) CUTTER ERROR SLIP OFF LINE SLIP PAPER OUT VALIDATION CMP RETURN PROHIBIT Cause of the Error Cutter home position is misaligned. Slip Printer is in off line status. No slip paper is set. The operation requires a Validation Print. Return entry with the [EBT CASH] or [EBT F/S] key is prohibited by the system option setting. It is recommended to prepare a copy of the above table, and place it near the ECR. 5.2 Lower Row (10-digit 7-segment Numeric Display) (1) Numeric Display AMOUNT (7 digits) DPT (2 digits) X (1 digit) Displays the numeric data, such as amount, quantity, etc. When the amount is negative, the symbol “ - ” is displayed as well. NOTE: When the following codes are being entered, the digits for “RPT” and “DPT” may be used as well (all 10 digits). On exceeding the 10 digits, the lowest 10 digits are being displayed. PLU Code (max. 13 digits as option) Non-add Number (max. 18 digits) Customer File No. (max. 12 digits) Displays the Department Code of the department item just entered. The department name is also displayed in the Upper Row. It stays lit when repeating the same department item entry. When a PLU is entered, PLU name is displayed in the Upper Row. Displays the repeat count of the same Department or PLU item. The count is indicated from the second entry on, and only the lowest digit of the repeat count will be displayed even when the count exceeds nine (such as “0” for 10, “1” for 11, etc.) 5.3 Display Indicator R OFF: Lights up when the Receipt-OFF mode is declared by the [LOG/RECEIPT] (or [RECEIPT]) key. In this condition, no receipts will be issued for a sale to be entered. It goes out by depressing the [LOG/RECEIPT] (or [RECEIPT]) key again for Receipt-ON mode. SIGN ON: This lamp turns lit only when the Cashier Code Entry method is selected. It lights up when a cashier has signed ON or signed IN. It goes out when the cashier has signed OFF or signed OUT, and the message “LOG” is displayed in the Upper Row instead. IN-LINE: It is used when the ECR is used as a terminal in a Master-Satellite system. When the ECR is used as a stand-alone machine, this lamp is not used. SLIP: Flickers when the program option “endorsement compulsory” or “slip print compulsory” has been selected. This lamp does not light up even when a slip is set to the slip printer. (( )) ALM: Lights up with the alarm buzzer generated to indicate that the last operation or numeric entry was an error. To clear the error status, depress the [C] key. TL TL: Lights up on a finalizing operation with the total amount displayed when the sale is finalized without any amount tendered. ST ST: Lights up when the [ST] key is depressed, indicating that the displayed amount is subtotal. The lamp is also illuminated when the [TXBL TL] or [FSTL TEND] key is depressed, indicating that the displayed amount is the taxable total or food-stampable total. It also lights up when the amount tendered is less than the sale total with the shortage amount (balance due) is displayed. CG: When an amount tendering operation is performed, it lights up with the change due displayed. 5- 4 6. OUTLINE OF PREPARATION PROCEDURE BEFORE OPERATING THE ECR EO1-11152 6. OUTLINE OF PREPARATION PROCEDURE BEFORE OPERATING THE ECR 6. OUTLINE OF PREPARATION PROCEDURE BEFORE OPERATING THE ECR This chapter shows the outline of set-up procedure of the ECR before actually starting the register operation. WARNING! Turn the POWER SWITCH to OFF before connecting the power cord. 1. Remove the ECR from the carton. And take out all the parts and accessories. REGMA S 2. Place the ECR on a stable and level surface, then remove the tapes and seals for holding parts or protecting surface of the ECR. 3. Plug the power cord of the ECR into a wall outlet. Make sure that the outlet voltage matches that of the power required for the ECR. REG X MGR 4. Insert the REG key into the Mode Lock. Z SET REG X MGR 5. Turn the Mode Lock to the “REG” position with the power ON. Z SET 6- 1 6. OUTLINE OF PREPARATION PROCEDURE BEFORE OPERATING THE ECR EO1-11152 6.1 Installing/Replacing the Receipt/Journal Roll 6. Install the Receipt and Journal rolls (referring to the following section “Installing the Receipt/Journal Roll”). 6.1 Installing/Replacing the Receipt/Journal Roll Turn the Mode Lock to the LOCK position using the Mode Selector Key to perform the paper roll installation in this section. CAUTION! Never touch the Cutter Knob. Doing so may cause a CUTTER ERROR. Cutter Knob Receipt Printer Installing/Replacing the Receipt Roll 1. To remove the Printer Cover, insert the Printer Cover Key to the Printer Cover Lock, and then turn it 90° clockwise. 6- 2 6. OUTLINE OF PREPARATION PROCEDURE BEFORE OPERATING THE ECR EO1-11152 6.1 Installing/Replacing the Receipt/Journal Roll 2. Pull up the Printer Release Lever to open the Receipt Cover Frame Ass’y. 2 1 3. Remove the old Receipt Roll, if any. Unstick the end of the Receipt, and then load the Receipt Roll into the printer. 4. Pull the end of receipt roll forward until the area with the glue on the paper is past the Cutter Block. 5. Close the Reciept Cover Frame Ass’y by pusing the shadowed portion until it clicks. 6. Attach the Printer Cover. 6- 3 6. OUTLINE OF PREPARATION PROCEDURE BEFORE OPERATING THE ECR EO1-11152 6.1 Installing/Replacing the Receipt/Journal Roll Installing/Replacing the Journal Roll 1. When installing the Journal Roll for the first time, skip to Step 3. When replacing the Journal Roll, cut the paper at the arrow indicating position in the figure. CAUTION: Never try to pull out the remaining paper end by hand. It may cause a paper jam. 2. Remove the Journal Take-up Reel from the holder, then pull the paper out of the reel. 3. Pull up the Printer Release Lever to open the Journal Cover Frame Ass’y. 2 1 4. Remove the old Journal Roll, if any. Unstick the end of the Journal, and then place the Journal Roll into the right holder as viewed from the front of the machine. 5. Pull the end of the Journal Roll until about 8 inches (about 20 cm) of paper comes out of the journal outlet. 6- 4 6. OUTLINE OF PREPARATION PROCEDURE BEFORE OPERATING THE ECR EO1-11152 6.1 Installing/Replacing the Receipt/Journal Roll 6. Close the Journal Cover Frame Ass’y by pushing the shadowed portion until it clicks. 7. Insert the paper end into the slit of the Take-up Reel and wind it around the reel twice or three times. 8. Set the Journal Take-up Reel into the Reel Holder. 9. Attach the Printer Cover. 6- 5 7. CASHIER SIGNING OR CASHIER KEY OPERATIONS EO1-11152 7.1 Cashier Code Entry 7. CASHIER SIGNING OR CASHIER KEY OPERATIONS 7.1 Cashier Code Entry Each cashier will sign-ON, sign-OFF, sign-IN, and sign-OUT through the [LOG/RECEIPT] (or [LOG]) key. OPERATION: Mode Lock: REG (or, MGR or “ - “ with Manager Intervention) ([LOG/RECEIPT] = [LOG]) (1) For Single-drawer Machines Sign-ON Sign-OUT Sign-IN [LOG/RECEIPT] A Sign-ON receipt is issued, and sales entries are now possible. 2-digit manager-assign code (01 to 99) 2-digit cashier’s own secret code (01 to 99) (NOTE 1) 9 [LOG/RECEIPT] A Sign-OUT receipt is issued, and the cashier must leave the ECR for a while expecting to come back soon. [LOG/RECEIPT] (same as Sign-ON) Sign-OFF 0 [LOG/RECEIPT] A Sign-IN receipt is issued. Sales entries are now possible. A Sign-OFF receipt is issued, and no sales entries will be accepted. Sign-ON..........to be operated to start the job. Sign-OUT........to be operated to leave the ECR for a while expecting to come back soon. Sign-IN............to be operated when the cashier comes back from a break declared by Sign-OUT. Sign-OFF........to be operated to end the job. NOTES: 1. As cashier’s own secret code, the code used for Sign-ON just after the issuance of cashier reset report is programmed. The secret code will be cleared when the cashier reset report is output. 2. Sign-OUT may automatically be performed without operating “9 [LOG]” on finalizing each transaction, including Check (or other non-cash media) Cashing, No-sale Exchange from/to Foreign Currencies, No-sale, Received-on-Account, Paid-Out, Loan, Pick Up if so set by a program option. When this option is selected, Sign-IN is always necessary before starting every transaction. 3. When the finalizing media key is programmed with Endorsement Compulsory status, the automatic Sign-OUT will be executed after taking the endorsement print of the media data. 7- 1 7. CASHIER SIGNING OR CASHIER KEY OPERATIONS EO1-11152 7.1 Cashier Code Entry (2) For Multi-drawer Machines Sign-ON [@/FOR] [LOG/RECEIPT] 2-digit manager-assign code (01 to 99) 2-digit cashier’s own secret code (01 to 99) 1 or 2 as Drawer No. By entering a Drawer No., the designated drawer will open on finalizing each sale by that cashier. It will cause an error if a Drawer No. already used by another cashier is entered. Sign-OUT Sign-IN Sign-OFF Same as those for Single-drawer Machines. NOTES: 1. A maximum of 2 different cashiers may sign-ON on a Multi-drawer Machine at the same time. To allow more than one cashier’s Sign-ON, the first cashier(s) must sign-OFF before the next cashier signs ON. Accordingly, only the cashier being signed ON or IN can sign OUT or OFF. 2. When the Drawer No. entry and the [@/FOR] key are skipped in a Sign-ON, the drawers will automatically be assigned to the cashiers from the smaller No. to the larger. 3. Performing Sign-OFF automatically cancels the designation of the drawer. Therefore, at the next opportunity to perform Sign-ON, the designation of another drawer is available. Performing SignOUT cannot cancel the designation of the drawer. (3) Mode Changes With Signing Operations When Signed-ON or Signed-IN: The Mode Lock position changes are allowed within “LOCK”, “REG”, “MGR”, and “ - ”. Changing to any other position will be an error. When Signed-OUT: The Mode Lock may be turned to any position. However, cashier reports of the cashier being signed OUT cannot be taken in the “X” or “Z” position. When Signed-OFF: The Mode Lock may be turned to any position. Therefore, it is best for the cashier (or all the cashiers on a Multi-drawer Machine) to sign-OFF before the Mode Lock is turned to the “LOCK”, “X”, “Z”, or “SET” position. 7- 2 7. CASHIER SIGNING OR CASHIER KEY OPERATIONS EO1-11152 7.2 Cashier Key Method ([CLK] Keys) -- SIGNING OPERATION RECEIPT PRINT FORMAT SAMPLES -- 7(& 6725( 7(& 6725( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 7(& 6725( 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( )5,3+21( 3($&+ '5,9( )5,3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP ∗∗ 6,*1 &ORVHG 287 HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 2SHQ DP WR SP ∗∗ 6,*1 &ORVHG 21 HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ ∗∗ ∗∗ -21(6 -21(6 70 )5, ∗∗ 6,*1 2)) -21(6 70 )5, 6,*1 ,1 ∗∗ ∗∗ -21(6 70 ∗∗ 70 NOTE: A program option provides a selection not to print nor issue receipts on any signing operation. 7.2 Cashier Key Method ([CLK] Keys) When the [LOG/RECEIPT] (or [LOG]) key is not installed, [CLK] keys ([CLK 1] to [CLK 8]; max. 8 keys) may be provided on the ECR keyboard. Sale entries will be possible only when one of the [CLK] keys is depressed (in “REG”, “MGR”, or “ - ” mode). When the same [CLK] key is again depressed, the cashier is in Sign-OFF status. A program option provides a selection to display or not display the cashier code (1 to 8) of the cashier being Sign-ON condition at the “DPT” digit on the Lower Row of the Operator Display. The multi-drawer feature may be taken with the [CLK] keys. In this case, each of the drawers is assigned to the cashier of the following keys. Drawer 1 to [CLK 1] Drawer 2 to [CLK 2] to [CLK 8] -- Cashier ID Print on Sale Receipts -On every sale receipt (issued in “REG”, “MGR”, or “ - ” mode), the name of the cashier who has operated the entries of the sale is printed. The cashier name is programmable corresponding to each Cashier Key No. (under the CASHIER KEY METHOD) or manager-assign cashier code (under the CASHIER CODE ENTRY METHOD). 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ )5, '3 '3 &$6+ ,7(0 -21(6 70 Cashier’s Name 7- 3 7. CASHIER SIGNING OR CASHIER KEY OPERATIONS EO1-11152 7.3 Training Mode Start and End 7.3 Training Mode Start and End When you have newly employed cashiers, you may provide some time for them to train their skills of operating the ECR. You are to start and end the Training Mode. Once entering the Training Mode, a cashier may operate just as ordinary sale entry operations in “REG” and “MGR” modes except Sign-ON/OFF entry and check track operation. The data in the Training Mode are processed into the training cashier memory but not affect any actual sales data in business. CONDITION Outside a sale, and in Cashier Signed-OFF condition for CASHIER CODE ENTRY Method OPERATION FOR TRAINING MODES START Cashier Code Entry Method [LOG/RECEIPT] (or [LOG]) .................................... A training-ON receipt is issued. 2-digit manager-assign code of a cashier with Training status (01 to 99) 2-digit cashier’s secret code (01 to 99) Cashier Key Method Case 1: Set the Cashier Key programmed with Training status .... A training-ON receipt is not issued. Case 2: 99 [LOG/RECEIPT] (or [LOG]) ......................... A training-ON receipt is issued. (In Cashier Code and Name Setting, cashier code 99 should be programmed as training status ON beforehand.) Fixed to 99 for training purposes. ENTRIES IN TRAINING MODE Registering operations are allowed by the trainees: All sale or transaction entry operations are possible in the Training Mode, except: 1) The drawer will not open. 2) The Consecutive No. on the receipt will not be incremented. 3) When performing an Endorsement print or a Validation print, spaces are printed. (i.e. Printing operation is performed but nothing is printed.) 4) Print occurs on receipt but not journal. 5) The Remote Slip Printer prints a slip. OPERATION FOR TRAINING MODE END Code Entry Method, and Cashier Key Method Case 2 0 [LOG/RECEIPT] (or [LOG]) .................................... A training-OFF receipt is issued in both cases. Cashier Key Method Case 1 Change from the current Cashier Key to another Cashier Key. Now the ECR is in a Signed-OFF condition. You may turn the Mode Lock to any position for its corresponding operations. To start sale entries, a Cashier Key to ON status or a cashier’s Sign-ON status is again necessary. 7- 4 7. CASHIER SIGNING OR CASHIER KEY OPERATIONS EO1-11152 7.3 Training Mode Start and End -- Training Mode Receipt Format -- Training Start (Training Sign-ON) Receipt )5, 75$,1,1* 21 ∗∗ ∗∗ %52:1 Training End (Training Sign-OFF) Receipt ∗∗ ∗∗ )5, Receipt issued in Training Mode 70 %52:1 )5, ∗∗ Training Mode Header 75$,1,1* 2)) ∗∗ ∗∗ 75$,1,1* 7RPDWR 9(*(7$%/( &$6+ ,7(0 ∗∗ ∗∗ 75$,1,1* %52:1 7- 5 7) 7 ∗∗ 70 Entry Contents ∗∗ ∗∗ 70 8. KEYBOARD LAYOUT EO1-11152 8. KEYBOARD LAYOUT 8. KEYBOARD LAYOUT The following are typical keyboard layouts for the MA-1595 series. Since this series is designed to be capable of programming most of the keys to be placed in the desired place on the keyboard, these are merely examples. The keyboard of your ECR should have its own layout according to the store’s requirements. -- Ordinary Keyboard Type (US Standard) -LOG/ RECEIPT NS RECEIPT ISSUE ALL VOID PO CUR DOLL DISC R/A RTN MDSE %- EX VOID READ ITEM CORR PLU HOLD/ RECALL TX1/M TX2/M # RF C 7 4 1 0 JF 1 6 11 16 21 26 2 7 12 17 22 27 3 8 13 `8 23 28 4 9 14 19 24 29 5 10 15 20 25 30 @/FOR 8 5 2 00 9 6 3 • ST AT/TL CHECK Chg CREDIT 1 Other keys not placed in the keyboard above: Additional Department Keys (31 to 60) [000] (Triple-zero Key) [VND CPN] [STR CPN] [BTL RTN] [%+] [MISC TEND] [CREDIT 2] [PR OPEN] [LC OPEN] [OPEN] PLU Preset-code Keys [TXBL TL] [TAX] [PICK UP BAL] (or [PB+]) [CODE OPEN] (or [PB-]) [TRF] [SI1/M], [SI2/M] [SI1/TL], [SI2/TL] [AMT] [RPT] [SCALE] [TARE] [CARD No.] [FS/M] [TX3/M], [TX4/M] [FSTL/TEND] [CUR 2] to [CUR 5] [LOG] [SALES PERSON] [CHK No.] [DP#] [CARD CHK] [PLU ADD] [RECEIPT] [VALIDATE] [COMMENT] [CLK 1] to [CLK 8] [FUNCTION 1] to [FUNCTION 10] 8- 1 [3rd PRICE] [TARE 2] [TARE 3] [PRINT] [PACK] [ID] [DISPLAY 1] to [DISPLAY 6] for the EBT (Electronic Benefit Transfer) Spec. [DEBIT] [MANUAL CARD#] [OFFLINE AUTH] for the EFT [STORE RECEIPT] (Electronic [POST AUTH] Fund Transfer) [EBT CASH] Spec. [EBT F/S] [VOUCHER AUTH] [BALANCE INQUIRY] 8. KEYBOARD LAYOUT EO1-11152 8. KEYBOARD LAYOUT -- Flat Keyboard Type (US Standard) -- 1 9 17 25 33 41 49 57 1 9 2 10 18 26 34 42 50 58 2 10 3 11 19 27 35 43 51 59 3 11 4 12 20 28 36 44 52 60 4 12 5 13 21 29 37 45 53 61 5 13 6 14 22 30 38 46 54 62 6 14 7 15 23 31 39 47 55 63 7 15 8 16 24 32 40 48 56 64 8 16 PLU Preset-code keys LOG/ RECEIPT RF JF NS EX RECEIPT ISSUE # DOLL DISC %- TX1/M ALL VOID PO HOLD/ RECALL READ TX2/M CUR R/A C @/FOR CREDIT 1 RTN MDSE 7 8 9 Chg VOID 4 5 6 CHECK ITEM CORR 1 2 3 ST PLU 0 00 • AT/TL Department keys Other keys not placed in the keyboard above: Additional Department Keys (17 to 60) [000] (Triple-zero Key) [VND CPN] [STR CPN] [BTL RTN] [%+] [MISC TEND] [CREDIT 2] [PR OPEN] [LC OPEN] [OPEN] [TXBL TL] [TAX] [PICK UP BAL] (or [PB+]) [CODE OPEN] (or [PB-]) [TRF] [SI1/M], [SI2/M] [SI1/TL], [SI2/TL] [AMT] [RPT] [SCALE] [TARE] [CARD No.] [FS/M] [TX3/M], [TX4/M] [FSTL/TEND] [CUR 2] to [CUR 5] [LOG] [SALES PERSON] [CHK No.] [DP#] [CARD CHK] [PLU ADD] [RECEIPT] [COMMENT] [VALIDATE] [CLK 1] to [CLK 8] [FUNCTION 1] to [FUNCTION 10] [3rd PRICE] 8- 2 [TARE 2] [TARE 3] [PRINT] [PACK] [ID] [DISPLAY 1] to [DISPLAY 6] for the EBT (Electronic Benefit Transfer) Spec. [DEBIT] [MANUAL CARD#] [OFFLINE AUTH] for the EFT [STORE RECEIPT] (Electronic [POST AUTH] Fund Transfer) [EBT CASH] Spec. [EBT F/S] [VOUCHER AUTH] [BALANCE INQUIRY] 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY EO1-11152 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY This section briefly describes functions of each key for your quick reference purposes. See the reference pages in Section 10: REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT for detail operation sequences. TABLE OF KEY FUNCTIONS Key Functions LOG key Used in case of Cashier Code Entry Method, to declare start or end of normal operation by cashier. For details, refer to Section 7.1. Receipt key Used to change the receipt-ON/OFF mode. LOG RECEIPT Log/Receipt key This is a dual-function key that has both [LOG] and [RECEIPT] functions. LOG RECEIPT RECEIPT ISSUE RF JF 7 4 1 0 1 8 5 2 00 9 6 3 • to DP# PLU C # NS 60 Receipt Post-Issue key Used to issue the receipt of a sale when the sale has already finalized in the Receipt-OFF mode. Receipt Feed key Used to advance the receipt roll and operated by holding it down until the paper has advanced to the required position. Journal Feed key Used to advance the journal roll in the same fashion as the [RF] key is used to receipt roll. Numeric keys Used to enter numeric values. Depressing the [00] key once is the same as depressing the [0] key twice consecutively. Depressing the [000] key once is the same as depressing the [0] key three times consecutively. The [ . ] key is used to designate the decimal point of a percentage rate or a quantity. Department keys Used to enter each item, serving for classifying merchandise by department. Department No. key Used to access a department by designating the department code, instead of depressing the specific Department key. With this key installed, a maximum of 99 departments may be controlled. PLU (Price Look Up) key Used to enter a PLU that is linked to a department. Clear key Used to clear numeric entries or a declaration key entry. Non-add Number Print key Used to print a non-add number (such as Customer No., Credit Card No., etc.) on the receipt and journal for future reference. No-sale key Used to open the cash drawer without relating a sale, and also used to display the store message. 9- 1 Reference page 7-1 10-2 See pages for [LOG] and [RECEIPT] 10-38 ----- ----- ----- 10-4 See pages for [DEPT] 10-5 ----- 10-20 10-2, 3 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY EO1-11152 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY Key AMT PR OPEN LC OPEN OPEN @/FOR VND CPN STR CPN READ COMMENT Functions Amount key Used to enter a manual amount of PLU item. And also used to enter an amount or price for an open department when the department is accessed by the [DP#] key. Preset Open key Used to release a preset-price department or PLU items for a manual price entry. Listing Capacity Open key Used to release the high or low amount limit preprogrammed on each department or PLU. Preset and Listing Capacity Open key This is a dual-function key that has both [PR OPEN] and [LC OPEN] functions. AT-FOR (Quantity Extension and Split Package Pricing) key Used to multiply a department, PLU, or Bottle Return item entry by a quantity. Also used to auto-calculate and enter a split-package price, triple multiplication, or HI-CONE. Vendor Coupon key Used to enter the amount of vendor coupons received from the customer. Store Coupon key Used to subtract a store coupon amount redeemed through a department. PLU Price-Read key Used to read the preset price of the designated PLU from the memory. Also used to read the amount and the name of the customer file. Comment Print key Used to print the respective programmed comments on the receipt. Reference page 10-4, 5 10-4, 5 10-22 See pages for [PR OPEN] and [LC OPEN]. 10-7 10-19 10-18 10-24 10-52 Returned Merchandise key Used to refund money to a customer who has returned items already purchased. Bottle Return key Used to enter a bottle return amount. 10-17 10-18 %+ Dollar Discount key Used to subtract an amount from the sale such as a discount during a sale. Percent Charge key Used to add a percent rate to a sale. Percent Discount key Used to subtract a percent rate from a sale. 10-18 %− Item Correct key Used to remove the last item from the bill, printing a line through the item on the receipt and journal. Void key Used to delete an item entered previously (before the last item) in the current transaction. 10-19 RTN MDSE BTL RTN DOLL DISC ITEM CORR VOID 9- 2 10-17 10-18 10-20 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY EO1-11152 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY Key Functions All Void key Used to cancel all the items entered in the current sale. ALL VOID Received-on-Account key Used to enter payments received on account, i.e. not relating to a sale. Also used for change reserve amounts loaned from the store. Paid-Out key Used to record amounts paid out of the cash drawer not relating to a sale. Also used for Pick Up operations, such as money collections for banking purposes. Subtotal key Used to obtain subtotal of the current transaction. R/A PO ST TXBL TL AT/TL CHK TND or CHECK TEND Chg MISC TEND CREDIT 2 CREDIT 1 CARD No. CHECK No. PB+ or PB- TRF PICK UP BAL Taxable Total key Used to obtain the taxable total (the sale total including taxes due) of the current transaction. Cash Amount Tendered/Cash Total key Used to record all cash paid transactions, and will be able to finalize a sale operation. Check key This is one of non-cash media keys, and used to cash a check when the ECR is outside a sale, or to finalize the transaction as a check payment. Charge key This is another non-cash media key, and usually programmed as “Charge Sale Total” key. This key can also be used for payments in credit cards, if the [CARD No.] key is installed. Miscellaneous Media key This is one of additional non-cash media keys that may be installed besides [CHK TND] and [Chg]. This key has the same functions and programmabilities as the [CHK TND] key, and usually used as Tender-only key. Credit 1 & 2 keys These are additional non-cash media keys that may be installed besides those already described, according to the requirements of each store. Card No. key Used to enter the code number (1 to 12) which classifies the credit card company followed by the sale finalization with the [Chg] key. Check No. and Endorsement Print key Used to print the endorsement data with or without a Check No. print after finalizing a sale with a non-cash media key. Previous Balance keys Used to enter a previous balance in a charge posting operation. Transfer key Used to transfer the entire balance in a charge posting operation with no payment. Pick Up Balance key This key should be installed in place of the [PB+] key if the “Customer File” (Check Track) memory option is selected instead of the “Manual PB Entry” type. 9- 3 Reference page 10-20 10-3, 44 10-44, 3-1 (MG) 10-23 10-23 10-26 10-26 See pages for [CHECK TEND] See pages for [CHECK TEND] See pages for [CHECK TEND] 10-26 10-51, 55 10-47 10-47 10-49 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY EO1-11152 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY Key Functions CODE OPEN SI/TL Reference page Customer File Code Open key This key should be installed in place of the [PB-] key if the “Customer File” memory option is selected. SI (Selective Itemizer) Total key Used to display (and print) the selective itemizer contents. 10-49 SI (Selective Itemizer) Modifier key Used to reverse the SI (Selective Itemizer) status programmed on each Department or PLU. 10-22 10-24 or: SI1/TL SI2/TL SI/M or: SI1/M SI2/M TX/M or: TX1/M to 10-23, 25 TX4/M EX SALES PERSON RPT CUR 1 Tax Modifier key(s) Used to reverse the taxable/non-taxable status on departments, PLUs, or other tax-status programmable keys. Also used in Tax Exempt operations. to SCALE TARE TARE 2 TARE 3 CUR 5 Tax Exempt key Used to declare the exemption of the taxes from the sale. 10-25 Salesperson key Used to record sales contribution data of each salesperson for report purpose. Repeat key Used to repeat a department or PLU item entry. 10-45 Foreign Currency keys Used in tendering or exchange with foreign currencies. 10-43 Scale key This key is used for various scaled items. To enable to register weight data from the scale, only the Departments programmed with the Scale-Allowed status or the PLUs programmed with the ScaleCompulsory status may be operated. Tare key Used to enter the preset tare weight data prior to a scaled item entry, thus to subtract tare from the gross weight and obtain the net weight. Tare 2 key Used to calculate the net weight using the % rate set in the PLU table or the input rate when the scaled item (for Department, PLU) is entered. Tare 3 key Used to enter the tare weight manually when the scaled item (for Department, PLU) is entered. 10-21 9- 4 10-6 10-21 10-21 10-21 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY EO1-11152 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY Key Functions TAX FS/M CARD CHK CLK 1 FUNCTION 1 CLK 8 to to FUNCTION 10 HOLD RECALL PLU ADD 3rd PRICE PACK ID VALIDATE DEBIT MANUAL CARD # OFFLINE AUTH Manual Tax key Used to enter an irregular tax amount that cannot be calculated on the basis of the programmed tax table, and to add it to the sale total. Food Stamp Modifier key Used to reverse the Food Stampable/Non-stampable status of a Department, PLU, and other function keys programmable with foodstampable status. Card Check key Used to enter the Card No. of the credit card to check if the card is acceptable. Cashier 1 to Cashier 8 keys Used to declare start or end of normal operation by cashier (instead of using [LOG/RECEIPT] (or [LOG]) key). Function 1 to Function 10 keys Used to execute a command of key string preprogrammed on each of these keys. An operation series of maximum 10 keys can be programmed on each key, thus eliminating time in daily operation routines. HOLD/RECALL key In case a customer is slow in payment or in endorsement of a check at finalizing the sale, this key is used to “hold” the sale by temporarily finalizing the sale, and after wards to “recall” the sale total of the customer to really finalize it. When the sale is “recalled,” additional sale items may be entered before the real finalization. PLU Add key Used to add a PLU item that has not been programmed in the PLU table file, to the PLU Additional Table file. PLU 3rd Price key Used to perform the dollar discount or the extra charge for a packed sales item. Pack key Used to enter a packed sales item. Reference page 10-23 10-23 10-46 7-3 10-51 10-45 10-16 10-12 10-12 ID key Used to enter a sales item of cigarette or alcoholic beverage. 10-5 Validation key Used to print a required item or finalize a required sale on a validation slip. Validation print operation is performed on the slip printer. Debit key This is one of the EFT media keys. 10-54 Manual Card No. key Used to manually enter a card No. and its expiration date on the ECR. Off-line Authority key Used to finalize the EFT sale transaction on the off-line ECR. 10-30 9- 5 10-29 10-31 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY EO1-11152 9. FUNCTIONS OF EACH KEY Key POST AUTH STORE RECEIPT Post Authority key Used to finalize the EFT sale transaction which was authorized on the off-line ECR. Store Receipt key Used to manually issue a store receipt. Reference page 3-3 (MG) 10-32 EBT CASH EBT Cash key This is one of the EFT media keys. 10-33 EBT F/S EBT Food Stamp key This is one of the EFT media keys. 10-35 VOUCHER AUTH BALANCE INQUIRY PLU Preset-code Keys NOTE: Functions Voucher Authority key Used to finalize the sale transaction on the off-line ECR when the network is down. Balance Inquiry key Used for inquiring the balance to the host. Each of these keys is programmed with a PLU Code. That is, depressing one of those keys is equal to entering a PLU Code then depressing the [PLU] key. 3-4 (MG) 3-6 (MG) See pages for [PLU] To perform the operations regarding the EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer), the hardware devise to connect the EFT terminal and the software setup to realize the EFT function are required. For details, ask your TOSHIBA TEC representative. 9- 6 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT WARNING! When opening the cash drawer, be careful not to let the drawer hit any person. CAUTION! When taking an issued receipt, be sure to confirm that the cutter operation stops. Failure to do this may cause a paper jam or a printer failure. Before starting sale entries, read through the following instructions: TRAINING MODE is available: If you are a beginner in operating this ECR, ask the store manager for practicing in the TRAINING MODE. During your operations, the following may occur: • Errors ... A tone continuously sounds and an error message appear in the upper row of the Operator Display panel. The keys on the keyboard are locked. In this case, read the Error Message (refer to the ERROR MESSAGE TABLE, Section 5.1), and depress the [C] key to cancel the error status. Then remove the cause of the error and perform the operation again. • Manager Intervention is required ... When Error Message “MANAGER REQUIRED” (standard setting; programmable) is displayed, it means that the last key or operation requires a Manager Intervention. Depress the [C] key to cancel the error status, and call the manager for intervention. When the manager comes to intervene with an appropriate key, you may perform the operation again. If you are informed which keys and operations will require Manager Intervention, you can call the manager in advance before the error occurs. • Other errors requiring Manager Intervention ... When an error occurs and you cannot think of the cause or the same error occurs again, call your manager. • Receipt or Journal Paper-End is detected ... When Error Message “PAPER END” (standard setting; programmable) is displayed, the receipt or journal roll is about to end. In this case, the error cannot be canceled by the [C] key. Replace the paper roll with a new one, referring to the paper installing/removing operations in Chapter 6. • Printer Motor-Lock Condition is detected ... If “PRINTER ERROR” is indicated in the lower row of the display panel (“AMOUNT” portion), the Printer Motor is locked due to paper jam, etc. Turn the Power Switch to OFF, and remove the cause of the motor-lock. Refer to Chapters 12 and 13. CONDITION SETTING TO START SALE ENTRIES Mode Lock: Insert the “REG” key and set it to the “REG” position. Cashier Sign-ON or Cashier Key to ON status: If the [LOG/RECEIPT] (or [LOG]) key is installed, you must sign-ON or sign-IN. (See Section 7.1.) If Cashier Keys are installed, you must set your cashier key to the ON status. (See Section 7.2.) Now you are ready for sale entries. On the following pages are patterns of entering operations, and receipt or journal print format samples due to the ]” operations. In the operation sequence patterns, “| |” indicates an input through the numeric keys, “[ indicates a depression of the function key, and “---” indicates other registering and/or finalizing operations. Please note that these are merely sample operations. Especially, the receipt or journal print indications merely show the standard print format. The actual print format and contents may vary on your machine in accordance with the differences in specifications, program selections, etc. 10- 1 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.1 Receipt-Issue/Non-Issue Selection 10.1 Receipt-Issue/Non-Issue Selection Receipts are issued or not issued according to the “R OFF” lamp illuminated/extinguished status on the Operator Display panel. “R OFF” (Receipt OFF) Lamp Status Change Operations ([LOG/RECEIPT] = [RECEIPT]). Mode Lock may be in any position [LOG/RECEIPT] Extinguished [LOG/RECEIPT] Receipt ON Status NOTES: 10.2 Illuminated Receipt OFF Status 1. The “R OFF” lamp status at the starting of a transaction entry decides whether a receipt will be issued for the transaction or not. Switching the Receipt ON/OFF status during a transaction will not be effective. 2. If a transaction entered with the “R OFF” lamp illuminated and finalized but a receipt is required, the [RECEIPT ISSUE] (Post-issue Receipt) key can be operated to issue a receipt. 3. Simply depress the [LOG/RECEIPT] key without a numeric entry. If the key is depressed with a prior numeric entry in REG mode, it may turn out to be a Sign ON or Sign OFF operation (in case of Cashier Code Entry Method). 4. Receipt-issue or non-issue cannot be selected after a non-add number print, sales person entry, comment print, or credit card No. check. Store Message Display This operation designates one of the four messages programmed to display in REG or MGR mode when no entries are under way on the ECR. OPERATION (Must be operated outside a sale) |Display Message Code| [NS] 1 to 4 (corresponding to Line No.1 to 4 in programming) NOTE: This operation is effective when program options “Display Message Method 16 CHARACTERS HELD” and “Display Message DISPLAY in REG and MGR mode (as well as in LOCK mode)” are both selected. Display selection in LOCK mode also depends on the line designated in this operation. 10- 2 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.3 No-Sale 10.3 No-Sale The no-sale transaction is used to open the cash drawer without relating to any sales, such as for giving change, testing the receipt/journal print condition, etc. OPERATION (Must be operated outside a sale) [NS] ...................... The drawer opens and a No-sale receipt is issued. -- Receipt Print Format -- 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( Max.4 lines of Store Name/Message 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ Max.3 lines of Commercial Message Date (Month-Day-Year order in this sample) 6$7 Day-of-Week Name of the Cashier who is operating the ECR. NOTE: 10.4 ∗∗ 12 6$/( -21(6 Register No. ∗∗ 70 No-sale Receipt Header Consecutive No. Current Time The print format samples in this manual are not copies of actual receipts printed on an ECR but are merely indications of print formats. In those format samples, the bold-face characters indicate Double-sized Characters on actual receipts issued by the ECR. Also note that each Double-sized Character on actual receipts will be printed at the position half-character space rightward more than in the print format samples in this manual. Loan This operation is used to record the cash amounts and food stamps loaned from the store as the change reserve in the drawer. OPERATION [R/A] (Must be operated outside a sale) |Cash Amount Loaned| [AT/TL] ([ST]) |Food Stamp Amount Loaned| [FSTL TEND] To read the loan total so far entered. Repeatable to add up amounts. Loan Receipt Header Amounts loaned Total amount loaned ∗∗ /2$1 ∗∗ &$6+ &$6+ &$6+ 68%7/ 727$/ -21(6 NOTE: 70 During the Loan operation, the Non-add Number print and the Validation print are possible. 10- 3 [AT/TL] 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.5 Department Entry 10.5 Department Entry Each department is preprogrammed as the “PRESET” type (with a price programmed) or “OPEN” type (with no price programmed). Perform operation depending on the type selected. -- Receipt Print Format -- OPERATION Open Department Type • |Price| [Open DEPT] • |Open-Dept Code| [DP#] |Price| [AMT] 9(*(7$%/( T: Taxable Item Symbol F: Food Stampable Item Symbol Preset Department Type • [Preset DEPT] • |Dept Code| [DP#] Preset-price Open through Preset Department Type • [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Price| [Preset DEPT] • [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Dept Code| [DP#] |Price| [AMT] 10.6 7) '3 '3 Gasoline Entry Enter the sale amount of gasoline. The quantity of gasoline is calculated by the preset gallon unit price. OPERATION Same as Open Department Type of DEPARTMENT ENTRY sequence using the Department Key which is programmed as a Gasoline Sales department. NOTES: 1. A department should be programmed with Gasoline status and unit price. 2. The [DP#] key cannot be used for Gasoline entries. 3. The calculation result (the quantity of gasoline) will be obtained down to the 3rd digit below the decimal point. The fraction rounding method is ruled by the option selected for the Quantity Extension fraction rounding. (see NOTE 5 attached to QUANTITY EXTENSION section). 4. The repeat entry is unavailable to a Gasoline Sales department. 5. Gasoline sales department cannot be used as the Preset type. The sale amount of gasoline must be entered. 6. The quantity of gasoline calculated will be not displayed but printed. Example) DEPT 10 = Unit price 3.00 with Gasoline status -- Receipt Print Format -1000 [DEPT 10] [AT/TL] *DO # *DVROLQH 7$; &$6+ 10- 4 *DO 7 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.7 PLU Entry (Manual PLU Code Entry) 10.7 PLU Entry (Manual PLU Code Entry) Each PLU is preprogrammed as the “PRESET” type (with a price preset) or “OPEN” type (with no price preset). Perform operation depending on the type selected. OPERATION -- Receipt Print Format -- Open PLU Type • |Price| [PLU Preset-Code Key] of Preset-PLU • |Open-PLU Code| [PLU] |Price| [AMT] 'ULQN 6PDOO% 7 Preset PLU Type • [PLU Preset-Code Key] of Preset-PLU • |Preset-PLU Code| [PLU] 'ULQN 6PDOO% 7 Preset-price Open Entry through Preset PLU Type • [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Price| [PLU Preset-Code Key] • [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Preset-PLU Code| [PLU] |Price| [AMT] 7RPDWR 7) 10.8 PLU Entry through Barcode Scanner OPERATION Basic Operation Sequence: Scan the barcode of the required item (instead of |PLU Code| [PLU]) ... A short tone is generated when the barcode is successfully scanned. When a barcode scanner is connected to the COM port, the operation sequence “|PLU Code| [PLU]” can be replaced by simply scanning the barcode. It is true in any operation pattern relating to PLU entries (Repeat, Quantity Extension, etc.). 10.9 Cigarette and Alcoholic Beverage Entry (Entry of Sales Item Restricted by Age Limit) This operation checks whether or not a customer satisfies the age limit to purchase cigarette and alcoholic beverage. OPERATION When the entry of “Date of Birth” is unnecessary. Entry of a cigarette or an alcoholic beverage status Department/PLU [ID] |Date of Birth| MM-DD-YYYY 8 Digits (NOTE 1 below) The display message “CHECK ID” is displayed on the Operator’s Display. When the age confirmation is accepted, the age confirmation print will be performed, and the sales item will be processed. If the age confirmation is not accepted, the error message “UNDER AGE” will be displayed on the Operator’s Display. NOTES: 1. When the month of date of birth is January to September, the entry of the preceding zero can be omitted. 2. Initial setting is as follows. • Customer of the age 18 or more can purchase cigarette. • Customer of the age 21 or more can purchase alcoholic beverage. 10- 5 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.10 Repeat Entry 3. In one sale transaction, when the entry of a sales item with the age limit status causes an error (the error message “UNDER AGE”), the entry of another sales item with the age limit status requires the entry of date of birth and the [ID] key depression. The age confirmation will be automatically performed in the second or later entry of cigarette or alcoholic beverage. 4. Entry of the date of birth can be programmed to be compulsory. 5. In the entry of cigarette or alcoholic beverage after the Recall Operation, it is unnecessary to enter the date of birth and depress the [ID] key if the age confirmation has been performed before the Hold Operation. 6. Immediately after the ID check error (the error message “UNDER AGE”) is cleared by the [C] key, the Item Correct Operation is not possible, but the Void or the All Void operation is possible. Example) In case a customer aged 20 (date of birth: July 31st, 1983) purchases items (DEPT5=age limit 21, DEPT6=age limit 18) on August 30th, 2003. -- Receipt Print Format -100 [DEPT5] ,' &+(&. Age Confirmation 07311983 [ID CHECK] The customer’s age is under 21, resulting in an error. This sales item cannot be accepted by the age confirmation, [C] the entered value of date of birth will be invalid. 200 [DEPT6] 07311983 [ID CHECK] The customer’s age is over 18, resulting that the sales item can be entered. [AT/TL] 10.10 Repeat Entry To repeat the same item of the last entry, simply depress the last key of the department or PLU entry sequence or depress the [RPT] key. OPERATION (1) Department Repeat Open Department Type • |Price| [Open DEPT] [Same DEPT] (or [RPT]) • |Open-Dept Code| [DP#] |Price| [AMT] [AMT] (or [RPT]) -- Receipt Print Format -9(*(7$%/( 9(*(7$%/( 7) 7) Preset Department Type • [Preset DEPT] [Same DEPT] (or [RPT]) • |Preset-Dept Code| [DP#] [DP#] (or [RPT]) Preset-price Open Repeat • [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Price| [Preset DEPT] [RPT] • [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Preset-Dept Code| [DP#] |Price| [AMT] [RPT] (2) PLU Repeat Open PLU Type • |Open-PLU Code| [PLU] |Price| [AMT] [AMT] (or [RPT]) • |Price| [PLU Preset-Code Key] [Same key] (or [RPT]) NOTES: -- Receipt Print Format -7RPDWR 7RPDWR 7) 7) 1. If the first item of those repeated is modified with [SI/M], [LC OPEN], [FS/M], or [TX/M], the modified status will be effective through the last item of the repeated. 2. Please note that the Preset-price Open Repeat using a [Preset DEPT] key or a [PLU PresetCode Key] can only be repeated by the [RPT] key. 3. A negative Department or negative PLU item cannot be repeated. Neither can any Other Income Department/PLU be repeated. 10- 6 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.11 Quantity Extension (Multiplication) for DEPTs/PLUs 10.11 Quantity Extension (Multiplication) for DEPTs/PLUs OPERATION (1) Department Multiplication Open Department Type • |Quantity| [@/FOR] |Price| [Open DEPT] • |Quantity| [@/FOR] |Open-Dept Code| [DP#] |Price| [AMT] Preset Department Type • |Quantity| [@/FOR] [Preset DEPT] • |Quantity| [@/FOR] |Preset-Dept Code| [DP#] Preset-price Open Type • |Quantity| [@/FOR] [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Price| [Preset DEPT] • |Quantity| [@/FOR] [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Preset-Dept Code| [DP#] |Price| [AMT] (2) PLU Multiplication Open PLU Type • |Open-PLU Code| [PLU] |Quantity| [@/FOR] |Price| [AMT] • |Quantity| [@/FOR] |Price| [PLU Preset-Code Key] of Open-PLU Preset PLU Type • |Quantity| [@/FOR] |Preset-PLU Code| [PLU] • |Quantity| [@/FOR] [PLU Preset-Code Key] of Preset-PLU -- Receipt Print Format -[ '3 [ '3 # # Preset-price Open Type • [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Preset-PLU Code| [PLU] |Quantity| [@/FOR] |Price| [AMT] • |Quantity| [@/FOR] [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Price| [PLU Preset-Code Key] of Preset-PLU NOTES: 1. Quantity ................. Max. 3 integral + 3 decimal digits (Use the [ . ] key for entering decimal digits.) Price (Unit Price) ... Max. 6 digits (or 5 digits with Preset Point feature) Product .................. Must not exceed 8 digits. 2. When the Quantity is 1-digit integer (1 to 9) followed by a Code-preset Department/PLU key with a price preset, the [@/FOR] key is omissible. 3. The product obtained by multiplication cannot be repeated. 4. The decimal portion of the Quantity entry itself is processed down to the two digits below the decimal point. The fraction rounding in this case is fixed to ROUND OFF. 5. You can select the rounding process of the fractions of the product (result of multiplication) by a program option: ROUND OFF (initial setting), ROUND UP, or ROUND DOWN. 10.12 Split Package Pricing (“Q’ty” = Quantity ... in the patterns listed below) This operation is used for entering individual item of whole package. For example, one individual item of whole package ($1.00/3 pcs.) can be entered by this operation. OPERATION (1) Department Open Department • |Purchased Q’ty| [@/FOR] |Whole Package Q’ty| [@/FOR] |Whole Package Price| [Open Dept] |Open-Dept Code| [DP#] |Whole Package Price| [AMT] 10- 7 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.12 Split Package Pricing Preset Department • |Purchased Q’ty| [@/FOR] |Whole Package Q’ty| [@/FOR] [Preset Dept] |Preset-Dept Code| [DP#] Preset-price Open • [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Purchased Q’ty| [@/FOR] |Whole Package Q’ty| [@/FOR] |Whole Package Price| [Preset Dept] |Preset-Dept Code| [DP#] |Whole Package Price| [AMT] (2) PLU Open PLU • |Purchased Q’ty| [@/FOR] |Split-Price Type PLU Code| [PLU] of open-price PLU NOTE 1 below |Whole Package Price| [AMT] |Whole Package Price| [PLU Preset-code Key] of open-price PLU and Split-Price Type Preset PLU • |Purchased Q’ty| [@/FOR] |Split-Price Type PLU Code| [PLU] of preset-price PLU NOTE 1 below [PLU Preset-code Key] of preset-price PLU and Split-Price Type Preset-Price Open • [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Purchased Q’ty| [@/FOR] |Split-Price Type PLU Code| [PLU] of preset-price PLU NOTE 1 below |Whole Package Price| [AMT] |Whole Package Price| [PLU Preset-code Key] of preset-price PLU and Split-Price Type NOTES: 1. When this portion is omitted, the “Purchased Q’ty” value is regarded as “1” (i.e. one individual item but not the whole package quantity.) 2. Purchased Quantity ....................... max.3 digits integral only Whole Package Quantity ............... max.3 digits integral only Whole Package Price .................... max.6 digits 3. This operation is possible only when the option “Split Package Pricing” is selected (instead of Triple Multiplication). 4. One of two fraction rounding methods can be selected for the Split Package Pricing calculations --Round Up PRODUCT (initial setting) or Round Up UNIT PRICE. Whole Package Quantity Purchased Quantity $SSOH Whole Package Price # 7) Purchased Amount Item Name 10- 8 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.13 HI-CONE PLUs 10.13 HI-CONE PLUs In addition to ordinary Split-Price PLUs, the HI-CONE status can be programmed to each of them. If so programmed, the operation patterns for one item entry (entry of one individual split-package item) and for the whole package quantity entry are different from those of ordinary Split-Price PLUs. To enter one individual item in the package (one unpacked item): Ordinary Split-Price PLUs (i.e. without HI-CONE status) Open PLU (1 [@/FOR]) |Split-Price Type PLU Code| [PLU] Entry of Quantity 1 can be omitted. |Whole Package Price| [AMT] of open-price PLU or Barcode Scanning |Whole Package Price| [PLU Preset-code Key] of open-price PLU Entry of Quantity Preset PLU (1 [@/FOR]) |Split-Price Type PLU Code| [PLU] of preset-price PLU Entry of Quantity 1 can be omitted. [PLU Preset-code Key] of preset-price PLU and Split-Price Type Barcode Scanning HI-CONE PLUs Open PLU 1 [@/FOR] Entry of Quantity 1 is required. |Split-Price Type PLU Code| [PLU] |Whole Package Price| [AMT] of open-price PLU and Split-Price Type or Barcode Scanning |Whole Package Price| [PLU Preset-code Key] of open-price PLU and Split-Price Type and HI-CONE status Preset PLU 1 [@/FOR] Entry of Quantity 1 is required. |Split-Price Type PLU Code| [PLU] of preset-price PLU and HI-CONE status [PLU Preset-code Key] of preset-price PLU and Split-Price Type and HI-CONE status Barcode Scanning To enter Whole Package Quantity (all the items packed): Ordinary Split-Price PLUs (i.e. without HI-CONE status) Open PLU • |Whole Package Q’ty| [@/FOR] |Split-Price Type PLU Code| [PLU] Cannot be omitted |Whole Package Price| [AMT] of open-price PLU or Barcode Scanning |Whole Package Price| [PLU Preset-code Key] of open-price PLU and Split-Price Type 10- 9 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.13 HI-CONE PLUs Preset PLU • |Whole Package Q’ty| [@/FOR] |Split-Price Type PLU Code| [PLU] of preset-price PLU Cannot be omitted [PLU Preset-code Key] of preset-price PLU and Split-Price Type Barcode Scanning HI-CONE PLUs Open PLU |Split-Price Type PLU Code| [PLU] |Whole Package Price| [AMT] of open-price PLU and HI-CONE status or Barcode Scanning |Whole Package Price| [PLU Preset-code Key] of open-price PLU and Split-Price Type and HI-CONE status Preset PLU |Split-Price Type PLU Code| [PLU] of preset-price PLU and HI-CONE status or Barcode Scanning [PLU Preset-code Key] of preset-price PLU and Split-Price Type and HI-CONE status Thus the “Whole Package Quantity” entry is not necessary for a sale of the Whole Package Quantity of a SplitPrice PLU of HI-CONE status. NOTE: The Unit Price of Individual Split-package Item can be preset for each HI-CONE PLU. If it is preset, Split Pricing entry of such a PLU (with less than the Whole Package Quantity) will be calculated on the basis of the preset price of Individual Split-package Item. If it is not preset, the calculation is performed on the basis of the Whole Package Price, just as ordinary Split-Price PLUs. Also see the NOTES attached to the section of SPLIT PACKAGE PRICING. Operation Examples of HI-CONE PLUs 1) When PLU No. 1 is programmed with Whole Package Price of $1.00, Whole Package of Quantity 3, and HICONE status. The Split-package Individual Item Price is not preset. Entry Contents Quantity 1: Quantity 2: Quantity 3: Whole Package: (= Quantity 3) NOTE: Key Operation 1 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] 2 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] 3 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] 1 [PLU] Sale Amount (Calculation Process) $0.34 ($1.00 ÷ 3 = $0.333 ...) $0.67 ($1.00 x 2/3 = $0.666 ...) (NOTE) $1.00 (Preset Whole Package Price) $1.00 (Preset Whole Package Price) When the option “ROUND UP UNIT PRICE” is selected, the Sale Amount and the Calculation Process will be as follows: $0.68 ($1.00 ÷ 3 = 0.333 ... rounded up to $0.34 ... x 2) 2) Same as 1) above, except that the Split-package Individual Item Price is preset with $0.40. Entry Contents Quantity 1: Quantity 2: Quantity 3: Whole Package: (= Quantity 3) Key Operation 1 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] 2 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] 3 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] 1 [PLU] 10-10 Sale Amount (Calculation Process) $0.40 (Preset Indiv. Item Price) $0.80 (Preset Indiv. Item Price x 2) $1.00 (Preset Whole Package Price) $1.00 (Preset Whole Package Price) 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.14 Mix & Match (M & M) Function of Split-Price PLUs 10.14 Mix & Match (M & M) Function of Split-Price PLUs Each of Split-Price PLUs can be programmed with a M & M Group No. Even different PLUs of the same M & M Group No. can be entered mixedly within a sale, then an automatic discount is made when the specified number of those PLU items are entered. For example, if two different bottled drink items cost $1.00 for three bottles, those items can be programmed with the same M & M Group No. to enable Mix & Match sales. To set different PLUs into the same M & M Group, each of the PLUs must be set with the same Whole Package Quantity, same Whole Package Price, and same Split-package Individual Price (if it is set). Otherwise, a wrong calculation will occur in actual entries in a sale. Operation Examples of Mix & Match Functions Cases 1) Two PLUs (PLU No. 1 and PLU No. 2 are programmed with Whole Package Quantity of 3, Whole Package Price $1.00, and the same M & M Group No.: 1-1) When the PLUs are programmed as ordinary Split-Price PLUs (without HI-CONE): Entry Contents (within one sale) Key Operation 1 x PLU No. 1 1 x PLU No. 2 1 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] 1 [@/FOR] 2 [PLU] 1 x PLU No. 1 1 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] Sale Total NOTE: Sale Amount (Calculation Process) $0.34 ($1.00 ÷ 3 = $0.333 ...) $0.33 ($1.00 x 2/3 = $0.666 ... rounded up to $0.67 - $0.34) (NOTE) $0.33 ($1.00 - $0.67) (NOTE) $1.00 When the option “ROUND UP UNIT PRICE” is selected, the Sale Amounts on the second and third entries are as follows: $0.34 (instead of $0.33) (second entry) $0.32 (instead of $0.33) (third entry) 1-2) When the PLUs are programmed with HI-CONE status and not programmed with Preset Individual Prices: Entry Contents (within one sale) Key Operation 1 x PLU No. 1 1 x PLU No. 2 1 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] 1 [@/FOR] 2 [PLU] 1 x PLU No. 1 1 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] Sale Total NOTE: Sale Amount (Calculation Process) $0.34 ($1.00 ÷ 3 = $0.333 ...) $0.33 ($1.00 x 2/3 = $0.666 ... rounded up to $0.67 - $0.34) (NOTE) $0.33 ($1.00 - $0.67) (NOTE) $1.00 Same as the NOTE in Case 1) above 1-3) When the PLUs are programmed with HI-CONE status and programmed with Preset Individual Item Price of $0.40: Entry Contents (within one sale) 1 x PLU No. 1 1 x PLU No. 2 1 x PLU No. 1 Key Operation (1 [@/FOR]) 1 [PLU] (1 [@/FOR]) 2 [PLU] (1 [@/FOR]) 1 [PLU] Sale Total Sale Amount (Calculation Process) $0.40 (Preset Indiv. Item Price) $0.40 (Preset Indiv. Item Price) $0.20 ($1.00 - $0.80) $1.00 10-11 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.15 Price Shift Entry for Split-Price PLUs Cases 2) Same as Case 1-3) except that the PLUs are not programmed with the same M &M Group 2-1) When Individual Items are entered separately: Entry Contents (within one sale) PLU No. 1 (Whole package) PLU No. 2 (Whole package) Key Operation (3 [@/FOR]) 1 [PLU] $1.00 (Whole Package Price) (3 [@/FOR]) 2 [PLU] $1.00 (Whole Package Price) Sale Total NOTE: Sale Amount (Calculation Process) $2.00 Even without M &M Grouping programmed, an entry of any Split-Price PLU in units of Whole Package Quantity is processed as Whole Package Price for each PLU. 2-2) When the PLUs are entered in units of whole packages: Entry Contents (within one sale) PLU No. 1 (Whole package) PLU No. 2 (Whole package) Key Operation (3 [@/FOR]) 1 [PLU] $1.00 (Whole Package Price) (3 [@/FOR]) 2 [PLU] $1.00 (Whole Package Price) Sale Total NOTE: Sale Amount (Calculation Process) $2.00 Even without M &M Grouping programmed, an entry of any Split-Price PLU in units of Whole Package Quantity is processed as Whole Package Price for each PLU. 10.15 Price Shift Entry for Split-Price PLUs This operation performs Split-price PLU item entry using the following three unit price. • Cooled one unpacked item • Cooled packed item • Packed item under normal temperature OPERATION 1) For the entry of cooled packed item [PACK] [PACK] [PACK] NOTES: Barcode Scanning |PLU Code| [PLU] [PLU Preset-Code Key] of Preset-PLU 1. 2. 3. 4. Depressing the [PACK] key after the [3rd PRICE] key is depressed results in an error. This transaction can handle neither open price PLU nor scale-compulsory PLU. Preset-price Open Entry is unavailable for this transaction. This transaction is unavailable when the Triple Multiplication feature has been selected. 10-12 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.15 Price Shift Entry for Split-Price PLUs 2) For the entry of packed item under normal temperature [3rd PRICE] [3rd PRICE] [3rd PRICE] NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. Barcode Scanning |PLU Code| [PLU] [PLU Preset-Code Key] of Preset-PLU Depressing the [3rd PRICE] key after the [PACK] key is depressed results in an error. This transaction can handle neither open price PLU nor scale-compulsory PLU. Preset-price Open Entry is unavailable for this transaction. This transaction is unavailable when the Triple Multiplication feature has been selected. Example) Program Contents Entry Contents Program Contents Entry Contents • Whole Package Price: $1.00 • HI-CONE Status: None • Whole Package Quantity: 3 • Mix & Match Function: With • Split-package Individual Item Price: $0.40 • Amount of Dollar Discount/ Extra Charge: $0.20 • Quantity Entry Compulsory: None (Discount) ............ Split-package Individual Item Price 1 [PLU] $0.40 ............ Split-package Individual Item Price 1 [PLU] $0.40 ............ Mix & Match $1.00 - $0.40 - $0.40 = $0.20 1 [PLU] $0.20 Total $1.00 ............ Split-package Individual Item Price 1 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] $0.40 ............ Mix & Match $1.00 - $0.40 = $0.60 2 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] $0.60 ............ Mix & Match 3 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] $1.00 Total $2.00 [PACK] 1 [PLU] $1.00 ............ Whole Package Price [3rd PRICE] 1 [PLU] $0.80 ............ Whole Package Price -Dollar Discount Total $1.80 • Whole Package Price: $1.00 • HI-CONE Status: None • Whole Package Quantity: 3 • Mix & Match Function: With • Split-package Individual Item Price: $0.40 • Amount of Dollar Discount/ Extra Charge: $0.20 • Quantity Entry Compulsory: With (Discount) ............ Split-package Individual Item Price 1 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] $0.40 ............ Mix & Match $1.00 - $0.40 = $0.60 2 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] $0.60 ............ Mix & Match 3 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] $1.00 Total $2.00 [PACK] 1 [PLU] $1.00 ............ Whole Package Price [3rd PRICE] 1 [PLU] $0.80 ............ Whole Package Price -Dollar Discount Amount Total $1.80 10-13 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.16 Triple Multiplication Program Contents Entry Contents • Whole Package Price: $1.00 • HI-CONE Status: With • Whole Package Quantity: 3 • Mix & Match Function: With • Split-package Individual Item Price: $0.40 • Amount of Dollar Discount/ Extra Charge: $0.20 • Quantity Entry Compulsory: None (Extra Charge) 1 [PLU] $1.00 ............ Whole Package Price 1 [PLU] $1.00 1 [PLU] $1.00 Total $3.00 ............ Split-package Individual Item Price 1 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] $0.40 2 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] $0.60 ............ Mix & Match 3 [@/FOR] 1 [PLU] $1.00 Total $2.00 [PACK] 1 [PLU] $1.00 ............ Whole Package Price [3rd PRICE] 1 [PLU] $1.20 ............ Whole Package Price + Extra Charge Amount Total $2.20 10.16 Triple Multiplication (1) Department Triple Multiplication Open Department • |Length| [@/FOR] |Width| [@/FOR] Preset Department • |Length| [@/FOR] |Width| [@/FOR] |Unit Price| [Open DEPT] |Open-Dept Code| [DP#] |Unit Price| [AMT] [Preset DEPT] |Preset-Dept Code| [DP#] Preset-price Open • [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Length| [@/FOR] |Width| [@/FOR] (2) PLU Triple Multiplication Open PLU • |Length| [@/FOR] |Width| [@/FOR] Preset PLU • |Length| [@/FOR] |Width| [@/FOR] |Unit Price| [Preset DEPT] |Preset-Dept Code| [DP#] |Unit Price| [AMT] |Open-PLU Code| [PLU] |Unit Price| [AMT] |Unit Price| [PLU Preset-Code Key] of Open-PLU |Preset-PLU Code| [PLU] [PLU Preset-Code Key] of Preset-PLU Preset-price Open • [PR OPEN] (or [OPEN]) |Length| [@/FOR] |Width| [@/FOR] |Preset -PLU Code| [PLU] |Unit Price| [AMT] |Unit Price| [PLU Preset-Code Key] of Preset-PLU PLU Entry through Barcode Scanner (see NOTE 4 on the next page) |Length| [@/FOR] |Width| Scan the Barcode of Preset-price PLU Scan the Barcode of Open-price PLU 10-14 |Unit Price| [AMT] 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.17 Single-Item Department or Single-Item PLU Entry NOTES: 1. The Triple Multiplication entries are possible only when the option “Triple Multiplication” is selected (instead of Split Package Pricing). 2. Length, Width ................................ Max. 3 integral digits + max. 3 decimal digits Unit Price ....................................... Max. 6 digits Product of Length x Width ............. Less than 9999,999 3. The fraction rounding method is ruled by the process designated for ordinary Quantity Extension entries. 4. In a entry sequence using a barcode scanner, an error will result on entering the [@/FOR] key for the second time. 10.17 Single-Item Department or Single-Item PLU Entry If a department (or PLU) is programmed as Single-item, the department (or PLU) entry sequence will immediately finalizes the sale as cash sale when operated outside a sale. OPERATION Same as NOTES: -- Single-item Receipt Print Format -DEPARTMENT ENTRY PLU ENTRY QUANTITY EXTENSION SPLIT PACKAGE PRICING TRIPLE MULTIPLICATION 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 1. If operated inside a sale, it functions just as an ordinary itemized department or PLU. 2. For the Validation print after the Single-Item Department (or PLU) entry, the name and the amount of the department (or PLU) are printed. 6$7 '3 &$6+ ,7(0 -21(6 70 10.18 HASH Department Entry, HASH PLU Entry This operation is used to enter items which do not directly become sales for the store, such as lottery, postage, gift wrapping fee, size adjustment fee, utility (payment of electricity and gas), and donation. OPERATION Same as DEPARTMENT ENTRY sequence using the Department Key which is programmed as an HASH department. When a PLU is used for this purpose, the PLU must be programmed to link to a department with HASH status. 10.19 Sub-Link Department Entry OPERATION Head-link Dept Entry Sub-link Dept Entry --- -- Receipt Print Format -- (compulsory) Example) Dept.“DRINK” is programmed as Headlink Dept. and Dept. “BTL DEPO” is programmed as Sub-link Dept. in this example. 10-15 '5,1. %7/ '(32↑ Sub-link Mark 7) 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.20 Sub-Link PLU Entry 10.20 Sub-Link PLU Entry OPERATION When the Sub-link PLU is of Preset-PLU Type: Sub-link PLU Code Entry --- Head-link PLU Entry (automatically entered) When the Sub-link PLU is of Open-PLU Type: --|Price| [AMT] (compulsory) -- Receipt Print Format -'ULQN 6PDOO% 6PDOO%WO 'HSR↑ (FR )HHV↑ Example) PLU “Drink Small-B” is programmed as Head-link PLU and PLU “Small-Btl Depo” and “Eco Fees” are programmed as Sub-link in this example. PLU Table Link PLU Table PLU Code PLU Name Tax Status 000001 000002 000003 Drink Small-B Small-Btl Depo Eco Fees TAX1 NOTES: 7 7 Link PLU Table No. 1 2 Table Code PLU Code 1 2 000002 000003 TAX1 1. For entering a Price of the Sub-link PLU, the [PLU Preset-code Key] cannot be used (always use the [AMT] key in this case). 2. When the program option “Manager Intervention for entering Negative Departments/PLUs in REG mode” has been selected, a Manager Intervention is required for the Head-link PLU entry of which Sub-link PLU is programmed as negative status. 10.21 Urgent PLU Maintenance (to enter a PLU item not existing in the PLU program file) OPERATION PLU Entry Operation [PLU ADD] Error Message “CODE ERROR” is displayed. Depress [C] to cancel the error status. (|Quantity| [@/FOR]) |PLU Code| [PLU] in case of quantity extension Or, scan the barcode. [DEPT] |Unit Price| [AMT] |Dept Code| [DP#] Link Department Designation NOTES: --- Max. 6 digits (0 to 999999) 1. When a PLU item is successfully entered in the operation procedure above, the item is printed on the receipt and journal. The item name at this time is the name of the Link Department. At the same time, the PLU item is automatically added to the PLU ADDITIONAL FILE. Thus, the added PLU item can now be entered normally on any of the terminals. 2. Since PLU items thus added to the PLU file are programmed with the name of the link department and the “zero” status as a provisional measure, it will be a Manager’s job to change those PLU tables with proper name and status as a PLU maintenance operation later (described in the Manager’s Guide). 10-16 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.22 Returned Merchandise 10.22 Returned Merchandise OPERATION [RTN MDSE] DEPARTMENT ENTRY PLU ENTRY QUANTITY EXTENSION SPLIT PACKAGE PRICING TRIPLE MULTIPLICATION SINGLE-ITEM DEPARTMENT/PLU ENTRY SUB-LINK PLU ENTRY (Operate before Head-link PLU to return both items linked together.) SUB-LINK DEPARTMENT ENTRY (Operate before each or one of the two items that is returned.) --- -- Receipt Print Format -571 '3 7) 571 3/8 NOTE: 7) This operation cannot be performed for Negative Departments/PLUs. 10.23 Bottle Return OPERATION |Bottle Return Amount| [BTL RTN] |Quantity| [@/FOR] |Unit Amount| [BTL RTN] max.3 digits (integral value only) NOTES: 1. This operation can be performed both inside a sale and outside a sale. (The “Credit Balance” option is ignored.) 2. The bottle return amount exceeding the subtotal amount can be entered. -- Receipt Print Format -%75 %75 10-17 [ # 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.24 Dollar Discount 10.24 Dollar Discount OPERATION --- Dept or PLU item entry (for discount from an individual item) |Amount| [DOLL DISC] --- [ST] (for discount from the sale total) --- -- Receipt Print Format -9(*(7$%/( ',6& 68%7/ ',6& 7) NOTES: 1. This operation can be performed both inside a sale and outside a sale. (The “Credit Balance” option is ignored.) 2. After the [ST] key depression, the discount amount exceeding the subtotal amount can be entered. 3. This operation is not possible immediately after a link-PLU entry. 10.25 Percent Discount, Percent Charge OPERATION [%-] (or [%+]) Dept or PLU entry Positive Previous Balance entry (credit balance) [ST] NOTES: |Rate| [%-] (or [%+]) 1. Rate ............................................... 0.001 to 99.999 (%). 2. When the Dept or PLU item entry is modified with [RTN MDSE] or [VOID], the following % entry will also be modified with [RTN MDSE] or [VOID]. 3. A % entry will cause an error if operated after a Negative Department/PLU or an HASH Department/PLU. 4. After the [ST] key depression, a negative subtotal amount can be entered also. -- Receipt Print Format -- '3 7) 68%7/ 10.26 Store Coupon OPERATION [STR CPN] NOTE: Follow DEPARTMENT ENTRY QUANTITY EXTENSION for DEPTs The store coupon amount to be entered must not exceed the sale total unless the “Credit Balance” option is selected. 10-18 -- Receipt Print Format -6&31 9(*(7$%/( 7) 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.27 Vendor Coupon 10.27 Vendor Coupon OPERATION --- ([ST]) |Coupon Amount| [VND CPN] ---- Receipt Print Format -- NOTES: 1. This operation can be performed both inside a sale and outside a sale. (The “Credit Balance” option is ignored.) 2. The vendor coupon amount exceeding the subtotal amount can be entered. 68%7/ 9&31 10.28 Item Correct OPERATION DEPARTMENT ENTRY PLU ENTRY REPEAT ENTRY QUANTITY EXTENSION SPLIT PACKAGE PRICING TRIPLE MULTIPLICATION RETURNED MERCHANDISE BOTTLE RETURN DOLLAR DISCOUNT PERCENT CHARGE/DISCOUNT STORE COUPON VENDOR COUPON Previous Balance Entry in CHARGE POSTING (Manual PB Entry or Customer File Type) RECEIVED-ON-ACCOUNT Item PAID-OUT Item MANUAL TAX -- Journal Print Format -9(*(7$%/( &255 ↑ 7) [ITEM CORR] NOTES: 1. When [ITEM CORR] is depressed after a Repeat Entry, only the last item of those repeated will be deleted. 2. When [ITEM CORR] is depressed after a Quantity Extension entry, the entire product (result of multiplication) will be deleted. 3. When the Item Correct operation is performed, “CORR ↑“ is printed on the journal, but the deleted item is not printed on the receipt. 4. The Validation Print operation is possible after the Item Correct operation. 5. The Item Correct operation is not possible after the Validation Print operation. 6. The Item Correct operation is not possible immediately after a Link-PLU entry. 10-19 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.29 Void 10.29 Void The VOID operation is used to delete an item already entered before the last item within the current sale. Such items cannot be deleted by the [ITEM CORR] key any longer. OPERATION [VOID] --- DEPARTMENT ENTRY PLU ENTRY QUANTITY EXTENSION SPLIT PACKAGE PRICING| TRIPLE MULTIPLICATION ---- Receipt Print Format -- NOTE: An amount exceeding the sale total cannot be entered unless the “Credit Balance” option is selected. 9(*(7$%/( 92,' 9(*(7$%/( 7) 7) '3 voids Void Entry 7) 10.30 All Void When the current transaction being entered is found to be canceled before finalizing it, ALL VOID can be operated to delete all the items entered in the transaction. OPERATION [ITEM CORR] to execute ALL VOID [ALL VOID] Sale Item Entries [C] to cancel ALL VOID NOTES: 1. All Void is possible if the current transaction contains less than 50 items. 2. All Void can also be operated to delete a charge posting sale of Manual PB Entry Type or Check Track Type. 3. The All Void cannot be operated after an [EX] entry or during a Received-on-Account or Paid-Out transaction. 4. The All Void cannot be operated after the [FS TL/TEND] key. 5. The All Void is not possible during the Hold operation. 6. The All Void is not possible after recalling a sales transaction which the Hold is performed for. -- Receipt Print Format -- 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 6$7 9(*(7$%/( 68%7/ 7) 7) '3 ∗∗$// 9' -21(6 ∗∗ 70 10.31 Non-Add Number Print Non-add numbers can be entered and printed for future references, to indicate codes or numbers of customers, media checks, credit cards, etc. The entered numbers do not affect any sale total data. OPERATION (--- (allowed any time during a sale or transaction) ) |Number| [#] -- Receipt Print Format -- --- Max.18 digits. Non-add No. Print 10-20 32 32 727$/ 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.32 Scale Entry 10.32 Scale Entry OPERATION (The department or PLU through which scale items are entered must be a Scale-Allow department or a Scale-Compulsory PLU) (1) Auto Scale Entry (without tare/tare 2/tare 3, or with tare/tare 2/tare 3 auto-subtraction) (M) • Through Dept: Place the item on the scale platter. [SCALE] |Unit Weight| [@/FOR] 1 to 9 (LB or Kg), 10 for 1/2 LB or 100g, 11 for 1/4LB (when the Unit Weight is different from the General Weight Unit) For entry with General Weight Unit ..... |Unit Price| [Open DEPT] --- per Unit Weight Max. 6 digits |Open-Dept Code| [DP#] |Unit Price| [AMT] per Unit Weight Max. 6 digits • Through Preset-PLU: Place the item on the scale platter. |Preset PLU Code| [PLU] ([SCALE]) (M) --- • Through Open-PLU: Place the item on the scale platter. ([SCALE]) (M) |Open PLU Code| [PLU] |Unit Price| [AMT] --- per Unit Weight Max. 6 digits NOTES: 1. When the PLU is programmed with a Tare Table No., the tare weight is automatically subtracted from the scaled weight, and thus only the net weight is processed. 2. If the Tare 2 rate is programmed in the PLU table, a Tare 2 entry is performed when the above Preset/Open PLU entry is performed. 3. At the link-PLU entry, the Scale Entry can be performed for the head-link PLU but not for the sublink PLU. (2) Auto Scale with Tare/Tare 2/Tare 3 |Tare Table No.| [TARE] 1 to 9 |Tare Table No.| [TARE] 1 to 9 |Tare 2 Rate| [TARE 2] 0 to 99.99 (%) |Tare Weight| [TARE 3] Any value other than 0, however, less than the weight of scaled item to be continued to the arrows marked with “(M)” in the above three operation sequences of the Auto Scale Entry. |Tare 2 Rate| [TARE 2] 0 to 99.99 (%) to be continued to the arrows marked with “(M)” in the above three operation sequences of the Auto Scale Entry. to be continued to the arrows marked with “(M)” in the above three operation sequences of the Auto Scale Entry. to be continued to the arrows marked with “(M)” in the above three operation sequences of the Auto Scale Entry. 10-21 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.33 Listing Capacity Open |Tare Weight| [TARE 3] Any value other than 0, however, less than the weight of scaled item NOTES: |Tare 2 Rate| [TARE 2] 0 to 99.99 (%) to be continued to the arrows marked with “(M)” in the above three operation sequences of the Auto Scale Entry. 1. If the Tare 2 rate is programmed in the PLU table, a PLU entry using |Tare 2 Rate| [TARE 2] (third pattern above) cannot be performed. 2. The [TARE 3] key cannot be used together with the [TARE] key. 3. Omission of the Tare 3 Entry causes an error if the compulsory status of the Tare 3 Entry has been programmed to a department/PLU item to be entered. (3) Manual Scale Entry (It may be prohibited by a program option.) |Net Weight| of the item to be continued to the arrows marked with “(M)” in the above three operation sequences of the Auto Scale Entry. [SCALE] 1 to 99999 (unit: g or 1/100LB. For example, enter 5 for 0.05 LB.) (4) Return or Void Manual Scale Entry (It may be prohibited by a program option.) [RTN MDSE] for Return to be continued to the top of the “Manual Scale Entry” sequence above. [VOID] for Void 10.33 Listing Capacity Open For Departments and PLUs Depress [LC OPEN] (or [OPEN]) prior to or any time during an entry of an open-department, open-PLU, or preset-open department or PLU sequence (including REPEAT and QUANTITY EXTENSION entries). Please note that the [LC OPEN] or [OPEN] key must be pressed, at latest, before the final key of the entry sequence. The High Amount Limit for the department or PLU will be extended with two higher digits, and the Low Amount Limit will be extended with one lower digit. For entering an amount still exceeding these limits, you must call for a Manager Intervention. For Media Tender Amounts Depress [LC OPEN] (or [OPEN]) before or after the amount but Media Key. The High Amount Limit for the media tendering will be extended with one higher digit. In need of still exceeding this limit, you must call for a Manager Intervention. For Amounts through [DOLL DISC], [VND CPN], [STR CPN], [BTL RTN] To exceed their limits, you must always call for a Manager Intervention. The [LC OPEN] or [OPEN] key will not be effective. As for the [STR CPN] key only, the amount is limited by both High Amount Limit of the department through which the store coupon amount is entered and the amount limit for [STR CPN]. That is, when an amount cannot be entered using [LC OPEN] or [OPEN], you must call for a Manager Intervention. 10.34 Selective Itemizer (SI) Status Modification Depress [SI/M] (or [SI1/M] and/or [SI2/M]) for entering the required Department or PLU item, the same way as [LC OPEN] is operated for Departments and PLUs. The SI-net status is reversed to non-net status, and vice versa. 10-22 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.35 Tax Status or Food Stamp Status Modification 10.35 Tax Status or Food Stamp Status Modification Depress [TX/M] (or [TX1/M], [TX2/M], [TX3/M], [TX4/M]), in the same way as [LC OPEN] is operated, prior to or any time during the entry sequence of the required Department, PLU, or any other tax-status-programmable item ([DOLL DISC], [%-], [%+], [STR CPN], [VND CPN], [BTL RTN]). The taxable status is reversed to non-taxable, and vice versa. The [FS/M] key operates the same to reverse from the Food Stampable status to nonstampable, and vice versa, of the required item. 10.36 Manual Tax Entry (where irregular tax amount addition is applied) -- Receipt Print Format -- OPERATION --- |Irregular Tax Amount to be Added| [TAX] --7$; 10.37 Subtotal (Sale Total Pre-taxed) Read OPERATION --- -- Receipt Print Format -[ST] --68%7/ The sale total (pre-taxed) of the items so far entered is displayed (and printed if so programmed), but the sale is not finalized. Additional item entries are allowed, if any. 10.38 Taxable Total (Sale Total With Taxes) Read OPERATION -- Receipt Print Format ---- [TXBL TL] --7;%/ 7/ The sale total including taxes due of the items so far entered is displayed (and printed if so programmed), but the sale is not finalized. Additional item entries are allowed, if any. 10.39 Taxable Total Read and Subtotal Print (when only one of [ST] and [TXBL TL] keys, not both, is installed on the keyboard) In this case, the key is usually programmed as [ST] key with [TXBL TL] functions. Since this key has both [ST] and [TXBL TL] functions, it may be labeled as “[ST]” in some stores or as “[TXBL TL]” in others. OPERATION --- [ST] --(or [TXBL TL]) The sale total including taxes of the items so far entered is displayed (and the sale total pre-taxed is printed if so programmed), but the sale is not finalized. Additional item entries are allowed, if any. 10-23 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.40 Selective Itemizer (SI) Total Read 10.40 Selective Itemizer (SI) Total Read OPERATION -- Receipt Print Format -- [SI/TL] - - - (for Single-SI Machine) ([SI1/TL] and/or [SI/2/TL] for Dual-SI Machine) --- SI Total Calculated 9(*(7$%/( 6, 7/ 7$; &$6+ 7) The SI total is displayed and printed on journal (and printed on the receipt if so programmed). NOTES: 1. The fraction process method is fixed to Round OFF. 2. For the Validation print after depressing the [SI/TL] key, the SI total amount is printed. 10.41 PLU Preset Price Read This operation may be used to verify the preset price of an individual PLU. (Any time inside or outside a sale, but prohibited during a short-tendered condition. It is impossible to read the customer file during the training entry.) OPERATION - - -) ) [READ] |PLU Code| [PLU] ( ) [READ] [PLU Preset-Code Key] ( - - -) ) [READ] Scan the Barcode of the PLU ( ) [READ] |Customer File Code| [PICK UP BAL] ( (--(--(--(--- - - -) - - -) ... The operation header “READ” (programmable) and the name of the PLU displayed in the upper row and the preset price of the PLU is displayed in the lower row. When it is an open PLU, nothing will be displayed in the lower row. No print occurs. NOTES: 1. Other items or operations relating or not relating to the read-out PLU may follow. If you want to clear the display content, depress the [C] key. It is only a “READ” operation and will not affect any sales data. 2. PLU Preset Price Read Operation designated by the [3rd PRICE] or [PACK] key is available. 10.42 Tax Calculation and Print Your ECR has been programmed with proper tax tables (tax breaks and/or tax rates). Each department or PLU has been programmed with proper tax status, i.e. taxable or non-taxable status of each Tax (of maximum 4 taxes of Tax 1 to Tax 4). On finalizing a sale, the taxes due are automatically calculated and printed on the receipt, and thus added to the sale. Whether all taxes (Tax 1 to Tax 4) are consolidated into one line print or individually printed in separate lines is a program option. -- Receipt Print Format -Example of Consolidated Print Line 68%7/ 7$; &$6+ 68%7/ Example of Separate Print 7$; 7$; Lines &$6+ 10-24 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.43 Tax Exemption 10.43 Tax Exemption OPERATION Selective Tax Exemption [TX1/M] [EX] Examples) [TX1/M] [TX2/M] [EX] [TX1/M] [TX2/M] [TX3/M] [EX] Sale Finalization ... to exempt from Tax 1 only Sale Finalization ... to exempt from Tax 1 & Tax 2 Sale Finalization... to exempt from Tax 1, Tax 2, & Tax 3 All Tax Exemption [EX] [TX1/M] [TX2/M] [TX3/M] [TX4/M] [EX] NOTES: Sale Finalization Sale Finalization to exempt from all taxes 1. On depressing [EX], the sale total including the exempted tax(es) is displayed and pre-taxed amount of the sale portion subject to the tax exemption is printed. 2. Tax Exemption is unavailable for inclusive taxes. 3. Only when the total validation function has been selected, the Validation print operation after depressing the [EX] key is possible. -- Receipt Print Format -7$;(; 7$;(; Pre-taxed amount of the sale portion subject to Tax1 Pre-taxed amount of the sale portion subject to Tax2 10.44 Food Stampable Total Read, Food Stamp Tendering OPERATION --- [FSTL TEND] |Food Stamp Tendered Amount| [FSTL TEND] Displays the Food Stampable Total Tendering in Food Stamp (This must be operated first of all the payments in finalizing the sale if food stamps are part of the payment.) --- ... When the Food Stamp tendered amount is less than the sale total, the sale is not finalized with the balance still due displayed. Then it can be finalized with cash or other media total or tendering operations. Entire Sale Total Food Stampable Total Food Stamp Tendered Amount Change in Cash Change in Food Stamp NOTES: 727$/ )67/ )6703 &+$1*( )6 &+* 1. Food Stamp feature is unavailable for the area where inclusive tax feature is used. 2. Any of the following features can be selected by the program option. 1) Normal The amount including the food stampable tax can be paid by Food Stamp. 2) Illinois Only the amount paid by Food Stamp is exempted from the food stampable tax. 3) New Jersey All food stampable tax is exempted regardless of the amount of Food Stamp. 3. Change in unit of $ is paid by Food Stamp, and ¢ is paid by cash. 10-25 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.45 Sale Finalization by Media Keys 10.45 Sale Finalization by Media Keys OPERATION ([TXBL TL]) --- [AT/TL] finalize without tendering |Tendered Amount| finalize with tendering and change calculation ([TXBL TL]) --- [CHK TND] [Chg] [MISC TEND] Other media keys finalize without tendering |Tendered Amount| finalize with tendering and change calculation |Quantity| [@/FOR] |Tendered Amount| max. 3 digits |Code for Credit Card Company| [CARD No.] 1 to 12 (|Tendered Amount| ) [Chg] (NOTE 6) NOTES: 1. Whether each Media Key is depressed with a prior tendered amount entry or not is determined by the key status selections programmed for each media key. 2. If the sale total is zero, any Media Key must be depressed without a tendered amount entry even if the key is programmed as “Tender” key. 3. When a non-cash media key is programmed as “Tender-only” key, it cannot finalize a negative balance sale. Whether a “Total-only” or “Tender/Total” key can finalize a negative balance sale or not is a program option. Each of non-cash media key with Tender function may be programmed to prohibit Over-tendering and/or Short-tendering. 4. When a media is programmed to allow “Total” function, it can also be programmed with the “Drawer Open” or “Not Open” status on operating the key. 5. When the media keys are programmed with the validation-compulsory status, the drawer opens after the Validation Print operation. 6. When performing the Validation Print operation after entering sale total for each credit card company, the name of the credit card company is printed. -- Receipt Print Format -- (Cash Total) 7$; &$6+ (Cash Tender) 7$; 727$/ &$7(1' &+$1*( 10-26 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.46 Multi-Tendering 10.46 Multi-Tendering Short-tendering repeated multiple times by the same media (allowed only when the media key is programmed to allow short-tendering). OPERATION ([TXBL TL]) --- (|Quantity| [@/FOR]) |1st Amount Tendered| [MEDIA] (|Quantity| [@/FOR]) |2nd Amount Tendered| [MEDIA] Repeat if not yet finalized. NOTE: When the media keys are programmed with the validation-compulsory status, the drawer opens after the Validation Print operation. -- Receipt Print Format -- Multi-tendering by [AT/TL] key Change due, as the result of the 2nd amount tendered 7$; 727$/ &$7(1' &$7(1' &+$1*( 10.47 Split Tendering Short-tendering repeated multiple times by the different media keys (allowed only when the media keys are programmed to allow short-tendering). OPERATION Example 1) --- ([TXBL TL]) (|Quantity| [@/FOR]) |Check Amount Tendered| [CHK TND] |Cash Amount Tendered| [AT/TL] ... Check & Cash |Company Code| [CARD No.] [Chg] ... Check & Credit Card |Cash Amount Tendered| [AT/TL] [Chg] ... Check, Cash, & Charge Example 2) --- ([TXBL TL]) |Cash Amount Tendered| [AT/TL] [Chg] ... Cash & Charge NOTES: 1. In both MULTI-TENDERING and SPLIT TENDERING operations, the sale is finalized and a receipt is issued on reaching the sale total amount. 2. If a media key is depressed without an amount tender entry and the key is programmed to function as “Total” key, the sale is then finalized on that stage processing the balance at that moment into that media. 3. When the media keys are programmed with the validation-compulsory status, the drawer opens after the Validation Print operation. -- Receipt Print Format -7$; 727$/ &+(&. &$6+ 10-27 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) Sale transaction by the various cards such as credit card, etc. is executed via the EFT terminal. (1) CREDIT Authorization OPERATION Key Operation FIU Upper Row Display Sale Entry ([TXBL TL]) (Tendered Amount) (Max. 7 digits; Omissible if all the amount is paid, however depending on the program option) [CREDIT] SWIPE CARD ([C]) Pressing the [C] key at this point will restore the ECR to the condition being ready for the [CREDIT] key entry Card Slide PROCESSING (in case of no response from EFT) or (in case of decline) NO RESPONS DECLINE Response from the EFT terminal APPROVED ECR prints a Customer Receipt ECR prints a Store Receipt NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. At tendering in Foreign Currency, the EFT media cannot be used. Receipt post-Issue operation after finalizing a sale by the EFT is unavailable. Training Cashiers are unacceptable to the EFT terminal. When “PROCESSING” is displayed, none of the operations on the ECR are possible. EFT entry is also available to the partial payment to the received on account and charge posting transactions. 6. Issuance of the Store Receipt is selectable. 7. For the EFT function, do not perform any registration in Receipt OFF mode. 8. When manual issuance of store receipt has been programmed, the store receipt must be issued to perform next transaction or read/reset jobs. 10-28 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) (2) DEBIT Authorization OPERATION Key Operation FIU Upper Row Display Sale Entry ([TXBL TL]) (Tendered Amount) (Max. 7 digits; Omissible if all the amount is paid, however depending on the program option) [DEBIT] SWIPE CARD ([C]) Pressing the [C] key at this point will restore the ECR to the condition being ready for the [DEBIT] key entry Card Slide (in case of no response from EFT) NO RESPONS Response from the EFT terminal ENTER PIN# Input the Pin No. from the Pin Pad Then depress the [ENTER] key ECR wait condition PROCESSING NO RESPONS (in case of no response from EFT) or (in case of decline) DECLINE Response from the EFT terminal APPROVED ECR prints a Customer Receipt ECR prints a Store Receipt 10-29 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. At tendering in Foreign Currency, the EFT media cannot be used. Receipt post-Issue operation after finalizing a sale by the EFT is unavailable. Training Cashiers are unacceptable to the EFT terminal. When “PROCESSING” is displayed, none of the operations on the ECR are possible. EFT entry is also available to the partial payment to the received on account and charge posting transactions. 6. Issuance of the Store Receipt is selectable. 7. Validation Print operation after finalizing a sale transaction by the EFT is possible. 8. Finalization of the [DEBIT] key operation in - mode causes an error. (3) CREDIT/DEBIT Refund OPERATION [RTN MDSE] NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. to be continued to the top of “CREDIT/DEBIT Authorization” sequence Receipt post-Issue operation after finalizing a sale by the EFT is unavailable. Training Cashiers are unacceptable to the EFT terminal. Key operation on the ECR is unavailable during the inquiry to the host. Issuance of the Store Receipt is selectable. Validation Print operation after finalizing a sale transaction by the EFT is possible. During the Refund operation, finalizing operation by several EFT media keys should not be performed. (4) Manual Card Number Entry When the EFT terminal cannot read information contained in a card, the EFT approval entry will be executed by manually entering the card No. and the expiration date on the ECR. • EFT Media Key Entry Sales Item Entry [TXBL TL] [MANUAL CARD#] (|Tendered Amount|) Max. 7 digits NOTE 1 [EFT Media Key] NOTE 2 NOTES: |Card No.| [#] |Expiration Date| [#] Max. 25 digits NOTE 3 Max 4 digits; MM/YY (Omissible) 1. Entry of tendering amount is omissible if a customer pays all the amount. 2. EFT Media Key: [CREDIT] (except for the [DEBIT] key) 3. For the Card No. entry, entering 0 at the beginning of the card No. is valid. Example) When “00123” is entered, “00123” will be printed. 10-30 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) (5) Off Line Authorization When the EFT system is in trouble and down, the EFT can be finalized on the ECR. To obtain the authorization code of the EFT approval, you tell the customer’s card data and the amount of purchase to the EFT authorization company on the telephone. OPERATION Sales Item Entry [TXBL TL] or [FSTL TEND] [OFFLINE AUTH] Max. 7 digits NOTE 1 (|Authorization Code|) [#] [EFT Media Key] Max. 11 characters (Omissible) NOTE 2 NOTES: (|Tendered Amount|) 1. Entry of tendering amount is omissible if a customer pays all the amount. 2. EFT Media Key: [CREDIT], [DEBIT], [EBT CASH], [EBT F/S], [CHECK] 3. Before performing this operation, each EFT Media Key should be programmed with the statuses both “with EFT process” and “off line authorization is available”. Failure to do this may cause an error. 4. None of store receipt is issued by the Off Line Authorization operation. 5. In Off Line Authorization operation, the Manual Card No. entry is unavailable. 6. The OFF Line Authorization operation is not possible by cashiers with training status. 7. Values 0 to 9 and A to Z should be used to enter the Authorization Code. Keyboard layout at the Authorization Code entry The keyboard layout changes by the [EFT Media Key] depression as shown below. Accordingly, values 0 to 9 and A to Z can be entered as the Authorization Code. -- Ordinary Keyboard Type -# C E J O T Y D I N S X 7 8 9 C H M R W 4 5 6 B G L Q V 1 2 3 A F K P U 0 10-31 Z 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) -- Flat Keyboard Type -Q W E R T Y U I O A S D F G H J K L Z X C V B N M P # C 7 8 9 4 5 6 1 2 3 0 (6) Store Receipt This operation is used for manually issuing the store receipt. OPERATION [STORE RECEIPT] NOTES: 1. Journal print is not performed. 2. In case of the tendering operation (multi- or split-), the [STORE RECEIPT] key can be depressed at the same number of times as its operation. (Allowed up to 4 times) 3. None of store receipt is issued by the Off Line Authorization operation. 4. The [STORE RECEIPT] key should be programmed with the status “Issuance of store receipt is available.” in the EFT key status setting. Failure to do this may cause an error. 5. When the host responds decline, the Store Receipt operation causes an error, 10-32 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) (7) Cashing Authorization Cashing operation with a Debit card or EBT cash card is performed here. OPERATION Key Operation FIU Upper Row Display Amount to be cashed (Max. 7 digits) [DEBIT] (or [EBT CASH]) SWIPE CARD ([C]) Pressing the [C] key at this point will restore the ECR to the condition being ready for the [DEBIT] (or [EBT CASH]) key entry. Card Slide (in case of no response from EFT) NO RESPONS Response from the EFT terminal ENTER PIN# Input the Pin No. from the Pin Pad Then depress the [ENTER] key ECR wait condition PROCESSING NO RESPONS (in case of no response from EFT) or (in case of decline) DECLINE Response from the EFT terminal APPROVED ECR prints a Customer Receipt ECR prints a Store Receipt 10-33 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) • Manual Entry (only for [EBT CASH] key) [MANUAL CARD#] (|Tendered Amount|) [EBT CASH] Max. 7 digits NOTES: |Card No.| [#] (|Expiration Date|) [#] 8 to19 digits Max 4 digits: MM/YY 1. Before performing this operation, the [DEBIT] (or [EBT CASH]) key should be programmed with the status “no-purchase cashing is allowed”. Also each EFT Media Key should be programmed with the statuses both “with EFT process” and “off line authorization is available”. Failure to do this may cause an error. 2. For the EFT function, do not perform any registration in Receipt OFF mode. 3. Receipt post-Issue operation after the Cash-only Debit is unavailable. 4. Key operation on the ECR is unavailable during the inquiry to the host. 5. The Endorsement Print can be performed. 6. Training Cashiers are unacceptable to the EFT terminal. 7. Issuance of the Store Receipt is selectable. 8. When manual issuance of store receipt has been programmed, the store receipt must be issued to perform next transaction or read/reset jobs. 9. EFT Cashing Authorization operation with the [CREDIT], [CHECK], or [EBT F/S] key is not possible. (This operation in REG or MGR mode works as a no-sale cashing of a non-cash media.) 10-34 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) (8) EBT CASH, EBT F/S Purchase Purchase with an EBT cash card or EBT food stamp card is performed here. OPERATION Key Operation FIU Upper Row Display Sale Entry This operation is possible when the [EBT F/S] key is programmed with the status “food stamp payment”. ([TXBL TL]) [FS TL/TEND] (Tendered Amount) |Tendered Amount| (Max. 7 digits; Omissible if all the amount is paid, however depending on the program option.) [EBT CASH] Max. 7 digits (Must be entered) [EBT F/S] SWIPE CARD Card Slide ([C]) Pressing the [C] key at this point will restore the ECR to the condition being ready for the [EBT CASH] (or [EBT F/S]) key entry. (in case of no response from EFT) NO RESPONS Response from the EFT terminal ENTER PIN# Input the Pin No. from the Pin Pad then depress the [ENTER] key. PROCESSING (in case of no response from EFT) or (in case of decline) NO RESPONS DECLINE Response from the EFT terminal APPROVED ECR prints a Customer Receipt ECR prints a Store Receipt 10-35 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) • Manual Entry (when the [EBT CASH] or [EBT F/S] key has been programmed with the status “taxable total payment”.) ([TXBL TL]) Sales Entry [MANUAL CARD#] (|Sale Amount|) Max. 7 digits (Omissible) |Card No.| [#] (|Expiration Date|) [#] 8 to 19 digits Max. 4 digits; MM/YY (Omissible) [EBT CASH] ([EBT F/S]) • Manual Entry (when the [EBT F/S] key has been programmed with the status “food stamp payment”.) ([FS TL/TEND]) Sales Entry [MANUAL CARD#] (|Sale Amount|) [EBT F/S] Max. 7 digits NOTES: |Card No.| [#] (|Expiration Date|) [#] 8 to 19 digits Max. 4 digits; MM/YY (Omissible) 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. Receipt post-Issue operation after finalizing a sale by the EFT is unavailable. Key operation on the ECR is unavailable during the inquiry to the host. Contents of the customer receipt are printed on the journal, but those of the store receipt are not. Automatic issuance or manual issuance of the store receipt is selectable by the system option setting. Up to 4 times of Multi-tendering operation or Split-tendering operation is possible when finalizing a sale transaction by the EFT, however, the 5 times of the operation causes an error. At this time, the sale finalization operation is possible only when using the [AT/TL] key or the media keys with the status “without EFT process”. Sale finalization by the EFT is possible only when the media key has been programmed with the status “EFT media” in the EFT key status setting. If not, ordinary sale finalization is performed. Training cashiers are unacceptable to the EFT terminal. (Ordinary finalization operation can be performed.) Issuance of the store receipt is selectable by the EFT key status setting. When tendering in foreign currency, the EFT media keys are not accepted. For the EFT function, do not perform any registration in Receipt OFF mode. Multiplication operation for each media with the EFT media keys is not possible. When manual issuance of store receipt has been programmed, the store receipt must be issued to perform next transaction or read/reset jobs. Validation Print operation after finalizing a sale transaction by the EFT is possible. Negative balance sale causes an error. 10-36 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) (9) Check Authorization Sale finalization by a check via the EFT terminal is performed. OPERATION Key Operation FIU Upper Row Display Sale Entry ([TXBL TL]) (Tendered Amount) (Max. 7 digits; Omissible if all the amount is paid, however depending on the program option) [CHECK] SLIDE CHECK Check Slide ([C]) Pressing the [C] key at this point will restore the ECR to the condition being ready for the [CHECK] key entry. (in case of no response from EFT) or (in case of decline) PROCESSING NO RESPONS DECLINE Response from the EFT terminal APPROVED ECR prints a Customer Receipt 10-37 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) • Manual Entry Key Operation FIU Upper Row Display Sale Entry ([TXBL TL]) [MANUAL CARD#] MANUAL CD (Tendered Amount) (Max. 7 digits; Omissible if all the amount is paid, however depending on the program option) [CHECK] |Account No.| Pressing the [C] key at this point will restore the ECR to the condition being ready for the [CHECK] key entry. ENT ACCT NUMBER Max. 20 digits [#] |Routing No.| [C] ROUTING NO Max. 20 digits [#] CHECK NO |Check No.| Max. 10 digits [#] |State Code| STATE CODE 2 digits [#] PROCESSING (in case of no response from EFT) or (in case of decline) NO RESPONS DECLINE Response from the EFT terminal APPROVED ECR prints a Customer Receipt 10-38 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. It is possible to cancel this operation prior to the inquiry to the host (i.e. before the message “PROCESSING” is displayed). Customer receipt is printed, but store receipt is not. Check No. and Authorization code are printed on the endorsement. Training cashiers are unacceptable to the EFT terminal. (Ordinary finalization operation can be performed.) When they depress the [MANUAL CARD#] key at the manual entry, it results in an error. As the finalization of the [CHECK] key, only the Check Authorization is possible. (Return operation is not possible.) When negative balance sale is given in REG or MGR mode, the finalization of the [CHECK] key causes an error. Also, this operation causes an error in - mode. This operation is possible only when “check authorization” has been selected for the [CHECK] key function in the system option setting. 10-39 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) (10) Driver’s License Authorization Sale finalization by a driver’s license via the EFT terminal is performed. OPERATION Key Operation FIU Upper Row Display Sale Entry ([TXBL TL]) (Tendered Amount) (Max. 7 digits; Omissible if all the amount is paid, however depending on the program option) [CHECK] |License No.| Pressing the [C] key at this point will restore the ECR to the condition being ready for the [CHECK] key entry. LICENSE NUMBER Max. 20 digits (alphanumeric character) [#] [C] |State Code| STATE CODE 2 digits [#] BIRTHDATE |Date of Birth| 4 digits (MMYY) or 6 digits (MMDDYY) [#] PROCESSING (in case of no response from EFT) or (in case of decline) NO RESPONS DECLINE Response from the EFT terminal APPROVED ECR prints a Customer Receipt 10-40 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.48 Sale Finalization by EFT (Electronic Fund Transfer) NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. It is possible to cancel this operation prior to the inquiry to the host (i.e. before the message “PROCESSING” is displayed). Customer receipt is printed, but store receipt is not. License No. and Authorization code are printed on the endorsement. Training cashiers are unacceptable to the EFT terminal. (Ordinary finalization operation can be performed.) As the finalization of the [CHECK] key, only the Check Authorization is possible. (Return operation is not possible.) When negative balance sale is given in REG or MGR mode, the finalization of the [CHECK] key causes an error. Also, this operation causes an error in - mode. Date of birth can be entered with 3 digits (MYY) or 5 digits (MDDYY) also. Example: Entry of January 2000 … 100 [#] Entry of January 15, 2000 … 11500 [#] This operation is possible only when “driver’s license authorization” has been selected for the [CHECK] key function in the system option setting. 10-41 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.49 Check Cashing (No-sale cashing of a non-cash media) 10.49 Check Cashing (No-sale cashing of a non-cash media) This operation is performed when a check is changed with cash. OPERATION (Must be operated outside a sale) |Check Amount to be Cashed| [CHK TND] ... The drawer opens to enable the exchange. NOTES: 1. Other non-cash media keys may be used for this purpose if programmed to allow no-purchase cashing. 2. Post-issue receipt is not available after the Check Cashing operation. 3. When the media keys are programmed with the validation-compulsory status, the drawer opens after the Validation Print operation. Example) To encash the check for $10. 1000 [CHK TND] -- Receipt Print Format -- 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 6$7 Check Amount Cashed &+(&. -21(6 70 10.50 Sale Paid in Foreign Currencies OPERATION --- [TXBL TL] (or [ST]) Mandatory for a sale paid in foreign currencies. NOTES: [CUR1] Amount Tendered in [CUR1] Foreign Currency Displays the equivalent value in Foreign Currency 1. Display the entered foreign currency amount. Displays the domestic currency value equivalent to the tendered foreign currency. [AT/TL] Other media keys may be used if paid in that media. (The media key must be programmed to allow tendering in this case.) 1. The [CUR 2] to [CUR 5] keys operate the same as [CUR 1], except that each of these keys has its own exchange rate programmed corresponding to each foreign currency. 2. The amount tendered in the foreign currency and its exchange rate may be programmed to print by program options. 3. The foreign currency keys cannot be used to finalize Received-on-Account payments, Paid-out items, or charge posting (sale with previous balance). 4. When a tendering by a foreign currency occurs during a short-tendered condition, the [ST] key will not be mandatory. 5. A sale of zero or negative balance cannot be finalized using any of the foreign currency keys. 6. The sale finalization using the [FS TL/TEND] key is not possible. 7. The fraction process method at the currency exchange is fixed to Round OFF. -- Receipt Print Format -- Optional Print Amount Tendered in CUR1 CUR1 Exchange Rate 10-42 7$; 727$/ &85 &$7(1' &+$1*( ∗ 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.51 No-Sale Exchange from Foreign Currency to Domestic Currency 10.51 No-Sale Exchange from Foreign Currency to Domestic Currency Foreign currency amount is exchanged with equivalent domestic currency amount. OPERATION [CUR 1] (Must be operated outside a sale) |Amount of Foreign Currency 1 to be exchanged| [NS] ... The drawer opens to enable exchange. Displays the domestic currency amount equivalent to the entered foreign currency amount. NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. The [CUR 2] to [CUR 5] keys operate the same. The fraction process method is fixed to Round OFF. After the [CARD No.] key, the [CUR] key depression causes an error. On the validation after performing the No-Sale Exchange from Foreign Currency to Domestic Currency, the exchanged amount is printed. -- Receipt Print Format -Amount of CUR1 to be exchanged Exchange Rate (optional print) Domestic Currency amount equivalent to the CUR2 &85 &+$1*( ∗ 10.52 No-Sale Exchange from Domestic Currency to Foreign Currency Domestic currency amount is exchanged with equivalent foreign currency amount. OPERATION (Must be operated outside a sale) |Amount of Domestic Currency to be exchanged| [CUR 1] [NS] ... The drawer opens to enable exchange. The display content of the CUR 1 value obtained on the [CUR 1] key depression is held. NOTES: 1. The [CUR 2] to [CUR 5] keys operate the same. 2. This operation (exchange from domestic to foreign currencies) may be prohibited by a program option. 3. The fraction process method is ruled by “Foreign Currency Rounding Process Setting”. 4. After the [CARD No.] key, the [CUR] key depression causes an error. 5. On the validation after performing the No-Sale Exchange from Domestic Currency to Foreign Currency, the exchanged amount is printed. -- Receipt Print Format -Domestic Currency amount to be exchanged Exchange Rate of CUR3 (optional print) CUR1 amount equivalent to the domestic currency amount 10-43 &$7(1' &85 ∗ 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.53 Received-on-Account 10.53 Received-on-Account A received-on-account transaction is used to identify money which is in the drawer but not relating to a sale. OPERATION |Amount of Payment| [R/A] |Cash Amount Tendered| [AT/TL] ([ST]) (if paid in cash) Repeatable if multiple amounts are received in one receipt sequence. (|Quantity| [@/FOR]) |Check Amount Tendered| [CHK TND] (if paid in check) [Chg] (if processed into charge account) Other Media Finalization This portion is the same as SALE FINALIZATION BY MEDIA KEYS already described. NOTES: 1. The media keys used for this operation must be programmed to allow received-on-account entries. 2. MULTI-TENDERING and SPLIT-TENDERING (already described) are also applied to the finalization of received-on-account payments. 3. The All Void operation is not possible during a Received-on-Account transaction. 4. When the media keys to be used for sale finalization are programmed with the validation-compulsory status, the drawer opens after the Validation Print operation. -- Receipt Print Format -5$ 5$ 68%7/ &$6+ -21(6 70 10.54 Paid-Out A paid-out transaction is used when money is removed from the drawer without totaling to a sale. OPERATION (Must be operated outside a sale) |Amount to be paid out| [PO] [AT/TL] ([ST]) Repeatable if multiple amounts to be paid out are recorded in one receipt sequence. NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. Only [AT/TL] can finalize paid-out amounts (i.e. must always be paid out in cash). The All Void operation is not possible during a Paid-Out transaction. Post-issue receipt is not available after the Paid-Out operation. If the [AT/TL] key is programmed with the validation-compulsory status, the Validation Print operation is not compulsory at the Paid-Out operation. -- Receipt Print Format -32 32 68%7/ 727$/ -21(6 10-44 70 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.55 Salesperson Entry (Salesperson Sign-ON) 10.55 Salesperson Entry (Salesperson Sign-ON) This operation is used for performing sales management of each salesperson. OPERATION |Salesperson Code| [SALES PERSON] --- 1 to 99 ... The name of the person is displayed and printed on both journal and receipt. Programmable options relating to Salesperson Entries: • Salesperson’s name non-print on receipt (print on journal only) • Salesperson Entry compulsory before sale item entries • Salesperson Entry Prohibited during a sale (i.e. allowed only one person entry at the starting of a sale but prohibits any other salesperson entry once the sale is started.) When this program option is not selected, up to five salespersons can sign-ON during one sale. The salesperson entry status (salesperson Signed-ON condition) will be held until: • Another salesperson entry is operated, or • The sale is finalized. NOTE: After a Salesperson Entry, the mode change is prohibited. -- Receipt Print Format - 6WDF\ Salesperson’s Name Salesperson Code 10.56 Hold & Recall You can interrupt one customer’s transaction with other customer’s transaction. OPERATION Sales item entries for Customer A [HOLD/RECALL] Operate sale item entries and finalize for Customer B. Temporary finalization of Customer A Sale (HOLD) [HOLD/RECALL] Additional entries if any and real sale finalization for Customer A. Recalling Customer A Sale (RECALL) Sale for Customer B Sale for Customer A (HOLD) 68%7/ +2/' ∗∗ -21(6 ∗∗ 70 '3 '3 7$; &$6+ ,7(0 -21(6 7) 7) 70 Sale for Customer A (RECALL) 5(&$// ∗∗ 7$; &$6+ ,7(0 -21(6 1. The All Void operation is not possible during a Hold transaction. 2. After a Hold operation, the mode change, Sign-OUT, and Sign-OFF are not possible. 10-45 ∗∗ The same Receipt Consecutive No. NOTES: 70 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.57 Credit Card No. Check 3. The Recall operation is not possible after a Hold operation or during sales item entry. After the sales finalization, the Recall operation is possible. 4. When a customer is being held, after the sales transaction is finalized, a buzzer tone generates twice. 5. When the Recall operation is performed for a sales transaction being held, the All Void operation is not possible for this sales transaction. (The Void operation is possible.) 6. During a Hold, Total-only type Post-issue Receipt can be issued. 7. The Validation Print operation is not possible after depressing the [HOLD/RECALL] key. 10.57 Credit Card No. Check --- [CARD CHK] |Number printed on the card| --- Max. 19 digits |Check No.| Max 15 digits This operation is allowed at the top of a sale or any time during a sale including while a sale is being finalized, or a received-on-account transaction is being operated. When an error results, the operator calls the manager. The manager then can select one of the following solutions: 1. Tells the customer that the card cannot be accepted referring to the displayed status code. (Or, lets the operator do so without calling the manager.) 2. To allow payment by this card as an exceptional case for some reason, depress the [C] key to clear the error, then turn the Mode Lock to “MGR” position using the MA key, and depress the [CARD CHK] key. The card No. is then accepted and printed. NOTES: 1. The card check function is activated in the REG mode only; in MGR or - mode, the card No. entry is accepted without an inquiry to the “Card No. Negative Check List”. Please also note that the card check function can be set to “active” or “non-active” in the MGR mode (described in Manager’s Guide.) 2. It is programmable to prohibit finalizing a sale before the card check operation by programming the compulsory card check to each media key. 10.58 Receipt Post-Issue OPERATION (Must be operated outside a sale) (A sale is finalized) [RECEIPT ISSUE] Programmable options: • Post-issue receipt is available only when the sale has been finalized with Receipt-OFF mode. • Available regardless of Receipt-ON/OFF mode (in this case two receipts may be obtained for one sale.) • Post-issue receipt is itemized receipt for a sale of maximum 50 lines. Exceeding 50 lines, the post-issue receipt is total-only receipt. • Post-issue receipt is always total-only receipt regardless of the number of lines of a sale. • Post-issue receipt is issued only once. • Post-issue receipt can be issued any number of times. NOTES: 1. The post-issue receipt content will not be printed on the Remote Slip Printer. 2. The post-issue receipt is not available for Paid-Out transactions. 10-46 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.59 Charge Posting: Previous Balance Manual Entry Type 3. The program option allows you to select that the post-issue receipt operation is available for the Received-on-Account transaction, the Charge Posting transaction and the Hold & Recall transaction. However, when the Charge Posting transaction is finalized by the [PO] key, the postissue receipt operation cannot be unconditionally performed. 4. The Validation Print operation is not possible after performing the post-issue receipt operation. Itemized Type -- Ordinary Receipt - 6$7 9(*(7$%/( [ 7RPDWR 68%7/ 7$; 727$/ &$7(1' &+$1*( ,7(0 -21(6 7) # 6$7 7) 70 ∗∗ &23< 9(*(7$%/( [ 7RPDWR 68%7/ 7$; 727$/ &$7(1' &+$1*( ,7(0 -21(6 -- Post-issue Receipt -Total-only Type 6$7 ∗∗ 7) # 7) 727$/ -21(6 70 70 This line is printed only when a post-issue receipt is issued after the Ordinary Receipt is issued, or the second and subsequent postissue receipts are issued. 10.59 Charge Posting: Previous Balance Manual Entry Type OPERATION (1) To initiate charge posting for a new customer 0 [PB+] (or [PB-]) Follow the line marked with “*” in Operation 2 below. zero (2) Charge posting with a previous balance first entered (pre-select) with or without PAYMENT [PB+] (for credit balance) * Sale item |Previous Balance| [PB-] (for debit balance) entries, if any. ([TXBL TL]) Displays the sale total excluding the previous balance. [Chg] Finalizes the current sale, displays the entire sale total including the previous balance. [TRF] ......... to transfer all the balance as a new balance (i.e. no payment for this occasion). The prior [Chg] key may be omitted in this case. |Amount Paid for this occasion| [R/A] Media Key operations (Same as media key operations for RECEIVED-ON -ACCOUNT payment finalization already described.) (The amount to be paid, partially or entirely, for this occasion. An excessive amount may be entered, in which case a debit balance will result.) Repeatable if necessary. [PO] ........... when the balance is negative (debit balance) and must be paid back to the customer in cash now. 10-47 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.59 Charge Posting: Previous Balance Manual Entry Type (3) Charge posting with a previous balance entered during a sale (post-select) A previous balance (including a zero balance for a new customer) may be entered not only before sale items but also after or between them if the [Chg] key has not been depressed. Multiple previous balance entries are possible within a sale (for the purpose to sum up multiple accounts into one, etc.). (4) Percent rate addition to a previous balance |Previous Balance| [PB+] (|Rate|) [%+] NOTES: --- 1. The [%-] key operates the same for percent discounting. 2. The previous balance entered through [PB-] (debit balance) will not allow %+ or %- operation. 3. When the last key is programmed with the validation-compulsory status, the drawer opens after the Validation Print operation. Charge Posting Operation Sample (Previous Balance Manual Entry Type) OPERATION CONTENTS DISPLAY (Lower Row) KEY OPERATION To open a new customer account: Sale Items: $3,50 Dept.1 $2,40 Dept.3 Finalize this sale. To transfer all the balance without payment. The above customer comes to the store for payment. All his balance is read. He will pay all the balance today. He tenders $7,00 in cash. The balance of the customer is now zero. Give the change to the customer in cash. 0 [PB+] 350 [DEPT 1] 240 [DEPT 3] ([Chg]) [TRF] (See Receipt 1 below.) 623 [PB+] (previous balance) [Chg] 623 [R/A] 700 [AT/TL] (See Receipt 2 below.) 0 0 1 3 0. 0 0 3. 2. 6. 6. 5 4 2 2 0 0 3 3 6. 2 3 6. 6. 0. 2 2 7 3 3 7 -- Receipt Print Format -- Receipt 1 Receipt 2 7(& 6725( 7(& 6725( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 6$7 3% '3 9(*(7$%/( 7$; &KJ 1(: %$/ ,7(0 -21(6 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( New Balance is transferred as PB. 7) 7) 6$7 3% 10-48 &KJ 5$ &$7(1' &+$1*( 1(: %$/ ,7(0 -21(6 70 70 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.60 Charge Posting: Customer File Type (Check Track Memory Option) 10.60 Charge Posting: Customer File Type (Check Track Memory Option) OPERATION (1) To initiate charge posting for a new customer |Customer File Code| [PICK UP BAL] (Must be one of those already opened in the “SET” mode and its balance must be zero.) Follow the line marked with “*” in Operation 2 below. |New Customer File Code| [CODE OPEN] (any 1 to 12-digit code not yet opened in the “SET” mode) ... (The use of [CODE OPEN] may require a Manager Intervention.) (2) Charge posting with a previous balance first entered (pre-select) with or without Payment * Sale item entries, if any. |Customer File Code| [PICK UP BAL] ([TXBL TL]) Displays the sale total excluding the previous balance. [Chg] Finalizes the current sale, displays the entire sale total including the previous balance. [TRF] ......... to transfer all the balance as a new balance (i.e. no payment for this occasion). The prior [Chg] key may be omitted in this case. |Amount Paid for this occasion| [R/A] Media Key operations (Same as media key operations for RECEIVED-ON -ACCOUNT payment finalization already described.) (The amount to be paid, partially or entirely, for this occasion. An excessive amount may be entered, in which case a debit balance will result.) Repeatable if necessary. [PO] ........... when the balance is negative (debit balance) and must be paid back to the customer in cash now. (3) Charge posting with a previous balance entered during a sale (post-select) A previous balance recalled through [PICK UP BAL] (or a zero balance by [PICK UP BAL] or [CODE OPEN]) may be entered not only before sale items but also after or between them if the [CRT] key has not been depressed. But, this operation is allowed only once in a sale. (4) Percent rate addition to a previous balance |Customer File Code| [PICK UP BAL] NOTES: (|Rate|) [%+] --- 1. The [%-] key operates the same for percent discounting. 2. When the balance recalled is negative (debit balance), neither %+ nor %- can be operated. 10-49 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.60 Charge Posting: Customer File Type (Check Track Memory Option) Charge Posting Operation Sample (Check Track Memory Option) OPERATION CONTENTS DISPLAY (Lower Row) KEY OPERATION Mr. JAMES HAILY comes and you start charge posting for him. Sale Items: $1,20 Dept.1 $3,50 Dept.3 Finalize this sale. To transfer all the balance without payment. Mr. JAMES HAILY now comes to pay all his account balance. He tenders $10,00 in cash. The balance is now zero due to the payment. Give the change to the customer in cash. 1 [PICK UP BAL] 0 0 120 [DEPT 1] 350 [DEPT 3] ([Chg]) [TRF] (See Receipt 1 below.) 1 [PICK UP BAL] [Chg] 488 [R/A] 1000 [AT/TL] (See Receipt 2 below.) 1 3 0. 0 0 1. 3. 4. 4. 2 5 8 8 0 0 8 8 4. 4. 4. 5. 8 8 8 1 8 8 8 2 -- Receipt Print Format -- Receipt 1 Receipt 2 7(& 6725( 7(& 6725( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 6$7 Customer File Code Customer’s Name & Balance 3% -$0(6 +$,/< 9(*(7$%/( 7$; &KJ '3 1(: %$/ ,7(0 -21(6 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 6$7 3% 7) 7) -$0(6 +$,/< &KJ 5$ &$7(1' &+$1*( 1(: %$/ ,7(0 -21(6 70 10-50 70 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.61 Function Key Entry 10.61 Function Key Entry This operation will execute a string of key operations preprogrammed on each [FUNCTION] key. OPERATION --- -- Receipt Print Format -[FUNCTION] ( --- ) 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( [FUNCTION 1] to [FUNCTION 10] • 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ The following key operations are preprogrammed on the [FUNCTION 1] key in this example. [1] [00] [DP1] [ST] [AT/TL] 6$7 '3 68%7/ &$6+ ,7(0 -21(6 7) 70 10.62 Endorsement Print OPERATION After operating the required non-cash media key (usually the [CHK TND] key) Insert the check or the required slip into Remote Slip Printer Enter the check No. (Max. 15 digits) (if so the programmed), and then depress [CHECK NO.] key. NOTES: 1. The Check No. entry prior to the [CHECK NO.] key may be programmed to be compulsory. 2. Endorsement print performed after the received-on-account transaction is available. 3. When the validation-compulsory status is activated, the Endorsement print is possible after performing the Validation Print. -- Endorsement Print Sample -- Printed on Remote Slip Printer: 6$7 9(*(7$%/( 68%7/ 7;%/ 7/ 7$; 727$/ &+(&. &+$1*( '3 '3 ,7(0 -21(6 7) 7) 7) 7( 7(&& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( /,9(5322/ (1*/$1' 727$/ &+(&. &/ 70 70 10-51 Check No. Line Endorsement Message Lines Total Line (may not be printed) Check Amount Line Cashier ID, Consecutive No., Date, Time 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.63 Comment Print 10.63 Comment Print OPERATION Print of the programmed message |Comment Message Code| [COMMENT] .............. Programmed message corresponding to the designated 1 to 10 code is printed on the receipt and the remote slip. Print of a message using character code entry [COMMENT] Character Code Entry [COMMENT] .................. Message entered by character code is printed on the receipt and the remote slip. (Max. 32 characters; 2-digit code is assigned to each character as shown on the table below.) Example) Character code “00” is assigned to “SPACE”. Character code “34” is assigned to “B”. NOTES: 1. This operation is available any time outside a sale or inside a sale including during the short tendering condition, however except the following. During the Loan transaction During the Pick Up transaction During the Paid Out transaction 2. Neither the Item Correct transaction nor the Validation Print is effective for this operation. 10-52 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.64 Sale Finalization by EBT (Electronic Benefit Transfer) 10.64 Sale Finalization by EBT (Electronic Benefit Transfer) OPERATION Entry for customer’s receipt (1st Receipt) • Using the EBT Card (for Food Stamp) When all the amount is paid by EBT Card Sales Item Entry [FS TL/TEND] [DISPLAY 1] (|Food Stamp Tendered Amount|) The message “EBT AUTH” is displayed, and the sale finalization process is automatically performed as the EBT Card sale. • Using the Debit Card, Check, Credit Card and Cash EBT Card During short tendering condition Sales Item Entry When all the amount is paid by one media [TXBL TL] [DISPLAY 2] [DISPLAY 3] [DISPLAY 4] [DISPLAY 5] (|Media Tendered Amount|) The message “DEBIT AUTH” is displayed, and the sale finalization process is automatically performed as the Debit Card sale. The message “CHECK AUTH” is displayed, and the sale finalization process is automatically performed as the Check sale. The message “CREDIT AUTH” is displayed, and the sale finalization process is automatically performed as the Credit Card sale. The message “CASH EBT” is displayed, and the sale finalization process is automatically performed as the Cash EBT Card sale. Entry for store’s receipt (2nd Receipt) After the 1st receipt is issued [DISPLAY 6] The message “RECEIPT” is displayed, and the 2nd receipt (Receipt for store; Copy) is issued. NOTES: 1. Do not operate the keys on the keyboard until the 1st receipt (Receipt for customer) is issued. 2. This operation is available for the Received-on-Account transaction and the partial payment on the Charge Posting transaction. 3. As for the journal print, only the content of the 1st receipt is printed. 4. When the Validation Print or the Endorsement Print is necessary, perform it after the 1st receipt is issued. Neither the Validation Print nor the Endorsement Print can be performed after the 2nd receipt is issued. 10-53 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.65 Validation Print 10.65 Validation Print After performing each registering operation, insert a validation slip into the validation slot of the slip printer, confirm the PAPER OUT lamp on the slip printer is off, then depress the [VALIDATE] key to perform a validation print. OPERATION After entering the required item through a transaction key or media key. NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. Insert a validation slip into the validation slot. [VALIDATE] The following options are selectable. 1) Print/Non-print selection Date print/non-print, consecutive No. print/non-print, cashier No. print/non-print, terminal No. print/non-print, and time print/non-print are selectable. 2) Multi-validation function 3) Total validation function When depressing the declaration key, numeric key, or point key, the Validation Print causes an error. The Validation Print is possible after depressing the [#] or [NS] key. The validation compulsory status is programmable on each key by the key status setting. When the validation compulsory status after the issuance of the long receipt is activated, the Validation Print is performed then the drawer opens. When the total validation function is not selected, the Validation Print after the [EX] key depression causes an error. The subtotal amount is printed on the validation after performing the All Void operation. The Validation Print operation is not possible by cashiers with training status. The tendered amount is printed on the validation after tendering food stamps. When the taxable total display by the [ST] key depression has been programmed, not the taxable total amount but the subtotal amount is printed. While the entered data is printed by the slip printer, if you want to perform a validation print, press the RELEASE key of the slip printer to replace the slip with the validation slip, then depress the [VALIDATE] key. Characters of character codes 1007, 1206, 1207, 1211, 1500 through 1503, 1506 through 1514 VXFK DV , Œ, œ, , , kg, lb, No, ×, , are not printed on the validation slip. The name and amount of the head-link PLU are printed on the validation slip after performing the link PLU entry. -:8;9 10-54 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.66 Remote Slip Printer (hardware option) Operation 10.66 Remote Slip Printer (hardware option) Operation The Remote Slip Printer TM-U295 (EPSON printer) may be connected to the ECR as an optional device. The Remote Slip Printer will operate printing if a slip is properly inserted, regardless of the Mode Lock position (except that no print will occur in the “SET” mode or during program verification in the “X” mode). 1. The remote slip printer will automatically activate printing when the slip has properly been set to the printer table. 2. The following are selective status programmable relating to the remote slip printer. Ask the store manager and mark the status selected for your store. PROGRAM OPTIONS RELATING TO REMOTE SLIP CONTROL • Remote Slip Print compulsory for any Previous Balance entry in “REG” or “MGR” mode: Standard: FREE (Not compulsory) Option: COMPULSORY (applies to any Previous Balance entry whether it is the Manual PB Entry type or the Customer File (Check Track) Memory type. • Code No. (Check No.) Entry Before [CHECK NO.] key at Endorsement Print (Refer to ENDORSEMENT PRINT operation already stated.) Standard: FREE (Not compulsory) Option: COMPULSORY 3. The gap of the slip inlet is usually opened, and the slip may be inserted or withdrawn freely outside a receipt/journal print sequence. When a slip is properly set to the remote slip printer and the ECR is operated, the gap will be closed and printing will be performed. When the sale is finalized and the receipt is issued, the gap of the Remote Slip Printer will be opened to allow the slip withdrawal. (The gap keeps closed during sale item entries.) 4. The RELEASE key on the TM-U295 may be used to open the closed gap in order to withdraw the slip and skip unnecessary item print. 5. Printing on the remote slip will be performed alternately with printing on the receipt/journal of the ECR. 6. When the remote slip print is compulsory, the slip printer OFF status or the disconnection of the cable causes a SLIP OFFLINE error. During the error, the [ITEM CORR] key depression results in that the slip printer connection check message is displayed. At this time, the [ITEM CORR] key depression again results in that the slip printer is disconnected, however, the [C] key depression results in that the slip printer remains connected. 7. When the remote slip print (or endorsement print) is compulsory, the [VALIDATE] or [CHECK NO.] key depression may cause a SLIP OFFLINE error or SLIP PAPER OUT error. At this time, the compulsion status is canceled by performing one of the following operations, and you can proceed to the registering operation. (a) [ITEM CORR] key → [ITEM CORR] key • Depress the [ITEM CORR] key if you want to cancel the compulsion status. At this time, the confirmation message “COMP CANCEL?” is displayed. • Depress the [ITEM CORR] key again to perform the cancellation. • The cancellation continues during a sale transaction. (b) [ITEM CORR] key → [C] key • When the confirmation message “COMP CANCEL?” is displayed, if you do not want to perform the cancellation, depress the [C] key. (c) [C] key • Depress the [C] key to clear the error message. After clearing the error, the Validation Print operation or the Endorsement Print operation is possible by depressing the [VALIDATE] or [CHECK NO.] key. 8. Characters of character codes 1007, 1206, 1207, 1211, 1500 through 1503, 1506 through 1514 such as Ë, Œ, œ, ∅, →, ←, ↓, ↑, ×, ¯, kg, lb, No, ×, ∇, ∆ are not printed on the validation slip. 10-55 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.66 Remote Slip Printer (hardware option) Operation As typical application of remote slip printing, print formats of invoice and Charge Posting Customer Sale File are placed below. -- Invoice Print Format -- 6$7 9(*(7$%/( [ # 'ULQN 6PDOO% [ # 6PDOO%WO 'HSR↑ 68%7/ &$6+ ,7(0 -21(6 9(*(7$%/( # 'ULQN 6PDOO% # 6PDOO%WO 'HSR 68%7/ &$6+ 7) 7 ,7(0 -21(6 7) 7 70 70 -- Charge Posting Sale File Print Format (PB Manual Entry Type) -1 6$7 3% '3 9(*(7$%/( 7$; &KJ 9(*(7$%/( 7$; &KJ 7) 7) 1(: %$/ ,7(0 -21(6 3% '3 1(: %$/ ,7(0 3% 70 6$7 -21(6 3% 7RPDWR &KJ 3% 3% 7) 1(: %$/ ,7(0 -21(6 ,7(0 70 6$7 3% &KJ 5$ &$6+ 1(: %$/ ,7(0 -21(6 70 10-56 7) -21(6 70 &KJ 5$ &$6+ 1(: %$/ ,7(0 3 70 1(: %$/ 7RPDWR &KJ 2 7) 7) -21(6 70 10. REGISTERING PROCEDURE AND PRINT FORMAT EO1-11152 10.67 When a Power Failure Occurs... 10.67 When a Power Failure Occurs... If a power failure occurs, all sales data stored in the memory are automatically protected by the battery installed in the ECR. The battery is rechargeable and it is recharged when the AC power returns. As the power returns, the ECR revives to continue the work and displays the last item entered before the power failure. However, please note the following phenomena to occur on the ECR when the power is regained: 1. The printer will work to print the entered data without failure after the power recovery, if any data was being printed. However, one extra line may be fed on the power recovery depending on the power-recovery timing. 2. The following are the display indications on the power recovery: ECR CONDITION at the time of Power Failure DISPLAY INDICATION on the Power Recovery OUTSIDE A SALE No key-in has been operated. Numeric or Declaration keys have been entered but not motorized keys. DURING A SALE No Numeric or Declaration keys have been entered. Numeric or Declaration keys have been entered. Displays zero. Operations may go on. Regains the display content that was obtained just before the power failure. The operations may be continued. Regains the display content that was obtained just before the power failure. The operations may be continued. In case a power failure occurred during printing, after the power recovery, a line of “*****” is printed on the receipt, then whole contents will be printed. Example: -- Receipt Print Format -- 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 6$7 '3 '3 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 6$7 '3 '3 '3 '3 '3 &$6+ ,7(0 -21(6 70 10-57 11. JOURNAL AND RECEIPT PAPER-END DETECTOR EO1-11152 11. JOURNAL AND RECEIPT PAPER-END DETECTOR 11. JOURNAL AND RECEIPT PAPER-END DETECTOR (1) This detects when either the journal or receipt paper is coming near the end. It is provided in order to prompt the operator to replace the old paper roll with a new one. (2) When the paper roll is out (or the paper has not been set properly), no key operation will be accepted and the front display will indicate “PAPER END”. (3) When a new paper roll is set, only the [C] key is allowed to operate. Next, when the [C] key is depressed, the error message “PAPER END” will be cleared and normal key-in operations will be accepted. If any printing was suspended, it will continue printing. (4) If this detector senses a paper-end condition during printing, the printing will stop after the current line printing is completed. (5) If the [C] key is depressed in the paper-end condition, it will be ignored. The [C] key depression will be effective to clear the error message only after the new paper roll is set. (For further details, refer to Chapter 6.) 12. ECR PRINTER MOTOR LOCK DETECTOR (1) This detects the printer motor lock condition caused by some trouble. (2) When such a condition is detected, the front display indicates “PRINTER ERROR” and none of the keys (including [RF] and [JF]) will be accepted. (3) To regain the normal condition, turn the power of the ECR to OFF, remove the cause of the motor lock, and then turn the power to ON again. 11- 1 13. REMOTE SLIP PRINTER MOTOR LOCK DETECTOR EO1-11152 13. REMOTE SLIP PRINTER MOTOR LOCK DETECTOR 13. REMOTE SLIP PRINTER MOTOR LOCK DETECTOR (1) This detects the remote slip printer motor lock condition caused by some trouble. (2) When such a condition is detected, the front display indicates “SLIP OFF LINE” and none of the keys (including [RF] and [JF]) will be accepted. (3) To regain the normal condition, turn the powers of the ECR and the remote slip printer to OFF, remove the cause of the motor lock, and then turn the powers to ON again. * If the cause cannot be found in the remote slip printer and only the ECR may be required to work temporarily without the remote slip printer, remove the remote printer cable from the ECR, and turn the power of the ECR to ON. 14. PRINTER HEAD OPEN DETECTOR (1) This detects the printer head open condition. (2) When such a condition is detected, the front display indicates “Error” and none of the keys (including [RF] and [JF]) will be accepted. (3) To regain the normal condition, turn the power of the ECR to OFF, close the printer guide, and then turn the power to ON again. 13- 1 15. GENERAL MAINTENANCE EO1-11152 15.1 Cleaning the Covers 15. GENERAL MAINTENANCE WARNING! 1. DO NOT POUR WATER directly onto the ECR, as this may cause electric shock or fire. 2. The Journal Take-up Motor becomes very hot while printing. To avoid getting burned, never touch the Journal Take-up Motor. CAUTION! Never use an organic solvent like thinners or benzene for cleaning. Using such solvents may discolor the cover. 15.1 Cleaning the Covers Wipe the covers with a soft dry cloth slightly moistened with mild detergent. After using detergent for cleaning, be sure to wipe it off with a slightly moistened cloth. 15.2 Removing Jammed Paper 1) Turn the power OFF. 2) Open the Receipt Frame Cover Ass’y. If Receipt Frame Cover Ass’y will not open because of paper jam, turn knob until pin appears in opening by triangle. Pin Knob 3) Remove the jammed paper. DO NOT USE any sharp implement or tool as these will damage the printer. 4) Re-load the receipt roll. (Refer to Section 6.1 Installing/Replacing the Receipt/Journal Roll.) 15.3 Clearing the Cutter Error When the display indicates “CUTTER ERROR”, clear this error by following procedure below. 1) Turn the power OFF. 2) Turn the power ON. 3) Depress the [C] key. 15- 1 15. GENERAL MAINTENANCE EO1-11152 15.4 Manual Drawer Release and Lock 15.4 Manual Drawer Release and Lock WARNING! When opening the cash drawer, be careful not to let the drawer hit any person. The drawer opens automatically when a registration is performed. In the event of a power failure or other trouble, the drawer can be opened manually in the following manner: Releasing 1) Remove the CDC Cap. 2) Insert the Drawer Release Key into the Drawer Release Lock, then turn the key clockwise. The drawer will now open. The Drawer Release Key can be taken out by returning it to the original position. Locking When the drawer is closed, it is automatically locked and will not open without the Drawer Release Key or transaction entries. 15.5 Removing the Drawer 1) Pull the drawer out, and when it stops by the stopper, lift the drawer up and pull it again. 2) When it stops again by the roller fixed in the drawer case, lift it and pull it again. 15- 2 15. MAINTENANCE OPERATIONS EO1-11152 15.6 Media Slot 15.6 Media Slot The Media Slot provided at the front of the drawer is used to put non-cash media such as check in the drawer without opening it. The non-cash media put from this slot are kept under the Money Case, therefore you can keep them in secret. Media Slot Non-cash media are kept here. Money Case 15.7 CDC (Cash Drawer Cover; Option) Lock Locking 1) Push the Cash Drawer Cover to the back of the drawer. 2) Press the cover lightly, insert the key into the key hole on the cover, and turn it 90° clockwise. Unlocking Unlock the cover using the key, and lift the front end. 15- 3 16. SPECIFICATIONS EO1-11152 16. SPECIFICATIONS 16. SPECIFICATIONS Size ........................................................ 460 mm (width) x 430 mm (depth) x 350 mm (height) (height including rubber feet) Weight ................................................... 15.0 kg Power Required .................................... AC 117 V ±10 %; 60 Hz (varies depending on the destination) Power Consumed ................................. 0.6 A at 117 V Ambient Temperature .......................... 0 °C to 40 °C, 10% to 90% Relative Humidity Size of Receipt and Journal Tape ...... Width: Thickness: Outside dimension: Recommended thermal paper: 16- 1 57.5 ± 0.5 mm 0.06 mm to 0.075 mm 83 mm or less KF50 (KANZAN) TF50KS-E2C (Nippon Paper Industries) P350 (KSP) 2. STAND-ALONE LEVEL MANAGER’S GUIDE EO1-11152 MA-1595-1 SERIES TABLE OF CONTENTS Page 1. DAILY OPERATION FLOW -------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1- 1 2. MANAGER INTERVENTION------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2- 1 2.1 2.2 Items Programmed to Require Manager Interventions ------------------------------------------ 2- 1 Other Operations Required Manager Interventions ---------------------------------------------- 2- 3 3. MANAGER’S OWN OPERATIONS IN “MGR” MODE --------------------------------------- 3- 1 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 Pick Up Operation ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3- 1 Enforced Sign-OFF of a Cashier (Code Entry Method)------------------------------------------ 3- 2 Post Authorization Operation -------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3- 3 EBT F/S Electronic Voucher Purchase -------------------------------------------------------------- 3- 4 EBT CASH, EBT F/S Balance Inquiry --------------------------------------------------------------- 3- 6 4. OPERATIONS IN “ - ” MODE ----------------------------------------------------------------------- 4- 1 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 4.6 Ordinary Operations In “ - ” Mode -------------------------------------------------------------------- 4- 1 Charge Posting With Customer File (Check Track Memory) In “ - ” Mode------------------ 4- 1 Scale Item Entry In “ - ” Mode ------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4- 3 Electronic Fund Transfer (EFT) Operation In “ - “ Mode ---------------------------------------- 4- 3 Prohibitive Operations In “ - ” Mode ------------------------------------------------------------------ 4- 7 Manager Intervention Required Status or Amount Limit In “ - ” Mode------------------------ 4- 7 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS------------------------------------------------------------ 5- 1 5.1 5.2 Combination Reports ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 5- 4 General Notes On Report Takings ------------------------------------------------------------------- 5- 4 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS ------------------------------------------------------------------- 6- 1 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 6.5 6.6 6.7 6.8 6.9 6.10 6.11 6.12 6.13 6.14 6.15 6.16 6.17 6.18 6.19 6.20 6.21 6.22 Basic Key Functions and Keyboard Variations in Programming Operations --------------- 6- 2 Character Entries ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6- 4 Condition Required for Programming Operations------------------------------------------------- 6- 8 Store Name Message and Commercial Message Programming (Submode 1) ------------ 6- 9 Cashier Code and Name Programming (Submode 2) ------------------------------------------ 6-11 PLU Table Programming (Submode 4)------------------------------------------------------------- 6-13 Time Setting or Adjustment (Submode 5)---------------------------------------------------------- 6-24 Date Setting or Adjustment (Submode 6) ---------------------------------------------------------- 6-25 Amount Limit Setting for Function Keys (Submode 8) ------------------------------------------ 6-25 Customer File Code (Check Track No.) and Name Setting (Submode 15) ---------------- 6-26 Salesperson Code and Name Programming (Submode 20) ---------------------------------- 6-28 Link-PLU Table Programming (Submode 25)----------------------------------------------------- 6-29 Tare Table and General Unit Weight Setting (Submode 26) ---------------------------------- 6-30 PLU Preset-Code Key Setting (Submode 27)----------------------------------------------------- 6-32 Display Message Programming (Submode 31)--------------------------------------------------- 6-35 Negative Amount Key Limit Amount Setting (Submode 35) ----------------------------------- 6-37 PLU Price Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Amount Setting (Submode 40) ------------------ 6-38 Department Preset Price Setting or Changing ---------------------------------------------------- 6-39 PLU Preset Price Setting or Changing, Whole Package Quantity Changing -------------- 6-40 %+ and %- Preset Rate Setting ---------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-41 Preset Rate Setting for Selective Itemizers (SI1 and SI2) ------------------------------------- 6-42 Foreign Currency Exchange Rate Setting --------------------------------------------------------- 6-44 EO1-11152 MA-1595-1 SERIES Page 6.23 TAX Table Setting --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-45 6.24 Store/Register No. Setting ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-47 7. VERIFICATION OF PROGRAMMED DATA----------------------------------------------------- 7- 1 7.1 Tax Calculation Test -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------7- 2 8. BAR CODE SYSTEM FOR EACH MODEL ------------------------------------------------------ 8- 1 1. DAILY OPERATION FLOW EO1-11152 1. DAILY OPERATION FLOW 1. DAILY OPERATION FLOW The following shows the typical flow of daily operations on the ECR. CASHIER’S OPERATIONS (described in OPERATOR’S GUIDE) MANAGER’S OPERATIONS OR ASSISTANCE (described in MANAGER’S GUIDE) Sign-ON (or Cashier Key to ON) No-sale Receipt (to check the print condition, and check the date and time print) (Adjust the date and time, if necessary, Chapter 6.) Loan (or by Manager) STORE OPEN Sale entries start. Manager Interventions when requested (for such operations as Returned Merchandise, Amount Discount, etc. Chapter 2) Sign-OUT Sign-OFF Cashier Key Sign-IN Sign-ON Changes .... for breaks of the cashier, or for cashier changes “X” report takings (sales data readings during the day. Chapter 5) Pick Up (money collections from the ECR drawer for banking purpose, etc. Chapter 3) Sale entries. Operations in “ - ” Mode (for entire-sale return or cancel. Chapter 4) STORE CLOSE Sign-OFF (or Cashier Key to OFF) “X” report takings “Z” report takings (Chapter 5) OTHER OPERATIONS OUTSIDE STORE’S BUSINESS HOURS Programming Data Additions, Deletions, Changes (Chapter 6) Programmed Data Verification (Chapter 7) Training mode Start and End (Operator’s Guide) Operations in Training Mode (for practicing of new cashiers) PAPER ROLL REPLACEMENT OR OTHER MAINTENANCE (OPERATOR’S GUIDE) 1- 1 2. MANAGER INTERVENTION EO1-11152 2.1 Items Programmed to Require Manager Interventions 2. MANAGER INTERVENTION 2.1 Items Programmed to Require Manager Interventions During daily sale entry operations, the cashier may call for Manager Interventions. The following is the operation flow of a Manager Intervention. 1) During operations, the cashier comes across an item that requires a Manager Intervention. The cashier, already informed of it, may immediately call for a Manager Intervention. Or the cashier, without knowing of it, attempts the operation, and error results with Error Message “MANAGER REQUIRED” (programmable) displayed, clears the error by the [C] key, and then calls for a Manager Intervention. 2) The manager goes to the cashier counter with the MA key. 3) The cashier explains what kind of operation is attempted, and removes the REG key from the Mode Lock at the “REG” position. 4) The manager inserts the MA key and turns it to the “MGR” position. 5) The cashier operates the required item. 6) The manager returns the MA key to the “REG” position and pulls it out. 7) The cashier sets the REG key to the “REG” position again and continues registering operations. The following is the table of the keys and operations that are programmable with Manager Intervention. Fill in the table by marking in the “Not Required” or “Required” column of each item, referring to the documents, etc. listed in the table. 2- 1 2. MANAGER INTERVENTION EO1-11152 2.1 Items Programmed to Require Manager Interventions KEYS/OPERATIONS AND MANAGER INTERVENTION STATUS TABLE KEY Manager Intervention Not required Required [DOLL DISC] [VND CPN] [STR CPN] [BTL RTN] [%-] (or [% II]) [RTN MDSE] [VOID] [PO] [PB-] or [CODE OPEN] [EX] [NS] [ALL VOID] Credit Balance (NOTE 1 below) Negative-balance Sale Finalization by Media Keys except [AT/TL] and [FSTL TEND] (NOTE 2) Negative Department or negative PLU Entries (NOTE 3) PLU Price Read NOTES: Reference As for changing the key status, ask your TOSHIBA TEC representative. These are program options for each store. Ask your TOSHIBA TEC representative for information and these status changes. 1. The “Credit Balance” means that amount entries through [DOLL DISC], [VOID], [VND CPN], [STR CPN], [BTL RTN] will result in over-subtraction of the subtotal amount at the time of the entry through any of those keys. If the status “Not required” is selected, over-subtraction using these keys will be allowed in the “REG” mode. The [RTN MDSE] key, negative departments, and negative PLUs are not subject to this “Credit Balance” status selection. 2. The “Negative-balance Sale” may be caused by: 1. Credit Balance if “Not required” is selected as the above Credit Balance status. 2. Amounts entered through the [RTN MDSE] key. 3. Amounts entered through negative departments or negative PLUs. 4. Other negative amounts. 3. The “Negative DEPTs or PLUs” are the DEPTs/PLUs programmed as negative status, but not normal DEPTs/PLUs through which Store Coupon or Returned Merchandise amounts are entered. 2- 2 2. MANAGER INTERVENTION EO1-11152 2.2 Other Operations Required Manager Interventions 2.2 Other Operations Required Manager Interventions Listing Capacity or Amount Limit Release Amount Limits may be programmed on Departments/PLUs, Tender Medias, [DOLL DISC], [VND CPN], [STR CPN], [BTL RTN]. These limits are programmed to check an excessively high or low amount entry by cashier’s mistake at the earliest stage. Guide your cashiers as in the following procedure: (1) During sale entries by the cashier, an error occurs with Error Message “OPERATION ERROR” (programmable) is displayed. (2) The cashier clears the error by the [C] key. The cashier confirms the amount and operates the item again. (3) If the same error occurs again, the cashier attempts to enter the amount using the [LC OPEN] or [OPEN] key. (4) If the operation results in an error again, the Amount Limit cannot be solved by the [LC OPEN] or [OPEN] key. (5) The cashier calls for Manager Intervention. The procedure thereafter is the same as Steps 2) to 7) for the ITEMS PROGRAMMED TO REQUIRE MANAGER INTERVENTIONS (Section 2.1). In need of information of Amount Limits, see the following: 1) Individual Department High and Low Amount Limits (each PLU is restricted by the Amount Limits of its linked department): Ask your TOSHIBA TEC representative. 2) Departments Common High and Low Amount Limits, and High Amount Limits of Tender Media keys: Chapter 7: VERIFICATION OF PROGRAMMED DATA • FUNCTION KEYS AMOUNT LIMIT READ 3) High Amount Limits for [DOLL DISC], [VND CPN], [STR CPN], and [BTL RTN] keys: Chapter 7: VERIFICATION OF PROGRAMMED DATA • NEGATIVE AMOUNT KEY AMOUNT LIMIT READ 4) For setting or changing the current Amount Limits, see the following: Chapter 6: PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS • AMOUNT LIMIT SETTING FOR FUNCTION KEYS (Submode 8) • NEGATIVE AMOUNT KEY AMOUNT LIMIT SETTING or CHANGING (Submode 35) 2- 3 3. MANAGER’S OWN OPERATIONS IN “MGR” MODE EO1-11152 3.1 Pick Up Operation 3. MANAGER’S OWN OPERATIONS IN “MGR” MODE The following are operations possible only in the “MGR” position of the Mode Lock, which are performed by the manager or by a person under the manager’s control. 3.1 Pick Up Operation This operation is used when you collect money from the ECR drawer, during the day, for the banking purpose, etc. In order to record the money amounts collected and to subtract the amounts from the In-drawer Totals memory, this operation is necessary. CONDITION Any time outside a sale, in a Signed-ON condition. OPERATION Mode Lock: MGR [PO] |Media Amount Collected| [MEDIA KEY] (or [VND CPN], [FSTL TEND]) Drawer opens. [AT/TL] ([ST]) NOTE 3 NOTE 1 Repeat until all the collected media amounts are recorded. NOTES: 1. As for each media and Food Stamp, its in-drawer limit amount can be programmed. On reaching this in-drawer limit when a sale is finalized, the message “DRAWER LIMIT” (programmable) is displayed with an alarm buzzer generated to indicate that a Pick Up operation is necessary. 2. Depress the media keys or the [VND CPN] or [FSTL TEND] key corresponding to the collected media ([AT/TL] for cash). The media keys that can be operated here are those programmed to print their media-in-drawer amounts in reports. 3. Depress [ST], if necessary, to obtain the subtotal amount of the medias so far collected. 4. During the Pick Up operation, both the Non-Add Number Print and the Validation Print are possible. Pick Up Operation Sample: The manager comes to the register and collects the cash amount of $300.00 from the drawer: -- Receipt Print Format -- 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ Mode Lock: MGR (must be in a signed-ON condition) Depress [PO]. Enter 30000, depress [AT/TL]. Depress [AT/TL]. 681 3,&. 83 ∗∗ &$6+ 727$/ -21(6 3- 1 ∗∗ 70 3. MANAGER’S OWN OPERATIONS IN “MGR” MODE EO1-11152 3.2 Enforced Sign-OFF of a Cashier (Code Entry Method) 3.2 Enforced Sign-OFF of a Cashier (Code Entry Method) Each cashier signs-ON to start operations, signs-OUT for leaving the register for a while, signs-IN when comes back, and signs-OFF to end operations (refer to the OPERATOR’S GUIDE). However, when a cashier once signed-ON and then signed-OUT for taking a break does not come back (or the cashier may have operated a Sign-OUT by mistake instead of a Sign-OFF), the register cannot be operated. No one else can operate SignOFF, either, because the same cashier must sign-IN first before Sign-OFF. In this case, the manager may operate an Enforced Sign-OFF. CONDITION In a Signed-OUT condition OPERATION Mode Lock: MGR The 2-digit Cashier Code (manager-assign portion) [LOG/RECEIPT] (or [LOG]) ........... The same will result as the normal Sign-OFF. 01 to 99 The 2-digit code assigned to each cashier. As for the code opening and assigned cashier names, refer to the following: For verifying the code and the assigned cashier’s name: Chapter 7: VERIFICATION OF PROGRAMMED DATA • CASHIER CODE AND NAME READ For programming or changing the cashier’s names or assigned codes: Chapter 6: PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS • CASHIER CODE AND NAME PROGRAMMING (Submode 2) -- Receipt Print Format -- 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 6,*1 22)) )) ∗∗ -21(6 ∗∗ 70 3- 2 3. MANAGER’S OWN OPERATIONS IN “MGR” MODE EO1-11152 3.3 Post Authorization Operation 3.3 Post Authorization Operation This operation is used for finalizing the EFT sale transaction which was authorized on the off-line ECR. CONDITION Any time outside a sale, In a Signed-ON condition OPERATION Mode Lock: MGR • Without Card Number Entry [POST AUTH] |Sale Amount| [#] Card Slide |Authorization Code| [#] Max. 7 digits Max. 11 characters (Omissible) NOTE 1 ECR wait condition EFT terminal responds “APPROVAL” Store Receipt Print • With Card Number Entry [MANUAL CARD#] [POST AUTH] |Card No.| [#] Max. 25 digits |Sale Amount| [#] Max. 7 digits NOTES: (|Expiration Date|) [#] Max. 4 digits; MM/YY (Omissible) (|Authorization Code|) [#] Max. 11 characters (Omissible) 1. Pressing the [C] key at this point will restore the ECR to condition being ready for the [POST AUTH] key entry. 2. Training cashiers are unacceptable to the EFT terminal. 3. Values 0 to 9 and A to Z should be used to enter the Authorization Code. 4. None of customer receipt is issued by the Post Authorization operation. 5. The Validation Print operation is not possible after performing the Post Authorization operation. 3- 3 3. MANAGER’S OWN OPERATIONS IN “MGR” MODE EO1-11152 3.4 EBT F/S Electronic Voucher Purchase 3.4 EBT F/S Electronic Voucher Purchase In this operation, a sale entry with EBT card is performed on the off-line ECR when the network is down, then the sale transaction is authorized after the network recovery. (This operation is used for the EBT food stamp.) CONDITION Any time outside a sale, In a Signed-ON condition OPERATION Mode Lock: MGR • Without Card Number Entry Key Operation FIU Upper Row Display [VOUCHER AUTH] SWIPE CARD Card Slide Response from the EFT terminal ENT AMOUNT |Tendered Amount| Max. 7 digits Pressing the [C] key at this point will restore the ECR to the condition being ready for the [VOUCHER AUTH] key entry. [#] ENT AUT CD [C] (|Authorization Code|) Max. 11 characters (alphanumeric characters); omissible [#] (|Voucher No.|) ENT VOUCHER# Max. 10 digits; omissible [#] PROCESSING (in case of no response from EFT) or (in case of decline) NO RESPONS Response from the EFT terminal ECR prints a Store Receipt 3- 4 DECLINE APPROVED 3. MANAGER’S OWN OPERATIONS IN “MGR” MODE EO1-11152 3.4 EBT F/S Electronic Voucher Purchase • With Card Number Entry [MANUAL CARD#] [VOUCHER AUTH] |Card No.| [#] 8 to19 digits |Sale Amount| [#] Max. 7 digits NOTES: (|Authorization Code|) [#] Max. 11 characters (alphanumeric characters); Omissible (|Expiration Date|) [#] Max. 4 digits; MM/YY (Omissible) (|Voucher No.|) [#] Max. 10 digits; Omissible 1. It is possible to cancel this operation prior to the inquiry to the host (i.e. before the message “PROCESSING” is displayed). 2. Training cashiers are unacceptable to the EFT terminal. 3. Values 0 to 9 and A to Z should be used to enter the Authorization Code. 4. None of customer receipt is issued by the EBT F/S Electronic Voucher Purchase operation. 5. The Validation Print operation is not possible after performing the EBT F/S Electronic Voucher Purchase operation. 3- 5 3. MANAGER’S OWN OPERATIONS IN “MGR” MODE EO1-11152 3.5 EBT CASH, EBT F/S Balance Inquiry 3.5 EBT CASH, EBT F/S Balance Inquiry This operation is used for inquiring the balance to the host. CONDITION Any time outside a sale, In a Signed-ON condition OPERATION Mode Lock: MGR • Without Card Number Entry Key Operation FIU Upper Row Display [BALANCE INQUIRY] BALANCE INQUIRY [EBT CASH] or [EBT F/S] SWIPE CARD Card Slide (in case of no response from EFT) NO RESPONS Response from the EFT terminal ENTER PIN# Input the Pin No. from the Pin Pad Then depress the [ENTER] key PROCESSING NO RESPONS (in case of no response from EFT) or (in case of decline) DECLINE Response from the EFT terminal APPROVED ECR prints a Customer Receipt 3- 6 3. MANAGER’S OWN OPERATIONS IN “MGR” MODE EO1-11152 3.5 EBT CASH, EBT F/S Balance Inquiry • With Card Number Entry [BALANCE INQUIRY] |Card No.| [#] 8 to19 digits NOTES: [MANUAL CARD#] [EBT CASH] or [EBT F/S] (|Expiration Date|) [#] Max. 4 digits; MM/YY (omissible) 1. It is possible to cancel this operation prior to the inquiry to the host (i.e. before the message “PROCESSING” is displayed). 2. Training cashiers are unacceptable to the EFT terminal. 3. None of customer receipt is issued by the EBT CASH, EBT F/S Balance Inquiry operation. 4. The Validation Print operation is not possible after performing the EBT CASH, EBT F/S Balance Inquiry operation. 3- 7 4. OPERATIONS IN “ - ” MODE EO1-11152 4.1 Ordinary Operations In “ - “ Mode 4. OPERATIONS IN “ - ” MODE Instead of using the [RTN MDSE] or [VOID] key in the “REG” or “MGR” mode for deleting individual items, the “ - ” mode automatically processes positive items into negative and negative into positive. To operate, turn the Mode Lock to the “ - ” position using the MA key, and enter the items, one by one, just as in the “ REG” mode, as reading the sale receipt (issued at the time of the purchase) or tracing the returned items as if in the “ REG” mode. A positive balance resulted in the “ - ” mode indicates the amount to be paid back to the customer. The “ - ” mode operation may occur from time to time during day, on the cashier’s request, just as in the case of ordinary Manager Interventions, when a customer comes to the cashier counter to return or cancel all the items that he once purchased. In using this mode, please be certain to read the following three cases of operation patterns. If you only turn the Mode Lock to the “ - ” position and let the cashier operate the actual item entries in this mode, you should also inform the cashier of these three cases. 4.1 Ordinary Operations In “ - ” Mode Except those described in the next sections 4.2 to 4.4, all the sale items that were entered in “REG” or “MGR” at the time of purchase may be entered in the “ - ” mode in the same way as operated at the time of purchase. OPERATION AND RECEIPT SAMPLE RECEIPT ISSUED IN “REG” or “MGR” MODE RECEIPT ISSUED IN “ - ” MODE 7(& 6725( 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 9(*(7$%/( 68%7/ &$6+ 7) 7) '3 ,7(0 -21(6 NOTE: 4.2 70 These two receipts contain the same sale items and media finalization. The operations are also the same except the Mode Lock position. The cashier merely follows the purchase receipt (on the left) and enters the same items in the position, finalizing with the same media in case a customer has returned or canceled the entire sale after the cashier had finalized that sale. The - mode header ( * REG- * in this example ) is printed at the top and the bottom of the sale contents in the - mode receipt. 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 5(* 5(* '3 ∗∗ 9(*(7$%/( 7;%/ 7/ &$6+ ,7(0 -21(6 5(* 5(* ∗∗ ∗∗ 7) 7) ∗∗ 70 When you handle a sales item of cigarette or alcoholic beverage in the “ - ” mode, the age confirmation is unnecessary. Charge Posting With Customer File (Check Track Memory) In “ - ” Mode When your register adopts the Customer File Memory type (instead of the PB Manual Entry type), the previous balance entry is different from that operated in the “REG” or “MGR” mode. Due to the memory process, this special operation is required. In case a customer cancels the entire sale once purchased in the charge posting mode, please be certain to operate as instructed on next page. 4- 1 4. OPERATIONS IN “ - ” MODE EO1-11152 4.2 Charge Posting With Customer File (Check Track Memory) In “ - “ Mode (1) Operation in “REG” or “MGR” mode (at the purchase; refer to the OPERATOR’S GUIDE.) |Customer File Code*| [PICK UP BAL] (or [CODE OPEN]) ** The previous balance is recalled from the customer’s file memory. Entries of the purchased items*** ([TXBL TL]) [Chg] (if any) [TRF] ......... to transfer all balance with no payment **** |Payment Amount| [R/A] Finalization with Media Keys (2) Operation in “ - ” mode (at the cancel or return of the above sale) |Customer File Code| [PICK UP BAL] |Previous Balance| [AMT] Equivalent to * Equivalent to ** [Chg] Entries of the returned items (equivalent to ***) Balance Transfer or Payment operation (equivalent to ****) NOTE: Only the previous balance that was automatically recalled from memory in the “REG” or “MGR” mode must be entered manually through the [AMT] key in the “ - ” mode. Other operations are identical to those operated in the “REG” or “MGR” mode. (Such items as %+ and %- are also operated the same as entered at the time of purchase.) RECEIPT AT PURCHASE Mode Lock: REG or MGR 3 (Cus. File Code) [PICK UP BAL] 600 [DEPT 1] 10 [%-] (A) [Chg] [TRF] 681 3% .$5(1 :$/7(56 9(*(7$%/( 7$; &KJ 1(: %$/ ,7(0 -21(6 681 7) RECEIPT AT RETURN 70 5(* 5(* 3% ∗∗ .$5(1 :$/7(56 9(*(7$%/( 7$; &KJ 1(: %$/ 1(: %$/ ,7(0 5(* 5(* ∗∗ -21(6 ∗∗ 7) ∗∗ Mode Lock: 3 (Cus.File Code) [PICK UP BAL] 636 [AMT] Operated exactly the same as the sequence marked with “(A)” at purchase. The final new balance after correction in this operation (which should be equal to the balance called at the starting of the RECEIPT AT PURCHASE). 70 As shown in the sample above, the previous balance $6.36 is entered manually through the [AMT] key on the right-hand side receipt, while the same previous balance is automatically recalled by merely designating the Customer File Code through the [PICK UP BAL] key on the left-hand side receipt. The print formats in both receipts are designed to be the same from Customer File Code down to the first “NEW BAL” amount (resulting balance at the time of purchase.), except that the final new balance at the time of return is additionally printed (which will be the same amount of the balance before the purchase) and the “ - ” mode header is printed on the right-hand side receipt. 4- 2 4. OPERATIONS IN “ - ” MODE EO1-11152 4.3 Scale Item Entry In “ - “ Mode 4.3 Scale Item Entry In “ - ” Mode Any scale item entered in the “REG” or “MGR” mode at the time of purchase must be entered manually (Manual Scale Entry but not Auto Scale) in the “ - ” mode at the time of return or cancel. That is, for entering a scale item (once purchased) in the “ - ” mode, you must read the written net weight on the item (if any) or read the net weight in the scale display panel by placing it on the scale platter, then enter the net weight value, manually in the procedure described as MANUAL SCALE ENTRY operation in the OPERATOR’S GUIDE. NOTE: At the link-PLU entry, the Scale Entry can be performed for the head-link PLU but not for the sub-link PLU. 4.4 Electronic Fund Transfer (EFT) Operation In “ - “ Mode (1) Void Credit Sale This operation is performed for canceling credit sale transactions. OPERATION Sales Item Entry (|Tendered Amount|) [CREDIT] ([TXBL TL]) Card Slide Max. 7 digits (|Authorization Code|) [#] (|Reference No.|) [#] Max. 11 characters Customer Receipt Print EFT terminal responds “APPROVAL” Max. 16 digits Store Receipt Print (2) Void Credit Refund This operation is performed for canceling credit refund transactions. [RTN MDSE] NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. to be continued to the top of “Void Credit Sale” sequence Receipt post-Issue operation after finalizing a sale by the EFT is unavailable. Key operation on the ECR is unavailable during the inquiry to the host. Values 0 to 9 and A to Z should be used to enter the Authorization Code. Issuance of the Store Receipt is selectable. In the Receipt-OFF mode, payment by the EFT media cannot be made. The Validation Print operation is not possible after performing the Void Credit Sale or the Void Credit Refund operation. (3) Cashing Debit Refund This operation is performed for canceling debit cashing transactions. OPERATION | Amount to be cashed | Max. 7 digits [DEBIT] or [EBT CASH] EFT terminal responds “APPROVAL”. NOTES: 1. 2. 3. Card Slide Input the Pin No. from the Pin Pad. Then depress the [ENTER] key. Customer Receipt Print Store Receipt Print Before performing this operation, the [DEBIT] (or [EBT CASH]) key should be programmed with the status “no-purchase cashing is allowed”. Also each EFT Media Key should be programmed with the statuses both “with EFT process” and “off line authorization is available”. Failure to do this may cause an error. For the EFT function, do not perform any registration in Receipt OFF mode. Receipt post-Issue operation after the Cashing Debit Refund is unavailable. 4- 3 4. OPERATIONS IN “ - ” MODE EO1-11152 4.5 Prohibitive Operations In “ - “ Mode 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Key operation on the ECR is unavailable during the inquiry to the host. The Endorsement Print can be performed. Training Cashiers are unacceptable to the EFT terminal. Issuance of the Store Receipt is selectable. When manual issuance of store receipt has been programmed, the store receipt must be issued to perform next transaction or read/reset jobs. 9. The Validation Print operation is not possible. 10. EFT cashing operation with the [CREDIT], [CHECK], and [EBT F/S] keys is not possible. 4- 4 4. OPERATIONS IN “ - ” MODE EO1-11152 4.5 Prohibitive Operations In “ - “ Mode (4) EBT CASH, EBT F/S Return This operation is performed for canceling EBT CASH and EBT F/S transactions. OPERATION Key Operation FIU Upper Row Display Sale Entry This operation is possible when the [EBT F/S] key is programmed with the status “food stamp payment”. ([TXBL TL]) [FS TL/TEND] (Tendered Amount) |Tendered Amount| (Max. 7 digits; Omissible if all the amount is paid, however depending on the program option.) [EBT CASH] Max. 7 digits (Must be entered) [EBT F/S] SWIPE CARD Card Slide ([C]) Pressing the [C] key at this point will restore the ECR to the condition being ready for the [EBT CASH] (or [EBT F/S]) key entry. (in case of no response from EFT) NO RESPONS Response from the EFT terminal ENTER PIN# Input the Pin No. from the Pin Pad then depress the [ENTER] key. PROCESSING (in case of no response from EFT) or (in case of decline) NO RESPONS DECLINE Response from the EFT terminal APPROVED ECR prints a Customer Receipt ECR prints a Store Receipt 4- 5 4. OPERATIONS IN “ - ” MODE EO1-11152 4.5 Prohibitive Operations In “ - “ Mode • Manual Entry (when the [EBT CASH] or [EBT F/S] key has been programmed with the status “taxable total payment”.) Sales Entry ([TXBL TL]) [MANUAL CARD#] (|Sale Amount|) Max. 7 digits (Omissible) |Card No.| [#] (|Expiration Date|) [#] 8 to 19 digits Max. 4 digits; MM/YY (Omissible) [EBT CASH] ([EBT F/S]) • Manual Entry (when the [EBT F/S] key has been programmed with the status “food stamp payment”.) Sales Entry ([FS TL/TEND]) [MANUAL CARD#] |Sale Amount| [EBT F/S] Max. 7 digits NOTES: |Card No.| [#] (|Expiration Date|) [#] 8 to 19 digits Max. 4 digits; MM/YY (Omissible) 1. 2. 3. 4. Receipt post-Issue operation after finalizing a sale by the EFT is unavailable. Key operation on the ECR is unavailable during the inquiry to the host. Contents of the customer receipt are printed on the journal, but those of the store receipt are not. Automatic issuance or manual issuance of the store receipt is selectable by the system option setting. 5. Sale finalization by the EFT is possible only when the media key has been programmed with the status “EFT media” in the EFT key status setting. If not, ordinary sale finalization is performed. 6. Training cashiers are unacceptable to the EFT terminal. (Ordinary finalization operation can be performed.) 7. Issuance of the store receipt is selectable by the EFT key status setting. 8. When tendering in foreign currency, the EFT media keys are not accepted. 9. For the EFT function, do not perform any registration in Receipt OFF mode. 10. When manual issuance of store receipt has been programmed, the store receipt must be issued to perform next transaction or read/reset jobs. 11. Validation Print operation at the EBT CASH or EBT F/S Return operation is prohibited. 4- 6 4. OPERATIONS IN “ - ” MODE EO1-11152 4.5 Prohibitive Operations In “ - “ Mode 4.5 Prohibitive Operations In “ - ” Mode • NO-SALE ([NS]) • AUTO-SCALE (described in 4.3.) • NO-SALE CASHING OF CHEQUE OR OTHER NON-CASH MEDIAS • NO-SALE EXCHANGE from Foreign Currency to Domestic Currency, or vice versa • LOAN • PICK UP • TRAINING MODE START/END • ENDORSEMENT PRINT • RECEIPT POST-ISSUE ([RECEIPT ISSUE]) 4.6 Manager Intervention Required Status or Amount Limit In “ - ” Mode Since operations in the “ - ” mode are performed under the manager’s control, the status requiring a Manager Intervention, and Amount Limits (described in Chapter 2) will all be released, i.e., the same handling as in the “MGR” mode. 4- 7 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS The following table shows the key operation to take each report. The “X” and “Z” reports have exactly the same print content if both are available, except that: 1. The “X” reports allow to read the sales data but not clear memories, while the “Z” reports allow to read the sales data and at the same time all the resettable memories will be cleared when the reports have been issued. 2. The symbol “X...” is printed on the top line of a Daily Read Report, “Z...” on a Daily Reset Report, “GTX...” on a GT Read Report, and “GTZ...” on a GT Reset Report, as initial settings. 3. A reset count is printed on the bottom of a “Z” report only. WARNING! When opening the cash drawer, be careful not to let the drawer hit any person. TABLE OF OPERATIONS FOR X AND Z REPORTS Daily Reports Report Name FINANCIAL READ AND RESET • Financial Read • Financial Reset CASHIER READ AND RESET • All Cashier Read • All Cashier Reset • Individual Cashier Read • Individual Cashier Reset Mode Lock Key Operation X Z 3 [AT/TL] (Drawer opens.) X Z 4 [AT/TL] (Drawer opens.) X Z Code Entry Method: 4 [#] |Cashier ID Code| [AT/TL] Sample Page 5-5 5-7 (2-digit manager-assign code) Cashier Key Method: Set the required Cashier Key (or depress the required Cashier Key), then 4 [#] [AT/TL] SALESPERSON READ AND RESET • All Salesperson Read • All Salesperson Reset CREDIT CARD COMPANY SALES READ AND RESET • Credit Card Company Sales Read • Credit Card Company Sales Reset DEPARTMENT GROUP READ MEDIA SALES AND IN-DRWER TOTAL READ HOURLY RANGE READ AND RESET • Hourly Read • Hourly Reset 5-8 X Z 5 [AT/TL] 5-8 X Z X X X Z 5- 1 6 [AT/TL] 8 [AT/TL] 9 [AT/TL] (Drawer opens.) 10 [AT/TL] 5-9 5-10 5-10 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS Daily Reports (Continued) Report Name DEPARTMENT READ AND RESET • Individual Department Read • All department Read • All department Reset ALL MEDIA SALES TOTAL AND CASH-INDRAWER READ PLU READ AND RESET • Individual PLU Read Mode Lock X X Z X X Sample Page 5-11 Key Operation 11 [#], then depress the required Dept. Keys (or use [DP#] key), one by one, [ST] may be used to obtain subtotal, [AT/TL] to end. 11 [AT/TL] 12 [AT/TL] (Drawer opens.) 5-8 * 13 [#] |PLU Code| [PLU] ([ST]) Repeatable 5-13 [AT/TL] * (May be replaced by [PLU Preset-code Key]) • Zone PLU Read • Zone PLU Reset X Z • All PLU Read • All PLU Reset X Z 13 [AT/TL] • Inactive PLU Read CUSTOMER FILE READ AND RESET (for Check Track Memory type only) • All Files Read • All Files Reset • Individual File Read • Zone Files Read • Zone Files Reset X 13 [#] 0 [AT/TL] X Z X X Z 15 [#] |Zone-start File Code| [@/FOR] → |Zone-end File Code| [AT/TL] • Zero-balance Files Read • Credit-balance Files Read • Debit-balance Files Read PLU GROUP SALES READ AND RESET • PLU Group Sales Read • PLU Group Sales Reset EFT MEDIA LOG READ AND RESET • EFT Media Log Read • EFT Media Log Reset X X X 15 [#] 0 [AT/TL] 15 [#] 1 [AT/TL] 15 [#] 2 [AT/TL] 13 [#] Zone-start [@/FOR] Zone-end PLU Code [AT/TL] PLU Code 5-15 15 [AT/TL] 15 [#] |Customer File Code| [@/FOR] [AT/TL] 5-17 X Z 24 [AT/TL] X Z 45 [AT/TL] 5-18 5- 2 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS GT Reports -- to be taken on weekly or monthly basis -Mode Key Operation Lock (The Mode Lock position is the same as the corresponding Daily report. However, always add 200 to the numeric value for the report taking.) FINANCIAL GT READ AND RESET • Financial GT Read X 203 [AT/TL] (Drawer opens.) • Financial GT Reset Z CASHIER GT READ AND RESET • All Cashier GT Read X 204 [AT/TL] (Drawer opens.) • All Cashier GT Reset Z Sample Page Report Name • Individual Cashier GT Read • Individual Cashier GT Reset X Z 5-18 5-18 Code Entry Method: 204 [#] |Cashier ID Code| [AT/TL] (2-digit manager-assign code) Cashier Key Method: Set the required Cashier Key (or depress the required Cashier Key), then 204 [#] [AT/TL] CREDIT CARD COMPANY SALES GT READ AND RESET • Credit Card Company Sales GT Read • Credit Card Company Sales GT Reset DEPARTMENT GROUP GT READ DEPARTMENT GT READ AND RESET • Individual Department GT Read • All Department GT Read • All Department GT Reset PLU READ AND RESET • Individual PLU GT Read 5-18 X Z X X X Z X 206 [AT/TL] 208 [AT/TL] 5-18 5-18 211 [#], then depress the required Dept. Keys (or use [DP#] key), one by one, [ST] may be used to obtain subtotal, [AT/TL] to end. 211 [AT/TL] * 213 [#] |PLU Code| [PLU] ([ST]) Repeatable 5-18 [AT/TL] * (May be replaced by [PLU Preset-code Key]) • Zone PLU GT Read • Zone PLU GT Reset X Z • All PLU GT Read • All PLU GT Reset X Z 213 [AT/TL] • Inactive PLU GT Read PLU GROUP SALES GT READ AND RESET • PLU Group Sales GT Read • PLU Group Sales GT Reset X 213 [#] 0 [AT/TL] X Z 224 [AT/TL] 213 [#] Zone-start [@/FOR] PLU Code Zone-end [AT/TL] PLU Code 5-18 5- 3 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.1 Combination Reports 5.1 Combination Reports Multiple reports can be programmed to be issued in one operation sequence. The following are reports programmable for combinations (max. 5 reports in one table, max. 3 tables). Ask your TOSHIBA TEC representative for information of the contents of your Combination Report Tables or for changes. REPORT NAME Financial Report All Cashier Report All Salesperson Report Credit Company Sales Report Department Group Report Media Sales and In-drawer Report Hourly Range Report All Department Report All Media Sales & Cash-in-drawer Report All PLU Report All Customer Files Report PLU Group Sales Report KEY OPERATION: Mode Lock: X X X X X X X X X X X X X for Read Z for Reset | AVAILABLE REPORTS Z GTX GTZ Z GTX GTZ Z Z GTX GTZ GTX Z Z GTX GTZ Z GTX GTZ Z GTX GTZ | [AT/TL] Enter the Report Combination-ID No.: None (simply depress [AT/TL]): Daily Combination Report Table No.1 200: GT Combination Report Table No.1 1: Daily Combination Report Table No.2 201: GT Combination Report Table No.2 2: Daily Combination Report Table No.3 202: GT Combination Report Table No.3 NOTES: 5.2 1. When the mode set for taking combination reports does not match the mode of a report contained in the table, that report will be skipped. 2. If no combination reports data have been programmed, Combination Report Table No. 1 (which is issued by depressing the [AT/TL] key alone for Daily Reports and depressing 200 [AT/TL] for GT Reports) is auto-preset with All Department Report and Financial Report. It will be active as Table No. 1 content unless no data are programmed for Table No. 1. 3. The report output order is determined by the order programmed in each table. 4. The drawer will open when a contained report is ruled to open the drawer. General Notes On Report Takings 1. The cashier signed-OFF or signed-OUT condition is required for taking any Z reports in the Code Entry Method. (Otherwise, an error will result when the Mode Lock is turned to the “X” or “Z” position.) However, in case of a standalone system with PC connected and CVS spec. selected, X/Z reports can be taken during Sign-ON and sales entries. 2. Reset reports will be printed on the receipt roll as well as on journal, and issued, regardless of the current Receipt-ON/OFF status. 3. The [ITEM CORR] (or [VOID]) key may be depressed halfway during printing a report, for the purpose to abort the receipt issuance (except for some short reports). When a report-abort has been operated for a reset report, the memory of the report data will not be cleared. 5- 4 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings 4. The drawer will open at the starting of printing the reports which are stated with “(Drawer opens)” in the Daily and GT report table. However, the drawer may remain closed if so selected by a program option. This selection is applied only to the Financial Report. 5. The sales data of the following read reports will be cleared when the relevant reset reports are cleared. If those read reports are necessary, please be certain to take them before the relevant reset reports are taken: READ REPORT (with no reset reports provided) Department Group Read Media Sales and In-drawer Total Read All Media Sales Total and Cash-in-drawer Read Customer File Read ... non-resettable Inactive PLU Read Department Group GT Read Inactive PLU GT Read RELEVANT RESET REPORT that clears the read report data All Department Reset Financial Reset Financial Reset PLU Reset All Department GT Reset PLU GT Reset 6. The PLU with the Delete Status set in each PLU report is not printed/searched. As you notice, “Financial Reset”, “All Department Reset”, and “PLU Reset” reports should be taken after all other reports (particularly read reports) on the respective levels of daily and GT, so that the required read reports data may not be cleared by those reset report takings. FINANCIAL READ or RESET (Daily or GT) 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( Mode Lock: X for read Z for reset Reset Report Format Sample 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 Date, Day-of Week, Store/Register No. ;B),1$1&,$/ *7 1(7 *7 *6 16 7$; 7$; 16 +$6+ '3 9&31 ',6& Enter 3, depress [AT/TL] (for Daily) Enter 203, depress [AT/TL] (for GT) Report Name NOTES: 1. The numeric values placed in reports in this manual are merely examples to show the print format and may not balance correctly. 2. The items attached with “*” outside the receipt frame are printed only on Daily Reports but not on GT Reports. 3. The print or non-print status of each item on Financial Reports can be programmed. 4. Non-printing of items with zero sales (i.e.,zero skip) can be programmed by a program option. Grand Total (non-resettable) Net GT (non-resettable) Gross Sale Item Count & Amount Percent Charge I, II Count & Amount Net Sale Without Tax Item Count & Amount Tax 1 Amount Tax 2 to 4 Amount Manual Tax Amount Net Sale With Tax Item Count & Amount Total of Positive Departments programmed as HASH Dept., Item Count & Amount Total of Negative Departments programmed Percent Discount (on Subtotal) Count as HASH Dept., Item Count & Amount & Amount Percent Discount II (on Subtotal) Count & Vendor Coupon Count Amount if two Percent Discount keys are & Amount installed. Dollar Discount (on Subtotal) Count & Amount -- To be continued -- 5- 5 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings (Financial Read or Reset) -- Continued -BTR TOTAL CASH CHECK FS TL R/A PO ∗ CASH ID CHECK ID ∗ FS ID ∗ FS CG CORR VOID ALL VD %DISC S. CPN -DP TL RTN -TAX -SALE REGTRF TL TRF-GT TRFPB TL TXBL1 TXBL2 SI1 TL ∗ TAX EX TAX1 EX CUR 1 ∗ CUR 2 ∗ CUR 3 ∗ CUR RND ITEM/CUS NS/CUS NO SALE VALI CTR HOLD CTR 0001Z 6 $0.35 71CU $310.49 71CU $292.77 0CU $5.00 1CU $12.72 2 $8.00 8 $37.10 $95.02 2 $15.00 1 $13.00 $0.28 1 $1.00 1 $1.00 2 $8.60 11 $2.02 4 $2.00 2 $1.00 1 $1.00 4 $3.80 $0.22 4CU $5.37 2 $7.95 $0.03 $0.03 $0.03 1CU $0.00 $284.98 $58.20 2 $1.40 1CU $10.00 3 150.00 1 5.68 1 1.45 18.00 1.58 $4.23 3 3 1 Bottle Return Item Count & Amount All-media Sales (including CASH, FS TL, and PB TL) Customer Count & Amount Cash Sales Customer Count & Amount Check Sales Customer Count & Amount Food Stamp Sales Customer Count & Amount Received-on-Account Count & Amount Paid-Out Count & Amount Cash-in-drawer Amount Check-in-drawer Count & Amount Food Stamp-in-drawer Count & Amount Food Stamp Change Amount Item Correct (on positive Depts/PLUs) Count & Amount Void Count & Amount All Void Count & Amount Percent Discount (on Line Items) Count & Amount Dollar Discount (on Line Items) Count & Amount Store Coupon Item Count & Amount Negative Departments Item Count & Amount Returned Merchandise Item Count & Amount Negative Tax Amount Negative-balance Sales Customer Count & Amount Negative Mode (“ - “ Mode) Count & Amount Transfer GT Balance Transfer - GT Transfer - Daily Previous Balance Sales Customer Count & Amount Taxable Total 1 (Sale Amount Portion subject to Tax 1 taxation) Taxable Total 2 (Sale Amount Portion subject to Tax 2 taxation) Selective Itemizer 1 Count & Amount calculated out or processed Tax Exempted Customer Count Sale Portion Exempted from Tax 1 The amounts are expressed in the respective currencies’ unit Foreign Currency Rounding Amount Sales Item Count per Customer Net Sale Amount per Customer No-sale Count Validation Count HOLD Operation Count Financial Reset Report Count (on Reset Reports only) 5- 6 Additional Media (MISC, CREDIT, DEBIT, etc.) Sales data, if any ∗ Loan Amount, Pick Up Count & Amount ∗ Additional Media-in-drawer data, if any Miscellaneous Void Count & Amount Percent Discount II (on Line Items) Count & Amount if two Percent Discount keys are installed. Transfer + GT Transfer + Daily Previous Balance R/A, PO Amount Taxable Total 3, 4 Selective Itemizer 2 Count & Amount Sales Portion Exempted from Tax 2 to 4 FS EX1 to FS EX4 for Taxes exempted by tendering food stamps if ILLINOIS or NEW JERSEY type of food stamp system ∗ Foreign Currencies 4 & 5-in-drawer data if opened. Off-line EFT Authorization Count & Amount (for EFT spec.) 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings CASHIER READ or RESET (Daily or GT) Reset Report Format Sample Mode Lock: X for read Z for reset TEC STORE 1343 PEACH DRIVE PHONE: 87-6437 Open 8:00am to 7:00pm Closed: every Wednesday 08-31-2003 SUN #3001 (2) Individual Cashier: Enter 4, depress [#], enter the Cashier ID Code (2 digits), and depress [AT/TL] (CODE ENTRY Method) (for Daily) Z_CLERK GT 01 JONES GS NS ITEM/CUS NS /CUS NO SALE VALI CTR HOLD CTR 125 $346.77 112 $300.48 1.56 $4.17 2 3 1 0001Z 02 SMITH ∗∗ ∗ ∗ TRAINING 04 BROWN GS ∗∗ TAX1 NS TOTAL CASH CASH ID TXBL1 ITEM/CUS NS /CUS Set the required Cashier Key to ON, enter 4, depress [#] and [AT/TL] (CASHIER KEY Method) (for Daily) Enter 204, depress [#], enter the Cashier ID Code (2 digits), and depress [AT/TL] (CODE ENTRY Method) (for GT) Set the required Cashier Key to ON, enter 204, depress [#] and [AT/TL] (CASHIER KEY Method) (for GT) In CASHIER SIGNING Method, the ID code here is the 2-digit manager-assign portion of the Cashier Code Cashier ID Code & Cashier’s Name ∗ ∗ TRAINING 03 MEHL NS (1) All Cashiers: Enter 4, depress [AT/TL] (for Daily). Enter 204, depress [AT/TL] (for GT). Same contents as Financial Reports except for GT and NET GT 9 $22.80 9 $21.50 $1.30 9 $22.80 5CU $22.80 $22.80 $22.80 $21.50 1.80 $4.30 0001Z Individual Cashier Reset Report Count (on Reset Reports only) 0261 18:58TM 5- 7 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings SALESPERSON READ OR RESET (all Salespersons) CREDIT CARD COMPANY SALES READ OR RESET (Daily or GT) Reset Report Sample Reset Report Sample Mode Lock: X for read Z for reset Enter 5, depress [AT/TL] Mode Lock: X for read Z for reset 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ =B6/63(5621 *6 16 16 6WDF\ 571 = 681 Person Code, Name Gross Sale Item Count & Amount Net Sale Without Tax Item Count & Amount Net Sale With Tax Item Count & Amount Returned Item Count & Amount =B&5(',7 $%& 727$/ 70 ALL MEDIA SALES TOTAL AND CASH-IN-DRAWER READ (read only) Mode Lock: X, enter 12, depress [AT/TL] 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ ;B0(',$ 727$/ &$6+ ,' &8 = All Salesperson Reset Report Count (on Reset Reports only) 681 Enter 6, depress [AT/TL] (for Daily) Enter 206, depress [AT/TL] (for GT) All Media Sales Total Customer Count, Amount Cash-in-drawer Amount 70 5- 8 70 Company Code, Name, Count & Sales Amount Total of all card Companies’ sales (Item Count & Amount) Credit Card Co.Sales Reset Report Count (on Reset Reports only) 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings DEPARTMENT GROUP READ (Daily or GT) (read only) Mode Lock: X Enter 8, depress [AT/TL] (for Daily). Enter 208, depress [AT/TL] (for GT). 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 ; '3 *5283 9( )5 0( ), '$,5< %$.(5< &$ %7 '5 %/ 61 63 27+ 27+(56 (56 727$/ )5(6+ 0$18) 27+(5 727$/ Minor Groups: Group Name, Item Count Sales Percentage & Amount Item Count Amount Total of all Minor Groups Major Groups: Item Count Amount Total of all Major Groups 70 5- 9 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings MEDIA SALES AND IN-DRAWER TOTAL READ HOURLY RANGE READ or RESET (read only) Reset Report Sample Mode Lock: X, enter 9, depress [AT/TL] Mode Lock: X for read Z for reset 7(& 6725( 7(& 6725( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 681 &$6+ &+(&. &KJ )6 7/ &$6+ ,' &+(&. ,' &KJ ,' )6 &* 3% 7/ &85 &85 &85 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( ;B0(',$B$// 727$/ )6 ,' Enter 10, depress [AT/TL] &8 &8 &8 &8 &8 &8 681 =B+285/< 70 70 70 &8 70 All Media Sales Customer Count & Amount Each Media Sales Cus, Count & Amount = 70 Each Media-in-drawer Count & Amount Food Stamp Change Previous Balance Sales Cus. Count & Amount Each Foreign Currency-indrawer Count & Amount 70 5-10 8:01 to 12:00 12:01 to 15:00 15:01 to 19:00 Item Count Customer Count & Amount 19:01 and thereafter Hourly Range Reset Report Count (on Reset Reports only) 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings DEPARTMENT READ or RESET Individual Department Read (Daily or GT) 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( Mode Lock: X 11 [#] (for Daily) 211 [#] (for GT) 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 [DEPT: VEGETABLE] 571 6&31 &255 5(* )58,7 ',6& 571 6&31 &255 5(* [ST] 68%7/ 727$/ [AT/TL] ;B'3B,1',9 9(*(7$%/( ',6& [DEPT: FRUIT] Mode Lock: X Enter 11 and depress [#] for Daily Report, or Enter 211 and depress [#] for GT Report Depress the required Dept Keys (or enter the required Dept Code and depress [DP#]), repeat this for other required DEPTs, depress [ST] if subtotal is necessary, depress [AT/TL] to end reading. 7(& 6725( Operation for this sample report: 70 Department Name, Item Count Customer Count (or Sales Percentage: NOTE), Amount Dollar Discount or %Count & Amount Return Merchandise Item Count & Amount The print or non-print status of each Store Coupon Item item is selected in a programming Count & Amount operation. Item Correct/Void Count & Amount Negative Mode Count & Amount Item Count Amount Item Count Amount Subtotal of VEGETABLE + FRUIT Total of all departments read in this report When there is any Negative Department Subtotal value, its Item Count & Amount is printed here. When there is any Negative Department Total value, its Item Count & Amount is printed here. NOTE: A program option allows to select which of Customer Count and Sales Percentage is printed here. 5-11 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings All Department Read or Reset (Daily or GT) Reset Report Sample Mode Lock: X for read Z for reset 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 =B'3B$// 9(*(7$%/( ',6& 571 6&31 &255 5(* '3 ',6& 571 6&31 &255 5(* 727$/ 727$/ Department Data ↓ Dept. 1 Name Item Count Customer Count (or Sales %), Amount Dollar Disc. or %- Count & Amount Returned Merchandise Item Count & Amount Store Coupon Count & Amount Item Correct/Void Count & Amount Negative Mode Count & Amount Dept. 15 Data: Item Count Amount Item Count Amount of positive departments of negative departments 5-12 Enter 11, depress [AT/TL] (for Daily). Enter 211, depress [AT/TL] (for GT). 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings PLU (PLU SALES DATA) READ or RESET Individual PLU Read (Daily or GT) Mode Lock: X Enter 13 [#] for Daily Report, or Enter 213 [#] for GT Report. Enter the PLU code, depress [PLU]. (Repeat this step if necessary.) Depress [ST] for subtotal. Depress [AT/TL] to end. 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 Mode Lock: X 13 [#] ;B3/8B,1',9 /HPRQ $SSOH 68%7/ OPERATION FOR THIS SAMPLE REPORT: 20102 [PLU] 20105 [PLU] 727$/ [ST] to obtain subtotal of the above two PLUs. [AT/TL] to end 70 Zone PLU Read or Reset (Daily or GT) Mode Lock: X or Z Enter 13 [#] for Daily Report, or Enter 213 [#] for GT Report. Enter the zone-start PLU code, depress [@/FOR]. Then enter the zone-end PLU code, depress [AT/TL]. 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 ;B3/8B=21( 727$/ Mode Lock: X or Z 13 [#] (for Daily) 100000 [@/FOR] 199999 [AT/TL] Zone-start PLU Code -> Zone-end PLU Code ! 6PDOO%WO 'HSR For this sample PLU Code PLU Name Item Count, Amount Item Count, Amount of Total of all PLUs read in this report 70 NOTES: In Zone PLU Read Reports: • PLUs of zero sale will be skipped. • PLUs not existing in the PLU Program File memory will not be printed in reports (in any reports). 5-13 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings All PLU Read or Reset (Daily or GT) INACTIVE PLU READ (Daily or GT) Reset Report Sample (read only) Mode Lock: X or Z 13 [AT/TL] (for Daily), or 213 [AT/TL] (for GT) Mode Lock: X 13 [#] (Daily), or 213 [#] (GT). Enter 0 (zero), depress [AT/TL]. 7(& 6725( 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 =B3/8B$// 7RPDWR /HPRQ 0LON/DUJH 3DFN &KHHVH+DOI 3FN (JJ 3DFN +DOI 5ROOV 7XQD &DQ 6RXS &DQ .LZL -DP 'ULQN 6PDOO$ 6PDOO%WO 'HSR 727$/ = 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ Print data in order from lower to larger numbered PLU Code. 681 =B3/8B=(52 PLU Code 10101 Name “Tomato” Item Count, Amount NOTE: When a scaled item is entered, the item count “1” is processed into the Total Item Count of all the PLUs to be printed at the bottom, regardless of its actual weight volume. PLU Code 101301 70 3RWDWR 2UDQJH $SSOH %HHI 3RUN 0XWWRQ 6DOPRQ &RG 6KULPS 0LON6PDOO 3DFN 70 Total Item Count and Amount of all the PLUs PLU Reset Report Count (on Reset Reports only) 5-14 PLU Code Name 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings CUSTOMER FILE READ or RESET Zone Files Read or Reset (for Check Track Memory Type only) Mode Lock: X or Z Enter 15, depress [#]. Enter the zone-start File Code, depress [@/FOR]. Then enter the zone-end File Code, depress [AT/TL]. All Files (with balance remaining) Read or Reset Mode Lock: X or Z Enter 15, depress [AT/TL] 7(& 6725( 7(& 6725( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 681 681 ;B&867B=21( ;B&867B$// -$0(6 +$,/< 70 Customer’s Name File Code Balance (In this case, this is the only file with any balance remaining.) ! -$0(6 +$,/< 70 Individual Files Read Zero-balance Files Read Mode Lock: X Enter 15, depress [#]. Enter the required File Code, depress [@/FOR]. Depress [AT/TL] to end. Mode Lock: X Enter 15, depress [#]. Enter 0 (zero), depress [AT/TL]. 7(& 6725( 7(& 6725( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 681 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( ;B&8 ;B&867B,1',9 67B,1',9 +(/(1 5((' Zone-start File Code-> Zone-end File Code Customer’s Name File Code Balance (In this case, there is only one file with a balance in the designated zone.) 681 ;B&867B=(52 +(/(1 5((' Customer’s Name File Code Balance 70 70 5-15 Customer’s Name File Code 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings Credit-balance Files Read Debit-balance Files Read Mode Lock: X Enter 15, depress [#]. Enter 1, depress [AT/TL]. Mode Lock: X Enter 15, depress [#]. Enter 2, depress [AT/TL]. 7(& 6725( 7(& 6725( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 681 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 681 ;B&867B&5(' -$0(6 +$,/< ;B&867B'(%,7 Customer’s Name File Code Balance 70 In this case no debit-balance files are found at present. 70 NOTE: The program option allows you to select that data concerning the Previous Balance provided to the daily/GT financial memory (TRF TL, TRF + GT, TRF - GT, TRF +, TRF -, PB TL, PB R/A and PB PO) is all reset to zero on taking the All Customer Files Reset report. 5-16 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings PLU GROUP SALES READ or RESET (Daily or GT) Reset Report Format Sample Mode Lock: X for read Z for reset Enter 24, depress [AT/TL] (for Daily) Enter 224, depress [AT/TL] (for GT) TEC STORE 1343 PEACH DRIVE PHONE: 87-6437 Open 8:00am to 7:00pm Closed: every Wednesday 08-31-2003 SUN #3001 Z_PLU_GROUP VEGETABLE 3.22% MEAD & DAIRY 75.75% BAKERY 1.72% CAN & BTL FOOD 16.31% DRINK 2.58% BTL DEPO 0.43% TOTAL 4 $1.50 PLU Group Name Item Count Sales Percentage, Amount 15 $35.30 1 $0.80 17 $7.60 2 $1.20 4 $0.20 43 $46.60 0001Z PLU Group Sales Reset Report Count (on Reset Reports only) 0390 09:18TM 5-17 5. READ (X) AND RESET (Z) REPORTS EO1-11152 5.2 General Notes On Report Takings EFT MEDIA LOG READ or RESET This report can be taken when the connection of the EFT terminal has been programmed. Mode Lock: X for read Z for reset Enter 45, depress [AT/TL] TEC STORE 1343 PEACH DRIVE PHONE: 87-6437 Open 8:00am to 7:00pm Closed: every Wednesday 08-31-2003 SUN 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 99 #3001 X_MEDIA_LOG X_MEDIA_LOG $252.23 3 $62.00 2 $74.62 2 $0.00 0 $0.00 0 $0.00 0 $0.00 0 $102.60 6 $24.12 3 $82.56 5 $598.13 21 AMEX (Amount, Count) VISA (Amount, Count) Master Card (Amount, Count) Discover (Amount, Count) Private Label (Amount, Count) Diner’s Club or Carte Blanche (Amount, Count) JCB (Amount, Count) Debit (Amount, Count) EBT F/S (Amount, Count) EBT CASH (Amount, Count) Total for all card types (Amount, Count) 0393 19:42TM GT REPORTS The print form and items of a GT report are the same as those of its corresponding daily report, except the report header portion. Please also note that some items provided in the daily report are not provided in its GT reports. The counters and totals in a GT report are records accumulated for a certain period (week, month, etc.) while those counters and totals in the daily report are usually records for a day. The accumulated record data in each GT report will be renewed when its GTZ report has been taken. Header Example Z_DP_ALL GTX_DP_ALL All Department Read Report (Daily) All Department GT Read Report 5-18 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS This chapter is provided for the store programmer or the store manager who may have to change the programmed data of the ECR on the daily, weekly, or monthly basis. Usually, all the basic program data required for your store should be set before delivering the product by your local TOSHIBA TEC representative. However, in need of changing or adding program data, please refer to this chapter. It is also recommended to read the OPERATOR’S GUIDE as well as other chapters of the MANAGER’S GUIDE in order to thoroughly understand the descriptions in this chapter. If there are any unclear points or program data other than listed here must be changed or added, please contact your TOSHIBA TEC representative. TABLE OF PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS (Page) Basic Key Functions and Keyboard Variations in Programming Operations ...................................................... 6- 2 Character Entries ................................................................................................................................................. 6- 4 Condition Required for Programming Operations ............................................................................................... 6- 8 Submode No. 1: Store Name Message and Commercial Message Programming ......................................... 6- 9 Submode No. 2: Cashier Code and Name Programming ............................................................................... 6-11 Submode No. 4: PLU Table Programming ..................................................................................................... 6-13 Submode No. 5: Time Setting or Adjustment .................................................................................................. 6-24 Submode No. 6: Date Setting or Adjustment .................................................................................................. 6-25 Submode No. 8: Amount Limit Setting for Function Keys ............................................................................... 6-25 Submode No. 15: Customer File Code (Check Track No.) and Name Setting ................................................. 6-26 Submode No. 20: Salesperson Code and Name Programming ....................................................................... 6-28 Submode No. 25: Link-PLU Table Programming .............................................................................................. 6-29 Submode No. 26: Tare Table and General Unit Weight Setting ....................................................................... 6-30 Submode No. 27: PLU Preset-Code Key Setting ............................................................................................. 6-32 Submode No. 31: Display Message Programming ........................................................................................... 6-35 Submode No. 35: Negative Amount Key Limit Amount Setting ........................................................................ 6-37 Submode No.40: PLU Price Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Amount Setting ................................................... 6-38 No Submode No.: Department Preset Price Setting or Changing ..................................................................... 6-39 PLU Preset Price Setting or Changing, Whole Package Quantity Changing ...................... 6-40 %+ and %- Preset Rate Setting ........................................................................................... 6-41 Preset Rate Setting for Selective Itemizers (SI1 and SI2) ................................................... 6-42 Foreign Currency Exchange Rate Setting ........................................................................... 6-44 TAX Table Setting ................................................................................................................ 6-45 Store/Register No. Setting ................................................................................................... 6-47 6- 1 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.1 Basic Key Functions and Keyboard Variations in Programming Operations 6.1 Basic Key Functions and Keyboard Variations in Programming Operations 6.1.1 Basic Key Functions 1. The following are main keys and their functions to be used in programming operations: [@/FOR] (or [X]) ------------------------- Used to enter the program Submode No. ( NOTE below) [ST] or [NS] ------------------------------- Used to enter the Address No. or Item Code. Also used to end the item data entry. [#] -------------------------------------------- Used to enter data for the address or item. Each character also entered through this key. [ITEM CORR] ----------------------------- When you enter incorrect settings, depressing this key can return the display to the previous item setting. [AT/TL] ------------------------------------- Used to end the entire program Submode sequence. NOTE: Regarding programming operations in this chapter, the [X] key instead of the [@/FOR] key is shown. 2. Function of the [C] key: ù When an entered program data is already printed, the [C] key cannot clear if any longer. To correct the data, re-enter it. ù Before the entered data is printed, the data may be cleared by the [C] key (except in the SFKC Programming Operation). 3. To clarify the operation flow, definitions of keys of the ECR keyboard are as shown below. | | --------- Selective numeric value which is entered through the Numeric keys. [ ]---------- Depression of the function key. xxxx ------------ Fixed numeric value which is entered through the Numeric keys. Fixed 6.1.2 Keyboard Variations in Programming Operations This ECR provides several keyboards for programming operations. Depending on which keyboard is used, the key layout and the character entry method will vary. Case 1: When the ECR Keyboard is Ordinary Type (Stroke-key Type) 1-1 When the Ordinary keyboard alone is used for programming, follow the instructions as they are described in this manual. For character settings, use the CHARACTER CODE TABLE (later stated). None of the DIRECT CHARACTER ENTRY methods are possible. 1-2 When the PLU Keyboard PK-2 (hardware option) is connected: 1) Character Keys provided on the PK-2 Character Setting Sheet may be used to directly enter the characters (DIRECT CHARACTER ENTRY method). Any characters not provided there (and those provided as well) may be entered, in the CHARACTER CODE ENTRY method, through the Numeric Keys and the [#] key on the ECR keyboard. 6- 2 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.1 Basic Key Functions and Keyboard Variations in Programming Operations 2) All Function keys ([C], [@/FOR], [ST], [AT/TL], [DP#], etc.) must be operated on the ECR keyboard. 3) In the following operations, however, the Character Setting Sheet should be removed and the keys on the PK-2 are used as PLU Preset-code Keys: • PLU PRESET-CODE KEY SETTING (Submode 27 in this chapter) Case 2: When the ECR Keyboard is Flat Keyboard Type: The Flat Keyboard will be set with the “Setting Mode Key Layout” in the programming operations including character entries. On this keyboard, functions and locations of keys required in various programming operations are fixed. Characters on the key sheet can be entered directly through this keyboard. The Character Code Entry method is also allowed. NOTE: If an option keyboard (PK-2) is connected, the DIRECT CHARACTER ENTRY method is allowed through both the ECR keyboard and the option keyboard. 6- 3 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.2 Character Entries 6.2 Character Entries As already stated, there are two methods of operations for character settings for names or messages: CHARACTER CODE ENTRY Method and DIRECT CHARACTER ENTRY Method. CHARACTER CODE ENTRY Method This method is to set a character by entering a Character Code and depressing the [#] key. This method is allowed in either of Case 1 and Case 2, but is operated only on the ECR keyboard (Ordinary Type or Flat Type). DIRECT CHARACTER ENTRY Method This method is to set a character by directly depressing the Character Key on any of the following keyboard: • Flat Keyboard (ECR Keyboard Flat Type) with “Setting Mode Key Layout” sheet (refer to Case 2) • PK-2 Keyboard (PLU Keyboard; hardware option) By using those character keys, the characters are directly entered. In this manual, sample operations are attached to most of the programming operations. And at name or message programming portions, characters are entered by the CHARACTER CODE ENTRY method. Instead of this, you may depress the Character Keys. For example, instead of entering 401 [#] (to enter character “A”), you may simply depress Character Key “A” on any of the above three keyboards. On the following pages, Character Code Tables under the CHARACTER CODE ENTRY Method and three different keyboards under the DIRECT CHARACTER ENTRY Method are shown. These pages are to be referred to, every time the “Character Entries” sequence is contained in various programming operations in this manual. Read through these pages at least once first, so that you may know the appropriate method of character entries using the ECR keyboard and/or option keyboards. 6- 4 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.2 Character Entries 6.2.1 Character Code Entry Method Character Code Table 1: Standard Characters Column Code 2 3 4 5 6 7 9 10 11 12 13 SP 0 @ P ` p ¼ á Å \ ! 1 A Q a q é å ← " 2 B R b r í Ø ↓ 03 # 3 C S c s ó ø ↑ 04 $ 4 D T d t , ú Æ ½ 05 % 5 E U e u • â æ ¼ 06 & 6 F V f v Ä ê Œ 07 ' 7 G W g w Ë î œ Ì 08 ( 8 H X h x Ö ô Kg 09 ) 9 I Y i y Ü û ¢ lb 10 * : J Z j z É à £ No 11 + ; K [ k { ä è - X 12 , < L ¥ l | ë ì 13 - = M ] m } ï ç ÷ 14 . > N ^ n ¯ ö Ñ F 15 / ? O _ o ü ñ 00 01 Row Code NOTE: 02 8 14 15 → V U Characters of those character codes 1007, 1206, 1207, 1211, 1500 through 1503, and 1506 through 1514 cannot be printed on the slip printer. 6- 5 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.2 Character Entries Character Setting Operations • To set a regular-sized character, enter the COL (column) code and then the ROW code, followed by the [#] key. ex.) To set “%”, enter 205 and depress [#]. To set “kg” enter 1508, and depress [#]. • To set a blank instead of a character, simply depress [#] without a prior entry, or enter 200 and depress [#]. • Depress the [@/FOR] key once prior to regular-sized character entry, and it will be a double-sized character (a blank will also be double-sized). ex.) To set “GROUP”, “G” in double-sized, and “ROUP” in regular-sized: [@/FOR] 407 [#] G 502 [#] R 515 [#] O 505 [#] U 500 [#] P Depress the [@/FOR] key twice prior to the first character code entry to set the entire message line or enter name will all double-sized characters. ex.) To set “GROUP” all in double-sized: To set “Drink”, all in double-sized; • 407 [#] G [@/FOR] [@/FOR] 502 [#] R 415 [#] O 505 [#] U 500 [#] P All Double-sized Declaration 6.2.2 Direct Character Entry Method Using Flat Keyboard (installed as the ECR Main Keyboard): -- Setting Mode Key Layout -(Use the special template for this purpose and insert it between the film layers covering the flat keyboard. This key layout is applicable to only certain submodes.) Q A Z q a z ! 1 W S X w s x @ 2 E D C e d c # 3 R F V r f v $ 4 T G B t g b % 5 Y H N y h n & 6 U J M u j m : 7 I K , i k ( 8 Character Key in Programming O L . o l ? ) 9 P ; / p * – SP 0 RF # JF NS C 8 5 2 00 @/FOR ALL VOID ITEM CORR PLU 7 4 1 0 9 6 3 • DP# ST AT/TL Function key in programming Character Keys: Simply depress the key to enter the character. (The [#] key should not follow.) Then numerics 1 to 0 are entered as characters 1 to 0 but not as codes for PLU Item Codes, etc. Function Keys: These are function keys to be used in programming operations with the Setting Mode Key Layout. The numeric Keys here are used to enter PLU Codes, etc. or numeric values as program data, but not to enter the numerics as characters. 6- 6 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.2 Character Entries Using PK-2 (PLU Keyboard; hardware option) The PK-2 is used to enter a required PLU code by simply depressing the code-preset key on the PK-2 keyboard in the “REG” or “MGR” mode. In addition, the PK-2 can be used to enter characters directly during the programming operations that require character settings, such as STORE NAME/MESSAGE AND COMMERCIAL MESSAGE PROGRAMMING, DEPARTMENT TABLE PROGRAMMING, etc. The figure below shows the key indications of the PK-2 keyboard for the character setting purpose. Insert the template for this purpose between the film layers that cover the PK-2 keyboard. Instead of entering a 3 or 4 digit character code and depressing the [#] key on the ECR keyboard, a simple depression of the appropriate key on the PK-2 keyboard will be the character entry. All the function keys, such as [@/FOR], [ST], [#]. [AT/TL], etc. must be operated on the ECR side. Any characters not listed on the template may be entered by the CHARACTER CODE ENTRY method on the ECR keyboard (the characters even listed on the template may be entered as well by that method). Please note also that the keys “0” to “9” in the figure below function as character keys but do not function for code entries. Any code entries, for Menu Item Codes, Address Nos, etc. must be entered through the Numeric Keys on the ECR keyboard. The One Double-size Declaration (by depressing the [@/FOR] key once prior to the required character) and the All Double-sized Declaration (by depressing [@/FOR] twice before all the characters) are the same as in the CHARACTER CODE ENTRY method. 7 8 9 4 5 6 1 2 3 ! @ # $ % ¢ & * ( ) q w e r t y u i o P ~ ^ a s d f g h j k l " _ + z x c v b n m ' - = Q W E R T Y U I O P [ ] A S D F G H J K L ; : , Z X C V B N M space . / ? 6- 7 0 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.3 Condition Required for Programming Operations 6.3 Condition Required for Programming Operations “CONDITION” is given at the top of each programming operation. The ECR must satisfy this condition to perform programming operations. There are two types of conditions: “Any time outside a sale” It means that the programming operation is allowed when a sale is finalized before going into any other sale entry. “After------ reset” It means that the designated reset report must be taken before entering the programming operation. And an error will result if the operation is attempted without taking the report. However, the words “After ... Reset” do not necessarily mean “immediately after ...”. When the designated reset report has already been taken and then some operations are performed in the SET, X, or Z mode, the condition “After ... Reset” is still satisfied and the programming operation is still allowed. On the contrary, when the designated reset report has been taken but then some sales data relating to that report’s output data are entered in the REG, MGR, or - mode, the programming operation will no longer be allowed and the same reset report must be taken. Thus the condition “After ... Reset” indicates that all the sales data relating to the report data must be zero (except non-resettable memory data). Because of this “CONDITION” requirement, the report data will be protected from any inconsistencies of sales data entered in the period from a resetting of the report to another resetting of the same report next time. 6- 8 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.4 Store Name Message and Commercial Message Programming (Submode 1) 6.4 Store Name Message and Commercial Message Programming (Submode 1) Store Name Message and Commercial Message to be printed on the receipt can be programmed here. CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET Repeat for another line. |Line No.| [ST] 1 [X] 1 digit (1 to 7) 1 to 4: Store Name Message 5 to 7: Commercial Message (For sequentially programming lines, the line number specification can be skipped.) [ST] Character Entries Max. 32 characters/line (See Section 6.2 Character Entries.) NOTES: [AT/TL] To complete this line. To complete this programming operation. 1. For each line, a maximum of 32 regular-sized characters or 16 double-sized characters can be entered. A combination of both types is also available. 2. When blanks are entered for the whole one line, it results in one line feed. 3. If no commercial message is required on the receipt, program blanks for all three lines. As a result no extra lines will be fed. If any one of the three lines is programmed, the two other lines will cause line feeds. 4. The 4-line range assigned for the store name/message will be either printed or fed, regardless of any system option selection. 5. If any incorrect characters have been programmed, depress the [C] key to clear all the characters on a line and then re-enter characters from the beginning, or end the line with an [ST] and re-program the entire line. The new data will be active. 6. When all the lines have been programmed, do a check by issuing a receipt. Only the lines with errors need to be re-programmed; other lines will not be affected. Example) To program the following Store Message and Commercial Message T E C 1 3 4 3 S T P E A C H P H O N E : O R E D R I V E 8 7 - 6 4 3 7 Line No. 1 Line No. 2 Line No. 3 Store Name/Message portion Line No. 4 O p e n C l o s e d : 8 : 0 0 a m e v e r y t o 7 : 0 0 p m Line No. 5 W e d n e s d a y Line No. 6 Line No. 7 6- 9 Commercial Message portion 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.4 Store Name Message and Commercial Message Programming (Submode 1) Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 1 and depress the [X] key. 1 [ST] (Line No. 1) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [X] [5] [0] [4] [#] (T ) [X] [4] [0] [5] [#] (E ) [X] [4] [0] [3] [#] (C ) [X] [#] (Space) [X] [5] [0] [3] [#] (S ) [X] [5] [0] [4] [#] (T ) [X] [4] [1] [5] [#] (O ) [X] [5] [0] [2] [#] (R ) [X] [4] [0] [5] [#] (E ) [ST] (to complete Line 1) 2 [ST] (Line No. 2) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [3] [0] [1] [#] (1) [3] [0] [3] [#] (3) [3] [0] [4] [#] (4) [3] [0] [3] [#] (3) [#] (Space) [5] [0] [0] [#] (P) [4] [0] [5] [#] (E) [4] [0] [1] [#] (A) [4] [0] [3] [#] (C) [4] [0] [8] [#] (H) [#] (Space) [4] [0] [4] [#] (D) [5] [0] [2] [#] (R) [4] [0] [9] [#] (I) [5] [0] [6] [#] (V) [4] [0] [5] [#] (E) [ST] (to complete Line 2) 3 [ST] (Line No. 3) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [5] [0] [0] [#] (P) [4] [0] [8] [#] [4] [1] [5] [#] [4] [1] [4] [#] [4] [0] [5] [#] [3] [1] [0] [#] [#] [3] [0] [8] [#] [3] [0] [7] [#] [2] [1] [3] [#] [3] [0] [6] [#] [3] [0] [4] [#] [3] [0] [3] [#] [3] [0] [7] [#] [ST] (H) (O) (N) (E) (:) (Space) (8) (7) (-) (6) (4) (3) (7) (to complete Line 3) 5 [ST] (Line No. 5) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [4] [1] [5] [#] (O) [7] [0] [0] [#] (p) [6] [0] [5] [#] (e) [6] [1] [4] [#] (n) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [3] [0] [8] [#] (8) [3] [1] [0] [#] (:) [3] [0] [0] [#] (0) [3] [0] [0] [#] (0) [6] [0] [1] [#] (a) [6] [1] [3] [#] (m) [#] (Space) [7] [0] [4] [#] (t) [6] [1] [5] [#] (o) [#] (Space) [3] [0] [7] [#] (7) [3] [1] [0] [#] (:) [3] [0] [0] [#] (0) [3] [0] [0] [#] (0) [7] [0] [0] [#] (p) [6] [1] [3] [#] (m) [ST] (to complete Line 5) 6 [ST] (Line No. 6) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [#] (Space) [4] [0] [3] [#] (C) [6] [1] [2] [#] (l) [6] [1] [5] [#] (o) [7] [0] [3] [#] (s) [6] [0] [5] [#] (e) [6] [0] [4] [#] (d) [3] [1] [0] [#] (:) 6-10 [#] [6] [0] [5] [#] [7] [0] [6] [#] [6] [0] [5] [#] [7] [0] [2] [#] [7] [0] [9] [#] [#] [5] [0] [7] [#] [6] [0] [5] [#] [6] [0] [4] [#] [6] [1] [4] [#] [6] [0] [5] [#] [7] [0] [3] [#] [6] [0] [4] [#] [6] [0] [1] [#] [7] [0] [9] [#] [ST] (Space) (e) (v) (e) (r) (y) (Space) (W) (e) (d) (n) (e) (s) (d) (a) (y) (to complete Line 6) [AT/TL] (to complete this submode) )5, 3 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 70 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.5 Cashier Code and Name Programming (Submode 2) 6.5 Cashier Code and Name Programming (Submode 2) Cashier Code and Name, and Cashier Status for each cashier can be programmed here. 6.5.1 Programming CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET 2 [X] |Cashier Code| [NS] (See NOTE 1 below.) Address 1: Cashier Name 1 [ST] [ST] Character entries Max. 12 characters (See NOTE 2 below.) Address 2: Cashier Status For sequentially programming the address, the Address number specification can be skipped. 2 [ST] |Cashier Status| [#] 0: Cashier for sale entries 1: Cashier for training entries (NOTE 3) Repeat for another cashier. [AT/TL] NOTES: (To complete this submode.) 1. The following table shows the Cashier Codes that can be entered (the capacity is determined by the RAM Allocation Setting). Code entry type Cashier key type [CLK] key * 2. 3. 4. 5. Standard memory Expansion memory 1 to 15 1 to 99 1 to 8, 99* --- The Cashier Code 99 for the Cashier Key Type is fixed as a code of a cashier for Training Entries. For the name of each cashier, a maximum of 12 regular-sized or 6 double-sized characters can be entered. A combination of both types is also available. Training entry status is available for every cashier. When the center file is used, this programming cannot be performed on the Satellite Terminal. Prior to the change of cashier status (Normal cashier → Training cashier, or Training cashier → Normal cashier), daily reports and GT reports of this cashier should be taken. 6-11 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.5 Cashier Code and Name Programming (Submode 2) Example) To program the following cashier data Cashier Code 1: Name JONES, Status 0 (for Sale Entries) Cashier Code 2: Name SMITH, Status 0 (for Sale Entries) Cashier Code 3: Name MEHL, Status 1 (for Training Entries) Cashier Code 4: Name BROWN, Status 1 (for Training Entries) Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 2 and depress the [X] key. 1 [NS] (Cashier Code) 1 [ST] (Address 1: Cashier Name) 410 [#] (J) 415 [#] (O) 414 [#] (N) 405 [#] (E) 503 [#] (S) [ST] (to end Cashier Name setting) (2 [ST]) (Address 2: Cashier Status) 0 [#] (for Sales Entries) 2 [NS] (Cashier Code) 1 [ST] (Address 1: Cashier Name) 503 [#] (S) 3 [NS] (Cashier Code) 1 [ST] (Address 1: Cashier Name) 413 [#] (M) 412 [#] [ST] (2 [ST]) 1 [#] 408 [#] (H) [ST] (to end Cashier Name setting) (2 [ST]) (Address 2: Cashier Status) 0 [#] (for Sales Entries) 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( (L) (to end Cashier Name setting) (Address 2: Cashier Status) (for Training Entries) 4 [NS] (Cashier Code) 1 [ST] (Address 1: Cashier Name) 402 [#] (B) 414 [#] [ST] (2 [ST]) 1 [#] 7(& 6725( (N) (to end Cashier Name setting) (Address 2: Cashier Status) (for Training Entries) 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ )5, 3 -21(6 70 [AT/TL] (to end this submode.) 6.5.2 Deletion CONDITION After the Daily and GT Cashier’s Resets, (and his/her Sign OFF for Code Entry Type) OPERATION Mode Lock: SET Repeatable for another cashier to be deleted. 2 [X] NOTES: [ITEM CORR] or [VOID] |Cashier Code| [NS] 1. The Cashier Reset Report Count of the deleted cashier will be cleared. 2. The cashier key or cashier code of the deleted cashier cannot be used or signed-ON for sale entries. Example) To delete Cashier Code 1 with name “JONES” that has been programmed in the preceding page: Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 2 and depress the [X] key. [ITEM CORR] (for declaration of deletion) 1 [NS] (Cashier Code) [AT/TL] (to end this program.) [AT/TL] 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ )5, 3 -21(6 70 6-12 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.6 PLU Table Programming (Submode 4) 6.6 PLU Table Programming (Submode 4) This submode can be operated when new PLU items are to be added, PLU program data is to be changed, or PLUs are to be deleted. 6.6.1 Programming or Changing CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET (See NOTE 2.) As for details of each Address, refer to the following pages. 4 [X] Barcode Scanning |Address Numbers| [#] |PLU Code| [PLU] (See NOTE 1.) for sequential-coded item only Address 1: Link Department |Department Code| [#] 1 [ST] (1 to 99) Address 2: PLU Name 2 [ST] Character Entries [ST] Max. 16 characters Address 3: Preset Price 3 [ST] |Price| [#] (Max. 6 digits) Address 4: Status Code 1 4 [ST] |Status Codes to ON| [#] Address 5: Status Code 2 5 [ST] |Status Codes to ON| [#] Address 6: Tax Status 6 [ST] |Status Codes| [#] (Max. 4 digits) Repeat for other PLUs. Repeat for any address within the same PLU by re-entry for correction. (NOTE 3) Address 7: Unit Price of Individual Split Package 7 [ST] |Unit Price| [#] (Max. 6 digits) Address 8: Whole Package Quantity 8 [ST] |Whole Package Quantity| [#] (Max. 2 digits) Address 9: PLU Group No. 9 [ST] |PLU Group No.| [#] (1 to 99; 0 to reset) Address 10: Link-PLU Table No. 10 [ST] |Link-PLU Table No.| [#] (1 to 99; 0 to reset) Address 11: Tare Table No. 11 [ST] |Tare Table No.| [#] (1 to 9; 0 to reset) Address 12: Unit Weight Code 12 [ST] |Unit Weight Code| [#] (1 to 11; 0 to reset) Address 13: Mix & Match Group No. 13 [ST] |Mix & Match Group No.| [#] (1 to 255; 0 to reset) Address 14: Tare 2 Rate 14 [ST] |Tare 2 Rate| [#] (0.01 to 99.99%; 0 to reset) Address 15: Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Code 15 [ST] |Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Code| [#] (1 to 99; 0 to reset) [AT/TL] (To complete this submode.) 6-13 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.6 PLU Table Programming (Submode 4) NOTES: 1. The “Address Numbers” designation at the top after “4 [X]” can be skipped if not necessary. If entered, the designated Address(es) will automatically be accessed after the PLU Code designation. 2. A maximum of 65,000 PLUs (5,000 PLUs as standard when the Expansion Memory is installed) are programmable (varies depending on the capacity and allocation of the RAM). Also refer to the “CODING PLUs” to be described at the end of this section. The “[PLU]” key here indicates the key labeled simply as “PLU” but not any PLU Preset-code Keys. 3. When the Address No. is sequential from the preceding address (if the Address Designation feature has not been used), the Address No. and the following [ST] can be omitted. 4. The programming contents of each address are further described in the PLU TABLE PROGRAMMING CONTENTS below. PLU TABLE PROGRAMMING CONTENTS Address No. 1 Description of Programming Contents Linked Department Code Enter the 2-digit code of the department to which the PLU is linked. When the PLU is newly programmed, this entry is compulsory (an error will result if this entry is skipped.) [#] 1 to 99 2 PLU Name (Descriptor) Enter a maximum of 16 regular-sized or 8 double-sized characters by referring Section 6.2 Character Entries, then end with the [ST] key. When no name is programmed for a PLU, the following will be the auto-program name for printing: PLUxxxxxx (for PLU Code Max. 6-digit feature) PLUxxxxxxxxxxxxx (for PLU Code Max. 13-digit feature) NOTE: For details, please contact your nearest TOSHIBA TEC representative. 3 Preset Price • For a preset PLU (preset-price PLU), enter a maximum of 6-digit price, and depress the [#] key. 1 to 999999 (result: $0.01 to $9999.99) When the option “Preset Point for one decimal digit allowed” is selected, the decimal digit can be entered after entering a maximum of 5 integer digits and the [.] key. 1 to 99999 (result: $0.01 to $999.99) or 0.1 to 99999.9 (result: $0.001 to $999.999) • A zero-price ($0.00) may be preset by entering 0 in the above operation. • When no numerics are entered and the [#] key is simply depressed, the PLU will be an open PLU (open-price PLU). 6-14 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.6 PLU Table Programming (Submode 4) PLU TABLE PROGRAMMING CONTENTS (continued) Address No. 4 Description of Programming Contents Status Code 1 Selection • Enter Codes 1 to 7 whose status must be set to ON side. More than one code may be entered. Enter 0 when none of the statuses should be set to ON. Code 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Item Quantity Entry Net to Selective Itemizer 1 Net to Selective Itemizer 2 Food Stamp Status Scale Entry HI-CONE Status Lock or Unlock Status Delete Status Selective Status ON OFF Compulsory Optional Yes No Yes No Yes No Compulsory Prohibited Yes No Lock (not in use) Unlock (in use) Yes No NOTES: Code 1: Quantity Entry Compulsion • When this status is selected, the quantity entry is always necessary for PLU item entry. Code 2,3: Net to Selective Itemizer 1, 2 • Refer to Section 6.21 Preset Rate Setting for Selective Itemizers. Code 5: Scale Entry • This status and the HI-CONE Status (Code 6) cannot be combined for one PLU. • The Scale Entry status is unavailable for the Age Limit 1 and 2 (Codes 6 and 7 in status 2 selection). Code 6: HI-CONE Status • This status requires setting of the Whole Package Quantity (Address 8). Code 7: Lock Status • When this status is set to a PLU, an entry of the PLU in a sale is prohibited. Code 8: Delete Status • This status can be set only to a PLU of sales data 0 in the stand-alone system with PLU expansion memory or the M/S system with “PLU to be inquired” feature. When this status is set to a PLU, an entry of the PLU in a sale is not allowed. PLU which has the this status is deleted from the PLU Table File when the PLU Merge is executed. • This status set is possible only when the PLU center file is selected. Setting Examples: To set only Status 2 to ON …........... Enter 2 [#] To set Statuses 2, 3, 5 to ON …....... Enter 235 [#] To set none of statuses to ON …..... Enter 0 [#] 6-15 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.6 PLU Table Programming (Submode 4) PLU TABLE PROGRAMMING CONTENTS (continued) Address No. 5 Description of Programming Contents Status Code 2 Selection • Enter Codes 2 to 7 (Code 3 is vacant.) whose status must be set to ON side. More than one code may be entered. Enter 0 when none of the statuses should be set to ON. Code 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Item Price Print Tare 3 Entry -- vacant -Tax Symbol “F” Print Canada Non-taxable Quantity Age Limit 2 Status (alcohol) Age Limit 1 Status (cigarette) Selective Status ON OFF Non-print Print Compulsory Optional Print Objective Necessary Necessary Non-print Not objective Unnecessary Unnecessary NOTES: Code 1: Price Print • When this status is set to ON (Non-print), PLU price will not be printed. However, when the Quantity Extension transaction is performed for the PLU, its price will be always printed regardless of this status selection. Do not set this status code ON. Code 4: Tax Symbol “F” Print • Tax symbol “F” is printed when this status code has been set “ON” to a taxable PLU. • If the Food Stamp feature has been selected, this symbol “F” will be always printed regardless of this code status when a food stamp taxable department is entered. * In Canada, some area handles two kinds of tax; GST and PST. Status Code 4 (Tax Symbol “F” Print) should be set at the GST status setting. Tax Symbol “T” ...... PST Tax Symbol “F” ...... GST Status Code 6,7: Age Limit Status 2, 1 • When the Age Limit 1 or Age Limit 2 Status is set to ON, the age confirmation is always necessary before entering a sales item. • The Age Limit 2 or Age Limit 1 Status (Code 6 or 7) is unavailable for the Scale Entry Compulsory PLU (Code 5 in Status 1 Selection). 6 Tax Status • Enter one- to four-digit Status Codes for applicable Taxes. [#] 0: Non-taxable 1: Tax 1 (Tax 1 taxable) 2: Tax 2 (Tax 2 taxable) 3: Tax 3 (Tax 3 taxable) 4: Tax 4 (Tax 4 taxable) (More than one code can be entered for combining Tax1 to Tax4 taxable status. For example, enter 12 to select Tax1 and Tax2 taxable status.) NOTES: 1. The rate of each Tax will be later be set and described in Section 6.23 Tax Table Programming. 2. In case of inclusive tax, the combination of the tax status is unavailable. Only one inclusive tax status can be programmed for a PLU. (Tax 3 taxable or Tax 4 taxable) 6-16 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.6 PLU Table Programming (Submode 4) PLU TABLE PROGRAMMING CONTENTS (continued) Address No. 7 Description of Programming Contents Unit Price of Individual Split Package • The unit price of individual split package can be programmed regardless of the HI-CONE status. • For preset the unit price of individual split package, enter a maximum of 6-digit price, and depress [#]. • To cancel the unit price of individual split package, enter 0 and depress [#]. (When the unit price of individual split package is not preset (or 0), whole package price (Address 3 setting) will be used in the registration. • When HI-CONE PLU is entered as an open-price PLU, use the unit price of whole package instead of that of individual split package. 8 Whole Package Quantity (for Split Package Pricing PLUs) [#] Enter the whole package quantity in max. 2 digits (1 to 99), or enter 0 to cancel the Split Package Pricing status. Be sure to set a whole package quantity here for PLUs with HI-CONE Status (Address 4 - Code 6) or Mix & Match Group No. (Address 13). NOTES: 1. This setting is not allowed for PLUs with the Scale-compulsory status. 2. When the option “Preset Point for one decimal digit” is selected, this setting is not allowed to any PLUs. (For details, please contact your nearest TOSHIBA TEC representative.) 9 PLU Group No. (for purposes of reports) • Enter a 2-digit code (1 to 99) as a PLU Group No. to which the PLU belongs, and depress [#]. To cancel the Group No. once set, enter 0 and depress [#]. • For HASH PLU, the PLU Group No. setting is available. 10 Link-PLU Table No. (for PLU-to-PLU linking requirement only) • This entry is useful, similar to the “Sub-link Dept.” feature in the Department Table Programming operation, when the PLU item entry should always be followed by another PLU item sale. If the PLU is not applied to this case, skip this address entry. Refer to the following examples of applications: Example 1) Example 2) HEAD-LINK PLU PLU 1 (Drink Small Bottle Net Content at $0.45 SUB-LINK PLU PLU 2 (Bottle Deposit for the small bottle at $0.05 PLU 101 (Battery-drive Clock at $20.00) PLU 202 (Battery-drive Pack at $1.50) As shown in the examples, this feature prevents the cashier from forgetting to enter the Sublink PLU item attached to the Head-link PLU item. And at the same time, in reports, two PLU Totals are separately read. • In setting, enter the Link-PLU Table No. (1 to 99) and then depress [#]. [#] 1 to 99 (Link-PLU Table No. The Sub-link PLU which link to the Link-PLU Table will be programmed in a separate programming operation later.) • To cancel the sub-linking, enter 0 instead of the Link-PLU Table No. before [#]. 6-17 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.6 PLU Table Programming (Submode 4) PLU TABLE PROGRAMMING CONTENTS (continued) Address No. Description of Programming Contents (10) REMARKS: 1) When the Head-link PLU is entered in a sale, the Sub-link PLU will automatically be entered. When the Sub-link PLU is an open-price PLU, the price entry and the [AMT] key depression should follow manually on the main keyboard. This manual operation sequence cannot be replaced by a PLU Preset-code Key on the main keyboard or on the PK-2 keyboard. 2) The PLU-to-PLU linkage is effective even when the Head-link PLU is an open-price PLU. 3) The linkage of the Sub-link PLU is as shown below. • Head-link PLU (one PLU) + Sub-link PLU (Max. seven PLUs) The linkage of the Sub-link PLU is effective so that up to seven Sub-link PLUs can be entered. If eight or more Sub-link PLUs are programmed, they will be ignored at the item entry. 4) It is possible to set multiple PLUs as Head-link to one Sub-link PLU. (In Example 1 described above, it may be extended to have more Head-link PLUs of similar items such as Drink Large, which also link to the Bottle Deposit of the same amount.) 5) Repeat, Item Correct, Dollar Discount, Vendor Coupon, Bottle Return, %+, or %operations are not accepted for PLU-to-PLU link entries. But Return Merchandise or Void operation is possible for the Head-link (and the Sub-link PLU will be processed as returned or voided item automatically, in this case). 6) The Sub-link PLU may be operated for sales entries, skipping the Head-link PLU, without affecting the Head-link PLU sales memory. 7) Multiplication is possible on the Head-link PLU, and then the Sub-link PLU will automatically be multiplied with the same quantity. 8) Modifier Keys (such as [SI/M]) will be effective for the Head-link PLU item only, and the modification will be disregarded for the Sub-link PLU. 9) When an error occurs at the Sub-link PLU, only the Head-link PLU is entered but not the Sub-link PLU. (Errors such as Multiplication Product Over-limit Error, the Sub-link PLU has not been opened, the sale subtotal will turn into negative, etc.) 10) When the Sub-link is a negative PLU, a Return Merchandise or Void entry through the Head-link PLU is not possible. 11) None of Scale-Compulsory PLUs should be linked as Sub-link to another PLU of Headlink. An error will result on the Head-link item entry attempt in this case. 12) When a price-change entry is made (using the [PR OPEN] or [OPEN] key) through the Head-link PLU, the Sub-link PLU will always require a manual amount entry (through [AMT]) even when the Sub-link is a preset-price PLU. 13) PLU with the Age Limit Status or with the Quantity Entry Compulsion Status programmed cannot be used for Link-PLU. 11 Tare Table No. (for Scale-compulsory PLUs only) [#] Enter the Tare Table No. (1 to 9). The content of each Tare Table is set later in a separate operation (Submode 26). In a scale item entry of a PLU with a Tare Table No. set, the tare weight preset in the Tare Table will automatically be subtracted from the total weight read from the scale. Enter 0 to cancel a Tare Table No. once set. Or skip this address setting for PLUs not needing any tare weight calculations. 6-18 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.6 PLU Table Programming (Submode 4) PLU TABLE PROGRAMMING CONTENTS (continued) Address No. 12 Description of Programming Contents Individual PLU Unit Weight Table Code (for Scale-compulsory PLUs only) [#] LB unit Kg unit 0: General Unit Weight (Set in Submode 26) 1: 1 LB 1 Kg 2: 2 LB 2 Kg 3: 3 LB 3 Kg 4: 4 LB 4 Kg 5: 5 LB 5 Kg 6: 6 LB 6 Kg 7: 7 LB 7 Kg 8: 8 LB 8 Kg 9: 9 LB 9 Kg 10: 1/2 LB 100 g 11: 1/4 LB not applicable NOTE: Whether the ECR adopts the LB or Kg unit system is determined by a system option selection. (For details, please contact your nearest TOSHIBA TEC representative.) 13 Mix & Match Group No. [#] Enter the Mix & Match Group No. (1 to 255). To cancel the Mix & Match Group once set, enter 0. NOTE: 14 This Mix & Match Group No. setting is only possible when a Whole Package Quantity (Address 8) is set. Tare 2 Rate • Enter a Tare 2 Rate (0 to 9999; 0% to 99.99%), and depress [#]. To cancel the Tare 2 Rate once set, enter 0 and depress [#]. 15 Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Code • Enter the Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Code (1 to 99), then depress the [#] key. Enter 0 as the Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Code to reset the code once programmed. PLU Price Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Amount Setting can be performed in Submode 40. ADDITIONAL NOTES If a PLU is linked to a negative Department, the PLU is automatically set as negative PLU. If a PLU is linked to an HASH Department, the PLU is automatically set as HASH PLU. When a negative PLU is set with the Scale-Compulsory status, an error will result in a sale entry attempt of that PLU. The Amount Limits (High Amount, Low Amount) of each open-price PLU is ruled by that of its linked department. When a PLU is linked to a Gasoline Sales Department, an error will result in a sale entry attempt of that PLU. The system option allows you to select that the Tax Status and the Food Stamp Status of each PLU are determined by those of its link department. 6-19 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.6 PLU Table Programming (Submode 4) Example) To program the following PLU data: PLU Code Link Department (Address 1) PLU Name (Address 2) Preset Price (Address 3) Status Code 1 (Address 4) Status Code 2 (Address 5) Tax Status (Address 6) Unit Price of Individual Split Package (Address 7) Whole Package Quantity (Address 8) PLU Group No. (Address 9) Link-PLU Table No. (Address 10) Tare Table No. (Address 11) Unit Weight Code (Address 12) Mix & Match Group No. (Address 13) Tare 2 Rate (Address 14) Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Code (Address 15) 10101 Dept. 1 Tomato $1.00 4 (Food Stamp Status) 4 (Tax Symbol “F” print) 1 (Tax 1 taxable) None None 1 None None None None None None Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 4 and depress the [X] key. 01020304050609 [#] Address Skip Information (Addresses 7,8,10 to 15 are skipped.) 10101 [PLU] PLU Code (1 [ST]) (Address 1) 1 [#] (Linked Dept. No.) (2 [ST]) (Address 2) 504 [#] 615 [#] 613 [#] 601 [#] 704 [#] 615 [#] [ST] (Name: Tomato) (3 [ST]) (Address 3) 100 [#] (Preset Price) (4 [ST]) (Address 4) 4 [#] (Status Code 1) (5 [ST]) (Address 5) 4 [#] (Status Code 2) (6 [ST]) (Address 6) 1 [#] (Tax Status) (9 [ST]) (Address 9) 1 [#] (PLU Group No.) [AT/TL] (Complete this submode) 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ )5, 3/8 3 7RPDWR # 70 6-20 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.6 PLU Table Programming (Submode 4) 6.6.2 Deletion CONDITION To delete a PLU with sales data of zero: Any time outside a sale To delete a PLU with sales data of not zero: After PLU Reset OPERATION Mode Lock: SET Individual PLU Deletion Barcode Scanning 4 [X] [ITEM CORR] or [VOID] |PLU Code| [DP#] [AT/TL] Repeatable for other PLUs to be deleted. Example) To delete PLU No. 90701 (Drink Small-B) that was once programmed: Key Operation Mode Lock: SET, enter 4, depress the [X] key. 7(& 6725( [ITEM CORR] 90701 [PLU] [AT/TL] 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ )5, 3 'ULQN 6PDOO% 70 All PLU Deletion 4 [X] [ITEM CORR] or [VOID] [ALL VOID] [AT/TL] NOTES: 1. If PLU items have been added to the PLU Additional File, these PLU items are also deleted by the ALL PLU Deletion operation. 2. Prior to the All PLU Deletion operation, the PLU daily reset report and the PLU GT reset report should be taken. 6-21 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.6 PLU Table Programming (Submode 4) 6.6.3 PLU Programmed Data Copying This operation is used to copy the programmed data of a PLU item and to use it in programming another PLU item, thus eliminating time in PLU programming operation. CONDITION OPERATION 4 [X] To program new PLUs or to change any programmed contents of PLUs: Any time outside a sale (except the following case) To change the PLU of the copy-destination with sales data not zero: After PLU Reset |PLU Code of the copy-destination| [PLU] [NS] |PLU Code of the copy-source| [PLU] The programmed data of the copy-source PLU is now copied to the copy-destination PLU (except the PLU Code). Then follow the procedure in Section 6.6.1 Programming or Changing to change data of any required Addresses. Example) To program PLU 90701 (Drink Small-B) again that was once programmed and then deleted, by copying the programmed data of PLU 90601 (Drink Small-A): Key Operation Mode Lock: SET, enter 4, depress the [X] key. 90701 [PLU] [NS] 90601 [PLU] 2 [ST] 404 [#] 702 [#] 609 [#] 614 [#] 611 [#] [#] 503 [#] 613 [#] 601 [#] 612 [#] 612 [#] 213 [#] 402 [#] [ST] 9 [ST] 7 [#] [AT/TL] (PLU Code of the copy-destination) 7(& 6725( (PLU Code of the copy-source) (Address 2, Name changed into: Drink Small-A) (D) (r) (i) (n) (k) (Space) (S) (m) (a) (l) (l) (-) (B) 'ULQN 6PDOO$ (Address 9, PLU Group No. changed into: 7) (to complete this submode) 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ )5, 3 'ULQN 6PDOO% 70 6-22 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.6 PLU Table Programming (Submode 4) 6.6.4 CODING PLUs (supplement to PLU programming operations) A maximum of 6-digit or 13-digit No. may be assigned to each PLU as PLU Code, depending on the system option selection of the PLU Code digits. Any number within this limit may be assigned to each PLU. The following description is applied to the “Manual PLU Entry System Type”. DIGIT LENGTH OF PLU CODES In determining the actual digit length of PLU codes, refer to the following factors: 1) The smaller the digit length, the easier and quicker the PLU sales entries will be. 2) The larger the digit length, the more precise analysis will be possible using various report functions. 3) Some stores may adopt PLU Codes of more than 2 digits (while 1- or 2-digit codes are given to Departments), to prevent confusions or mistakes in key operations. 4) Some stores may use smaller-digit codes for frequently sold PLU items while using larger-digit code for slowsale items. CODING METHODS For the purpose of classifying merchandise and for convenience of PLU report applications, any of the following methods may be taken according to each store’s requirement: 1. Coding With Linked Department Code In this method, the PLU’s linked Department Code should be contained in the PLU Code. Its Linking PLU Codes Example) Department Code 1 100, 101, 102, 103 ... 199 12 1200, 1201, 1202, 1203 ... 1299 If the linked Department Code is contained in the top 2 digits of the PLU code, as in the above examples, the following merits are expected: 1) The store cashiers and other clerks may easily see each PLU’s link Department. 2) In PLU report takings, “Zone PLU Read/Reset” reports are effective, by designating the zone of all the PLUs that link to the same Department. Example) To read all the PLUs linked to Dept. 12: Zone-start PLU Code ..... 1200 Zone-end PLU Code ...... 1299 (For more details, refer to the report section in the Owner’s Manual.) 2. Coding With Type ID for Each Digit This method is to give each digit numeric of the PLU code a certain meaning according to the merchandise, color, grade, size, wholesaler, etc. Example using 4-digit codes) -- in case of a clothing shop -2 1 3 0 Merchandise serial No. assigned under the same number of the preceding digits. Size ID (1 for Small, 2 for Medium, 3 for Large, etc.) Color ID (0 for White, 1 for Gray, 2 for Black, etc.) Wholesaler or Maker ID (1 for Company “A”, 2 for Company “B”, etc.) 6-23 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.7 Time Setting or Adjustment (Submode 5) 3. Using Bar codes (source-marking EAN or UPC bar codes) If most of the sale items in the store are printed with a source-marking UPC bar codes, the code (the humanreadable numerics attached to the bar code print) may be entered as it is. Some items are printed with 13-digit code, and others with 8-digit code. Thus this method is possible only when the option “PLU Code max. 13 digits” is selected. The merit of this system is that you can simply read and enter the source-marked code rather than generating an original code for each PLU item. If the barcode No. is used, however, it is recommended to adopt the “Scanning System Type”. 4. Combining Methods 1, 2, and 3 When the option “PLU Code max. 13 digits” is selected, some combinations of the above three methods are possible. Example 1) Combining Methods 1 and 2: x x x x x x Type IDs described in Method 2 Linked Department Code described in Method 1 Example 2) Combining Methods 3, and Method 1 or 2: For source-marked items .…use the bar codes. For other items .……………generate codes in Method 1 or Method 2, in max. 6 or 7 digits for example. After all, the methods described above are only suggestions. You may freely make up your own PLU coding method to suit each store’s merchandise controls. 6.7 Time Setting or Adjustment (Submode 5) CONDITION Anytime outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET 5 [X] |Hour| [AT/TL] |Minute| (00 to 23) (00 to 59) NOTE: If an hour value of more than 23 or a minute value of more than 59 is entered, the current data will not be changed by setting or adjusting the time. Example) To set time “1:15 p.m. (13:15)”. Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 5 and depress the [X] key. 7(& 6725( [1] [3] [1] [5] [AT/TL] 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ )5, 3 70 70 6-24 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.8 Date Setting or Adjustment (Submode 6) 6.8 Date Setting or Adjustment (Submode 6) CONDITION Anytime outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET 6 [X] |Day-of-Week Code| |Month| |Day| 2 digits 2 digits (01 to 12) (01 to 31) See NOTE 1 below 0: SUN (Sunday) 1: MON (Monday) 2: TUE (Tuesday) 3: WED (Wednesday) 4: THU (Thursday) 5: FRI (Friday) 6: SAT (Saturday) |Year| [AT/TL] 4 digits (2003, 2004, etc.) NOTES: 1. The date entry order may be Day-Month-Year or Year-Month -Day instead of Month-Day-Year if so selected in the program option. 2. If you do not want to print the Day-of Week on receipt, please contact your nearest TOSHIBA TEC representative. TEC STORE 1343 PEACH DRIVE PHONE: 87-6437 Open 8:00am to 7:00pm Closed: every Wednesday Example) To set date “August 25 (MON), 2003”. 08-22-2003 FRI Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 6 and depress the [X] key. P06 1 08-25-2003 [1] [0] [8] [2] [5] [2] [0] [0] [3] [AT/TL] 6.9 #0 0033 13:15TM Amount Limit Setting for Function Keys (Submode 8) This submode sets the high amount limit in finalizing transactions by tendering through each media key and also sets the high and low amount limits in entering amount through departments. Any time outside a sale CONDITION OPERATION 8 [X] Mode Lock: SET | Key Code | [ST] | Amount Limit Set Value | [#] Max. 2 digits (See the table below) [AT/TL] Max. 8 digits; 0 to reset NOTE 1 Repeat for another key. Key Code 1 2 3 4 5 6 NOTES: Key Code 7 8 9 10 11 12 Item or Key to be applied [AT/TL] (Cash Tender) [CHK TEND] (Check Tender) [Chg] (Charge Tender) [MISC TEND] (Misc. Tender) [CREDIT 1] (Credit 1 Tender) [CREDIT 2] (Credit 2 Tender) Item or Key to be applied [DEBIT] [EBT CASH] [EBT F/S] [FSTL/TEND] (Food Stamp Tender) Common High Limit for all depts. Common Low Limit for all depts. 1. When continuous key codes are programmed, the key code entry is omissible. 2. If the individual High or Low Amount Limit of department has been set, it prevails over the Common High or Low Limit for all departments here. 3. The Amount Limit set value of each tender media is the high amount limit and is effective only when the media key is used for tendering but not when used as total key. Different from amount limit setting of departments, an exact value on all the digits can be set for tendering media. For example, if you enter 1234[#], an amount up to $12,34 can be tendered. 6-25 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.10 Customer File Code (Check Track No.) and Name Setting (Submode 15) Example) To set the Amount Limits of the following items: Key Code Amount Limit Set Values 2 ([CHK TND]) $ 99.99 9999 11 (Common High) $ 999.99 100000 12 (Common Low) $ 0.01 1 Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 8 and depress the [X] key. 2 [ST] Item Code for Check Media Key 9999 [#] Amount Limit Set Value 11 [ST] Item Code for Common High Limit for all depts. 100000 [#] Amount Limit Set Value 12 [ST] Item Code for Common Low Limit for all depts. 1 [#] Amount Limit Set Value [AT/TL] To complete this submode 6.10 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 &+(&. 3 70 Customer File Code (Check Track No.) and Name Setting (Submode 15) This submode creates files for customers whose sales are to be processed using the check track memory. CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET Repeat for other codes * 15 [X] For sequentially programming codes, the code specification can be skipped.) | Customer File Code | [ST] Character Entries Max. 12 digits (1 to 999999999999) [ST] [AT/TL] Max. 16 characters for the Customer’s Name When no name is to be programmed for the code NOTES: 1. The Customer File codes that are programmed in this submode will be accessed by entering the code and depressing the [PICK UP BAL] key for a sale entry in a charge posting operation in the REG or MGR mode. At this time, the balance of the new customer assigned with the code will show zero which will be printed as the previous balance line. On finalizing the sale, the new balance will be printed at the bottom of the receipt, which will be stored in the same Customer File Code memory area. Thus the operator always use the [PICK UP BAL] key for both starting a new customer’s account and at recalling the customer’s balance. 2. If all the programmed Customer File Codes are used up and a new customer file code is required to be opened during the business hours, the [CODE OPEN] key may be used. When a new code is entered, followed by [CODE OPEN], the code is printed as the previous balance line item with the balance zero on the receipt, and at the same time, the code is added to the list of the Customer File Codes programmed in the above operation of Submode 15. However, the use of the [CODE OPEN] key can be programmed to require Manager Intervention, which can control the operator’s opening of a new customer file code outside the list of the Customer File Codes programmed in Submode 15. 3. When the Standard Memory is used, a maximum of 1000 Customer File Codes can be programmed. When the Expansion Memory is used, a maximum of 3,000 Customer File Codes can be programmed. However, the actual maximum number of Customer Files varies depending on the RAM allocation. 6-26 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.10 Customer File Code (Check Track No.) and Name Setting (Submode 15) Deletion of Individual Customer File Codes Repeat for other codes to be deleted. 15 [X] [ITEM CORR] or [VOID] | Customer File Code | [ST] [AT/TL] [ALL VOID] [AT/TL] Deletion of All Customer File Codes 15 [X] NOTE: [ITEM CORR] or [VOID] If the balance of the deleted code is not zero, the Transfer memory of the code will automatically be adjusted to zero. At that time, the previous balance to be reset will be printed. Example) To program the following Customer File Codes with Customer Names: CODE NAME 1 : : : : : : : : : : : 105 JAMES HAILY HELEN REED Mode Lock: SET Enter 15 and depress the [X] 1 [ST] (Customer File Code) 410 [#] 401 [#] 413 [#] 405 [#] 503 [#] [#] 408 [#] 401 [#] 409 [#] 412 [#] 509 [#] [ST] (NAME: JAMES HAILY) : : : : : : : 105 [ST] (Customer File Code) 408 [#] 405 [#] 412 [#] 405 [#] 414 [#] [#] 502 [#] 405 [#] 405 [#] 404 [#] [ST] 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 3 -$0(6 +$,/< +(/(1 5((' 70 [AT/TL] Example) To delete the Customer File Code 104 that has once been programmed. 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 15 and depress the [X]. 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ [ITEM CORR] 104 [ST] (Customer File Code) [AT/TL] 021 3 70 6-27 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.11 Salesperson Code and Name Programming (Submode 20) 6.11 Salesperson Code and Name Programming (Submode 20) By programming Salesperson Codes here, those codes may be used in sales entries. In addition, the name of each salesperson can be programmed in maximum 12 characters. CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET Repeat for other Salespersons * 20 [X] | Salesperson Code | [ST] (For sequentially programming codes, the code number specification can be skipped.) Character Entries [ST] [AT/TL] Max. 2 digits (1 to 99) See NOTE 1 below NOTES: 1. A maximum of 12 regular-sized or 6 double-sized characters may be programmed for a name. A combination of both types is also available. 2. Even if no name is programmed (i.e. skipping the Character Entries before the second [ST] key) for a Salesperson Code, that code can be used in sale entries. Then, auto-preset ID symbol “SP xx” (xx = Salesperson Code) will be printed instead of a name in this case, for his/her ID in receipt print, etc. Example) To program the following salesperson code and name: Code Name 1 White 2 Stacy 3 Jansen Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 20 and depress the [X] key. 1 [ST] 507 [#] 608 [#] 609 [#] 704 [#] 605 [#] [ST] 2 [ST] 503 [#] 704 [#] 601 [#] 603 [#] 709 [#] [ST] 3 [ST] 410 [#] 601 [#] 614 [#] 703 [#] 605 [#] 614 [#] [ST] [AT/TL] (Salesperson Code 1) (W) (h) (i) (t) (e) 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ (Salesperson Code 2) (S) (t) (a) (c) (y) 021 :KLWH 6WDF\ -DQVHQ 3 70 (Salesperson Code 3) (J) (a) (n) (s) (e) (n) (to complete this submode) 6-28 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.12 Link-PLU Table Programming (Submode 25) Deletion CONDITION After Daily Salesperson Reset OPERATION Mode Lock: SET 20 [X] [ITEM CORR] or [VOID] | Salesperson Code | [ST] [AT/TL] Max. 2 digits (1 to 99) Repeat for other salesperson to be deleted. NOTE: When a Salesperson Code is deleted in the above operation, no entries using that code will be accepted until the code is again opened in the “Programming” operation already described. Example) To delete Salesperson Code 3 (name: Jansen) that was once programmed: Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 20 and depress the [X] key. 7(& 6725( [ITEM CORR] 3 [ST] [AT/TL] 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 3 -DQVHQ 70 6.12 Link-PLU Table Programming (Submode 25) This submode programs Link-PLU Tables and their respective Sub-link PLUs. When a PLU is programmed with a Link-PLU Table No. (Address 10 of the PLU TABLE PROGRAMMING operation), an entry of the PLU will automatically enter the Sub-link PLU that is programmed in the Link-PLU Table No. Refer to the “Link-PLU Table No.” description in the PLU TABLE PROGRAMMING, Submode 4, as to details of PLU-to-PLU Iinkage. CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET Barcode Scanning 25 [X] | Link-PLU Table No. | [ST] | Sub-link PLU Code | [PLU] 1 to 99 (Enter the Table No. programmed in the Head-link PLU item in Submode 4) 6 or 13 digits (Enter the code of the PLU to be autoentered when the Head-link PLU is entered in a sale.) * Repeat for other tables. 6-29 (For sequentially programming tables, the Table No. specification can be skipped.) [AT/TL] 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.13 Tare Table and General Unit Weight Setting (Submode 26) Example) Toset the following Link-PLU Table and its Sub-link PLU: Link-PLU Table No. Sub-link PLU Code 1 101301 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 25 and depress the [X] key. 1 [ST] 101301 [PLU] [AT/TL] NOTE: 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ (Link-PLU Table No.) (Sub-link PLU Code) to complete this submode 021 In this example, Link-PLU Table No. has already been set in PLU 90601 (Drink Small-A) and PLU 90701 (Drink Small-B) as Head-link items in the PLU PROGRAMMING operation, Submode 4. The Sub-link PLU 101301 here has been programmed as a bottle-deposit PLU (Small-Btl Depo) in the same submode. 3 70 Deletion of Link-PLU Tables CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET 25 [X] [ITEM CORR] or [VOID] | Link-PLU Table No. | [ST] [AT/TL] 1 to 99 Repeatable for other tables to be deleted. 6.13 Tare Table and General Unit Weight Setting (Submode 26) In the PLU TABLE PROGRAMMING operation (Submode 4), some of Scale-compulsory PLUs may be set with a Tare Table No. The actual tare weight is set to each Tare Table here. Also, the General Unit Weight is set here so that the Unit Weight may be effective to scale items entered through departments or PLUs without any Individual Unit Weight designation. CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET • Tare Table Setting Repeat for other tables * 26 [X] | Tare Table No. | [ST] (For sequentially programming tables, the Table No. specification can be skipped.) | Tare Weight | [#] 1 digit (1 to 9) 0 to 999 (Unit: 1/00 LB or gram.) (Example: enter 13 for 0.13 LB or 13 grams.) • General Unit Weight Setting 26 [X] | General Unit Weight Code | 1 to 11 (NOTE 1 below) 6-30 [AT/TL] [AT/TL] 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.13 Tare Table and General Unit Weight Setting (Submode 26) • Tare Table and General Unit Weight Setting Repeat for other tables * * 26 [X] | Tare Table No. | [ST] 1 digit (1 to 9) NOTES: 1. 2. Example) | Tare Weight | [#] 0 to 999 (Unit: 1/00 LB or gram.) (Example: enter 13 for 0.13 LB or 13 grams.) General Unit Weight Code as follows. General Unit LB Unit Weight Code 1 1LB 2 2LB 3 3LB 4 4LB 5 5LB 6 6LB 7 7LB 8 8LB 9 9LB 10 1/2LB 11 1/4LB (For sequentially programming tables, the Table No. specification can be skipped.) [AT/TL] | General Unit Weight Code | 1 to 11 (NOTE 1 below) Kg Unit 1Kg 2Kg 3Kg 4Kg 5Kg 6Kg 7Kg 8Kg 9Kg 100g The initial value for the General Unit Weight is set to Code 1 (1LB or 1Kg). To set the following: Tare Table No. 1 with Tare Weight 13 grams, General Weight 100 grams (Code 10). Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 26 and depress the [X] key. 1 [ST] 13 [#] 10 [AT/TL] (Tare Table No.) (Tare Weight) (General Weight Code) to complete this submode 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 3 OE óOE 70 6-31 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.14 PLU Preset-Code Key Setting (Submode 27) 6.14 PLU Preset-Code Key Setting (Submode 27) When there are any keys programmed as PLU Preset-code Keys on the ECR Keyboard (Ordinary or Flat Type), and/or when the PLU Keyboard PK-2 (hardware option) is connected to the ECR, a PLU code may be preset to each of those keys in this operation. CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET Repeat for other keys. Barcode Scanning 27 [X] [KEY] | PLU Code | Enter through Numeric Keys on the ECR Keyboard (Enter 0 to close the key); Max. 6 or 13 digits NOTES: 1. 2. 3. Example) [AT/TL] Depress the required key on the ECR keyboard or on the PK-2 keyboard. If the PLU Code entry is skipped and a [KEY] is simply depressed in the above sequence, the preprogrammed PLU Code of the KEY will be displayed. A non-opened PLU Code (i.e. PLU non-existent in the PLU table file) can be set on a KEY; however, pressing the KEY in sale entries will result in an error unless the code is opened in the PLU TABLE PROGRAMMING operation, Submode 4. If “0” is entered as PLU Code in the above sequence, the KEY will be closed. Pressing the closed KEY in sale entry will cause an error. To set following PLU Codes to KEYs on the ECR keyboard: Mode Lock to SET 27 [X] PLU Code 50321 50322 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 50321 [required key] 50322 [required key] [AT/TL] 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 Location Code (left side); refer to REMARKS 1 and 2 on the next page. PLU code assigned to the key (right side) 6-32 3 70 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.14 PLU Preset-Code Key Setting (Submode 27) PK-2 KEYBOARD 1 11 21 31 41 51 61 71 81 91 101 111 121 2 12 22 32 42 52 62 72 82 92 102 112 122 3 13 23 33 43 53 63 73 83 93 103 113 123 4 14 24 34 44 54 64 74 84 94 104 114 124 5 15 25 35 45 55 65 75 85 95 105 115 125 6 16 26 36 46 56 66 76 86 96 106 116 126 7 17 27 37 47 57 67 77 87 97 107 117 127 8 18 28 38 48 58 68 78 88 98 108 118 128 9 19 29 39 49 59 69 79 89 99 109 119 129 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 REMARKS: 1. The Nos 1 through 130 marked on the PK-2 Keyboard are the KEY Nos to be printed on the left side of the program receipt issued in the operation on the preceding page. If each KEY is not set with a PLU Code, the auto-preset PLU Code identical to the initial KEY No. in the above figure will be active as its preset PLU Code ex.) 2. KEY No.1 ................... PLU Code 1 KEY No.130 ............... PLU Code 130 When a PLU code is assigned to a PLU Preset-code Key on the ECR Keyboard in the operation on the preceding page, the Hardware Key Code which indicates the absolute location of the key will be printed to the left of the assigned PLU Code. The Hardware Key Codes of the ECR keyboards of Ordinary Type and Flat Type are shown on the next page. 6-33 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.14 PLU Preset-Code Key Setting (Submode 27) ECR Ordinary Type Keyboard 1 7 13 19 25 31 37 43 49 55 61 67 73 79 85 2 8 14 20 26 32 38 44 50 56 62 68 74 80 86 3 9 15 21 27 33 39 45 51 57 63 69 75 81 87 4 10 16 22 28 34 40 46 52 58 64 70 76 82 88 5 11 17 23 29 35 41 47 53 59 65 71 77 83 89 6 12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 72 78 84 90 ECR Flat Type Keyboard 1 9 17 25 33 41 49 57 65 73 81 89 97 105 113 2 10 18 26 34 42 50 58 66 74 82 90 98 106 114 3 11 19 27 35 43 51 59 67 75 83 91 99 107 115 4 12 20 28 36 44 52 60 68 76 84 92 100 108 116 5 13 21 29 37 45 53 61 69 77 85 93 101 109 117 6 14 22 30 38 46 54 62 70 78 86 94 102 110 118 7 15 23 31 39 47 55 63 71 79 87 95 103 111 119 8 16 24 32 40 48 56 64 72 80 88 96 104 112 120 6-34 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.15 Display Message Programming (Submode 31) 6.15 Display Message Programming (Submode 31) The “DISPLAY MESSAGE” here means the message to be displayed in the 16-digit dot windows of the Operator Display panel while the Mode Lock of the terminal is in the “LOCK” position. This display message may be used as information, commercial message, welcoming greeting, etc. CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET Repeat for other lines. * 31 [X] Allowed for sequential Line No. only | Message Line No. | [ST] Character Entries [ST] (1 to 4; max. 4 lines) [AT/TL] (Max. 16 characters per line. Regular-size only.) NOTES: 1. When the option “Store Message SCROLLING DISPLAY” is selected, four lines (Line Nos. 1 to 4) are available. Even when the option “Store Message 16 CHARACTERS HELD” is selected, four lines (Line Nos. 1 to 4) are available. In this case, refer to the “Store Message Display” operation to display the respective message lines. 2. When the “SCROLLING DISPLAY” option is selected, a maximum of 64 characters can be entered consecutively after designating Line No.1 at first and depressing [ST] for each line end. 3. The character must be regular-sized only. 4. The DISPLAY MESSAGE set here will also appear in the “REG” or “MGR” mode if so designated by system option. Example) To program the following display message under the “SCROLLING DISPLAY” option: T H I S C L O S E G O T O H A N K C O D . Y U N T E R P L E E A N O T H O U . . . 6-35 I S Line No. 1 A S E Line No. 2 R , T Line No. 3 Line No. 4 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.15 Display Message Programming (Submode 31) Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 31 and depress the [X] key. 1 [ST] 504 [#] 408 [#] 409 [#] 503 [#] [#] 403 [#] 415 [#] 505 [#] 414 [#] 504 [#] 405 [#] 502 [#] [#] 409 [#] 503 [#] [#] [ST] (Line No. 1) (T) (H) (I) (S) (Space) (C) (O) (U) (N) (T) (E) (R) (Space) (I) (S) (Space) (to complete Line 1) (3 [ST]) 407 [#] 415 [#] [#] 504 [#] 415 [#] [#] 401 [#] 414 [#] 415 [#] 504 [#] 408 [#] 405 [#] 502 [#] 212 [#] [#] 504 [#] [ST] (Line No. 3) (G) (O) (Space) (T) (O) (Space) (A) (N) (O) (T) (H) (E) (R) (,) (Space) (T) (to complete Line 3) (2 [ST]) 403 [#] 412 [#] 415 [#] 503 [#] 405 [#] 404 [#] 214 [#] [#] [#] 500 [#] 412 [#] 405 [#] 401 [#] 503 [#] 405 [#] [#] [ST] (Line No. 2) (C) (L) (O) (S) (E) (D) (.) (Space) (Space) (P) (L) (E) (A) (S) (E) (Space) (to complete Line 2) (4 [ST]) 408 [#] 401 [#] 414 [#] 411 [#] [#] 509 [#] 415 [#] 505 [#] 214 [#] 214 [#] 214 [#] [ST] (Line No. 4) (H) (A) (N) (K) (Space) (Y) (O) (U) (.) (.) (.) (to complete Line 4) [AT/TL] to complete this submode 6-36 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 3 7+,6 &2817(5 ,6 &/26(' 3/($6( *2 72 $127+(5 7 +$1. <28 70 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.16 Negative Amount Key Limit Amount Setting (Submode 35) 6.16 Negative Amount Key Limit Amount Setting (Submode 35) This submode sets the limit amount to be entered through each of the negative-amount keys [VND CPN], [STR CPN], [BTL RTN], and [DOLL DISC]. CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET Repeat for other Media Codes. * 35 [X] (Repeatable from here for sequentially programming Media Codes.) | Key Code | [ST] | Limit Amount | [#] [AT/TL] Max. 6 digits (1 to 999999; result: $0.01 to $9,999.99) Enter 0 to reset the limit 1 to 4 (See the table below) MEDIA CODE AND KEY TABLE NOTES: Key Code Key 1 2 3 4 [VND CPN] [STR CPN] [BTL RTN] [DOLL DISC] 1. The [VND CPN] key will not be restricted by the limit amount set here but the amount up to 7 digits will be entered in “MGR” or “ - “ mode. 2. The limit set here cannot be released by the [LC OPEN] (or [OPEN]) key in transaction entries. Example) To set the following preset amount on the keys below: Error Code 1 2 KEY [VND CPN] [STR CPN] Limit Amount $10.00 $20.00 Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 35 and depress the [X] key. 1 [ST] 1000 [#] 2 [ST] 2000 [#] [AT/TL] (Key Code) (Limit Amount) (Key Code) (Limit Amount) to complete this submode 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 9&31 6&31 3 70 6-37 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.17 PLU Price Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Amount Setting (Submode 40) 6.17 PLU Price Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Amount Setting (Submode 40) This submode sets the dollar discount amount or the extra charge amount for PLU price. CONDITION Anytime outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET Repeat for another code. * 40 [X] Dollar Discount/ Extra Charge Code (Repeatable from here for sequentially programming Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Codes.) [ST] ([RTN MDSE]) | Amount | [#] [AT/TL] Max. 6 digits (1 to 999999; result: $0.01 to $9999.99) Max. 2 digits (1 to 99) Depress the [RTN MDSE] key to set the Dollar Discount amount. Example) To set as follows: • Code 2 for Dollar Discount $1.50 • Code 10 for Extra Charge $2.00 Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET, Enter 40 and depress the [X] key. 2 [ST] [RTN MDSE] 150 [#] 10 [ST] 200 [#] [AT/TL] (Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Code) (Dollar Discount declaration) (Dollar Discount Amount) (Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Code) (Extra Charge Amount) to complete this submode 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 3 70 6-38 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.18 Department Preset Price Setting or Changing 6.18 Department Preset Price Setting or Changing The preset price of each department may be set in the DEPARTMENT TABLE PROGRAMMING (Submode 3) already described. However, in setting or changing the price only but not other programmed data, the following operation will be more convenient. CONDITION Anytime outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET (1) Using the [DEPT] key: Repeatable for other departments. | New Preset Price | [DEPT] [AT/TL] Max. 6 digits; 0 to 999999 (result: $0.00 to $9999.99) NOTE (2) Using the [DP#] key: Repeatable for other departments. * | Department Code | [DP#] Max. 2 digits; 1 to 99 Repeatable from here when the Dept Code is sequential. | New Preset Price | [#] [AT/TL] Max. 6 digits; 0 to 999999 (result: $0.00 to $9999.99) NOTE To change a preset-price department into an open department, skip the “New Preset Price” entry and simply depress the [DEPT] key (in the first operation pattern) or simply depress the [#] key (in the second operation pattern). Presetting a zero-price is also possible. NOTE: Example) With the option “Preset Point for one decimal digit allowed”, 0 to 99999.9 (result: $0.000 to $999.999), using the [.] key. To set the following preset prices of departments: Dept.13……….$1.40 Dept.14……….$2.10 Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET By the first operation pattern: 140 [DEPT 13] 210 [DEPT 14] [AT/TL] 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( By the second operation pattern: 13 [DP#] 140 [#] 14 [DP#] 210 [#] [AT/TL] 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 '3 '3 3 # # 70 6-39 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.19 PLU Preset Price Setting or Changing, Whole Package Quantity Changing 6.19 PLU Preset Price Setting or Changing, Whole Package Quantity Changing The preset price of each PLU may be set in the PLU TABLE PROGRAMMING (Submode 4) already described. However, in setting or changing the price and/or the whole package quantity only but not other programmed data, the following operation will be more convenient. CONDITION Anytime outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET Barcode Scanning | PLU Code | [PLU] | New Whole Package Quantity | [ST] 6 or 13 digits | New Preset Price | [#] Max. 2digits; 0 to 99 * [AT/TL] Max. 6 digits; 0 to 999999 (result: $0.00 to $9,999.99) NOTE Repeatable from here if the PLU code is sequential. Repeatable for other PLUs NOTES: 1. With the option “Preset Point for one decimal digit allowed”, 0 to 999999 (result: $0.00 to $9,999.99), using the [.] key. 2. If the operation |New Whole Package Quantity| [ST] is skipped, only a unit price setting is performed. 3. Only for the Split Price PLU, Whole Package Quantity Changing is available. 4. Preset price of Open type PLU can also be changed. To change a preset-price PLU into an open-price PLU, skip the “New Preset Price” entry and simply depress the [#] key. Presetting a zero-price is also possible. Example) To set the following preset prices of PLU: New Whole Package Q’ty PLU20105 (Apple) 6 New Preset Price $1.25 Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET 20105 [PLU] 6 [ST] 125 [#] [AT/TL] (PLU Code) (New Whole Package Q’ty) (New Preset Price) to complete this submode 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 $SSOH 3 # 70 6-40 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.20 %+ and %- Preset Rate Setting 6.20 %+ and %- Preset Rate Setting A preset rate may be set on each of the [%+] and [%-] keys, one independent rate for each key. Once a rate is preset, the % key will simply be depressed without a prior rate entry to activate the preset rate. If a rate is entered prior to the depression of the key, the entered rate (manual rate) will be activated instead. CONDITION Anytime outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET | Preset Rate | [%+] (For Percent Charge Preset Rate) (0.001 to 99.999(%); use the [.] key if a decimal portion is contained.) | Preset Rate | [%-] (For Percent Discount Preset Rate) (0.001 to 99.999(%); use the [.] key if a decimal portion is contained.) • To reset the rate once set: Enter 0, depress the required % key. (Then the % key will always required a manual rate entry in sale entries.) NOTE: When two [%+] keys or two [%-] keys are installed on the keyboard, two different % rates (one for each) may be preset, in the same manner as described above. The two rates may be the same or different from the other. Or only one key may be preset with a rate and other may remain non-preset. Example) To program the following rate to each key. [%+] key……….Rate: 5.00% [%-] key………..Rate: 10.00% Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET Enter 5, depress [%+] Enter 10, depress [%-] 7(& 6725( 7(& 6725( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 021 3 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 021 70 6-41 3 70 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.21 Preset Rate Setting for Selective Itemizers (SI1 and SI2) 6.21 Preset Rate Setting for Selective Itemizers (SI1 and SI2) If any of [ST1/TL] (or [SI/TL]) and [SI2/TL] keys are installed on the keyboard, a preset rate may be programmed on each key. As for the functions and applications of the Selective Itemizers, refer to the description on the next page. CONDITION Anytime outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET | Preset Rate | [SI/TL] (or [SI1/TL]) (0.001 to 99.999(%); use the [.] key if a decimal portion is contained.) | Preset Rate | [SI2/TL] (0.001 to 99.999(%); use the [.] key if a decimal portion is contained.) NOTES: 1. Whether the calculated amount by the preset SI % rate affects (i.e. add to or subtract from) the sale total is determined by a system option status selection. 2. To reset the rate once set, enter 0 as the rate. (Then the rate is regarded as 100% if the option “Non-affect” is selected. With the option “SI Affects Sale Total”, some rate other than “0” should be programmed.) 3. Fraction process corresponds to that of the [%+] or [%-] key. Example) To set 7% as SI1 preset % rate: 7(& 6725( Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 7 [SI1/TL] 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 6, 7/ 3 70 Selective Itemizer Functions and Applications The “Selective Itemizer” is a temporary total memory for each sale and is activated separately from the Main Itemizer (i.e. sale total memory). If certain Department or PLU items are programmed with the SI (selective itemizer) “net” status, the Selective Itemizer will function to add up amounts of the SI-net status items in registering the items, while the Main Itemizer will function to add up all the items in the sale. Thus, near the sale finalization, the cashier may read the SI content by depressing the [SI/TL] key. A preset % rate may be programmed for each of SI1 and SI2 (on the preceding page), and whether the calculated amount will add to, subtract from, or non-affect the sale total is a selective option. Whether the amount resulted by depressing the [Sl/TL] key will print or non-print is another selective option. 6-42 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.21 Preset Rate Setting for Selective Itemizers (SI1 and SI2) The applications of this function may vary from store to store. Some stores may use it for counting the service stamps to be issued to the customers according to the sale amount of service-stampable items. In this case, the option “SI Total Non-affects Sale Total” should be selected, and a preset % rate, 1% for example, may be set to issue one service stamp for every $1.00. Thus the number of stamps to be issued to the customer is displayed (and printed if so programmed) as a result of calculation with the preset % rate, but the resulted value (the number of stamps in this case) will not affect the sale total. Example 1) With option “SI Total Non-affects Sale Total”: Key Operation in REG Mode 100 [DEPT 1] (SI-net) 150 [DEPT 2] (non-SI) 200 [DEPT 3] (SI-net) [SI/TL] (1% is preset) [AT/TL] Receipt/Journal Print 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 '3 '3 '3 6, 7/ &$6+ 6 6 “S” : SI-net Symbol Number of stamps to be issued 70 Dept.1 and Dept. 3 are programmed with SI-net-status. On depressing [SI/TL], “0.03” (which is 1 % of total amount of Dept. 1 “$1.00” + Dept. 3 “$2.00”) is displayed and printed, and 3 stamps are to be issued to the customer in this case. The sale total “$4.50” is not affected by the SI calculation. Other stores may use it for calculating the discount amount for certain sales items during a special discount sales period by presetting the discount % rate on the SI and programming SI-net status to certain Departments and PLUs which are subject to the special discount. Example 2) With option “SI Special Discount”: Key Operation in REG Mode 100 [DEPT 1] (SI-net) 150 [DEPT 2] (non-SI) 200 [DEPT 3] (SI-net) [SI/TL] (10% is preset) [AT/TL] Receipt/Journal Print 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 '3 '3 '3 6, 7/ &$6+ 6 6 70 Discount Amount resulted by SI % On depressing [SI/TL], “-0.30” (which is 10% discount from the total amount of Dept.1 + Dept. 3 items) is displayed and printed, and that amount is subtracted from the sale total. ($4.50 - $0.30 = $4.20) 6-43 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.22 Foreign Currency Exchange Rate Setting 6.22 Foreign Currency Exchange Rate Setting In this program, the rate of each foreign currencies (corresponding to the [CUR1] to [CUR5] keys) will be set. By setting a rate on each Foreign Currency Key, reading the sale total and tendering in the foreign currency value will be possible for sale finalization. CONDITION Anytime outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET | Exchange Rate for Foreign Currency 1 | [CUR 1] 0.000001 to 9999.999999 (Use the [.] key if decimal portion is contained in the rate.) | Exchange Rate for Foreign Currency 5 | [CUR 5] As for how to calculate the Exchange Rate, see the description below. Foreign Currency Exchange Rate Calculation 1. The rate must be calculated in the subsidiary currency unit values for both the domestic and the foreign currencies. (In case of calculating the rate from the domestic to a foreign currency with the same zerosuppress form, such as from U.S. $ to Euro, it will be no problem even if it is calculated in the main currency of $ and Euro. However, in case of exchanging from a domestic currency such as $ or Euro to Japanese yen, or vice versa, this rule must be obeyed; otherwise a wrong rate will result.) 2. Calculate the required foreign currency value equivalent to the domestic currency value “1”. Then the obtained value is the Exchange Rate value to be entered in the setting operation stated above. 3. The result of calculation is rounded up. Example) To set two foreign currency rates: (The rates here are merely examples, and may be different from the actual rates currently in effect.) Conditions given for Domestic Currency and Foreign Currencies (DOMESTIC) U.S. Dollar (CUR 1) EURO (CUR 2) Japanese Yen $1.00 ¼ ¥117.10 1 cent 1.0914 EURO Cent 1.1719 yen 6-44 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.23 TAX Table Setting Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET 7(& 6725( 1 [.] 0914 [CUR 1] (for EURO) 1 [.] 1710 [CUR 2] (for Japanese yen) 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP 7(& 6725( &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 021 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ &85 3 021 &85 3 ∗ 70 ∗ 70 Resetting a Foreign Currency Rate Once Set: Enter “0” in place of the Exchange Rate for the Foreign Currency in the setting operation. Then the rate for that foreign currency will be reset. The Foreign Currency Key of the rate thus reset cannot be used in sales entries. 6.23 TAX Table Setting A maximum of four tax tables can be programmed (Tax 1, Tax 2, Tax 3, Tax 4) in accordance with installation of [TX1/M], [TX2/M], [TX3/M], [TX4/M] keys. CONDITION After Financial Daily Reset OPERATION Mode Lock: SET TYPE 1: TAX 1 FULL BREAKS (COMBINATION OF NON-CYCLIC AND CYCLIC BREAKS) | Max. amount non-taxable | [TX1/M] | Max. amount for 1 ¢ tax levied | [TX1/M] | Max. amount for 2 ¢ tax levied | [TX1/M] Repeat up to the “A” Break | Max. amount for N¢ tax levied | [TX1/M] .. ... “A” Break (Non-cyclic Break Limit) [ST] (to indicate the completion of Non-cyclic Breaks) | Max. amount for N + 1¢ tax levied | [TX1/M] (beginning of Cyclic Breaks) | Max. amount for N + 2¢ tax levied | [TX1/M] Repeat up to the “B” Break (“B” Break - “A” Break + Multiple of $1.00; max. $9.00) [AT/TL] (to complete this tax table programming) NOTE: The break amount entry must be a maximum of 4 digits (1 to 9999 resulting in $0.01 to $99.99) 6-45 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.23 TAX Table Setting TYPE 2: TAX 1 COMBINATION OF NON-CYCLIC BREAKS AND % RATE First set all the breaks up to the “A” Break entry and the [ST] key depression as shown in TYPE 1. | TAX RATE applied when exceeding the “A” Break amount | (0.0001% to 99.9999%; use the [.] key if a decimal portion is contained. Examples: To set 5%, enter 5. To set 5.26%, enter 5.26. The fraction of the amount resulting from this % rate calculation will be rounded off.) [AT/TL] (to complete this tax programming) TYPE 3: TAX 1 % RATE ONLY 0 [TX1/M] [ST] | TAX RATE | [AT/TL] (The description for the TAX RATE in TYPE 2 is also applied to this case.) NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. For Tax 2, Tax 3, Tax 4 table programming, follow the same procedure in TYPE 1, 2, or 3 on the preceding page, using [TX2/M] or [TX3/M] or [TX4/M] instead of [TX1/M]. If multiple tax tables are programmed, the Tax 1 table must be set first, then Tax 2, Tax 3, and Tax 4. The Tax 1 table setting will automatically reset all of the old Tax 1, 2, 3. and 4 tables if they have been programmed. No second depression of the [ST] key is allowed within one tax table programming. A maximum of 99 breaks can be entered for Tax 1 to Tax 4 tables altogether. For inclusive tax (Tax 3 or Tax 4), tax table programming using a rate only is available. Tax table programming using a tax break is unavailable. Example 1) TAX 1 FULL BREAKS Tax Table Tax Levied Amount Range $0.00 to $0.10 0¢ $0.11 to $0.22 1¢ $0.23 to $0.39 2¢ $0.40 to $0.56 3¢ $0.57 to $0.73 4¢ $0.74 to $0.90 5¢ $0.91 to $1.08 6¢ ---- “A” Break $1.09 to $1.24 7¢ $1.25 to $1.41 8¢ $1.42 to $1.58 9¢ $1.59 to $1.74 10¢ $1.75 to $1.92 11¢ $1.93 to $2.08 12¢ ---- “B” Break Key Operation Mode Lock: SET 10 22 39 56 73 90 108 124 141 158 174 192 208 [TX1/M] [TX1/M] [TX1/M] [TX1/M] [TX1/M] [TX1/M] [TX1/M] [ST] [TX1/M] [TX1/M] [TX1/M] [TX1/M] [TX1/M] [TX1/M] [AT/TL] 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 7$; ∗ ∗∗ 3 70 6-46 6. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6.24 Store/Register No. Setting Example 2) TAX 2 COMBINATION OF NON-CYCLIC BREAKS AND % RATE Tax Table Tax Levied Amount Range $0.00 to $0.09 0¢ $0.10 to $0.29 1¢ $0.30 to $0.59 2¢ $0.60 to $0.84 3¢ $0.85 to $1.12 4¢ ---- “A” Break 5% is applied to any amount exceeding the “A” Break. Key Operation Mode Lock: SET 9 29 59 84 112 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( [TX2/M] [TX2/M] [TX2/M] [TX2/M] [TX2/M] [ST] 5 [AT/TL] 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 7$; 3 ∗ 70 Example 3) TAX 10% RATE ONLY Tax Table 10% is applied to any sale amount 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( Key Operation Mode Lock: SET [TX3/M] 0 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ [ST] 021 10 [AT/TL] 7$; ∗ 3 70 6.24 Store/Register No. Setting A maximum of 6 digits may be set as ID No. for the store and/or register. And once set, it will be printed on every receipt and every transaction on journal. CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET | Store/Register No. | [#] Max. 6 digits; 0 to 999999 NOTE: 7(& 6725( The preceding zeros, if entered, will not be printed. For example, if “001234” is entered in the above operation, “#1234” will always be printed as the Register No. Example) To set the Register No. of this terminal: 3001 Key Operation: Mode Lock: SET 3001 [#] 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 3 70 6-47 7. VERIFICATION OF PROGRAMMED DATA EO1-11152 7. VERIFICATION OF PROGRAMMED DATA 7. VERIFICATION OF PROGRAMMED DATA The programmed data entered in the preceding chapter can be read for verification purposes. The print format of each program reading is almost the same as on the program receipt, except that “PX” and a 3-digit number are printed instead of printing “P” and a 2-digit number. CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: X or SET 1. To read out the data of programming operations with a Submode No., first enter “1,” then each Submode No., and finally depress the [AT/TL] key. For example, to read the programmed data entered in Submode 1 (STORE NAME/MESSAGE, COMMERCIAL MESSAGE, PROGRAMMING), operate: 101 [AT/TL] Submode No. (In case of a 1-digit number, add a “0” on top to be a 2-digit number. Always attach “1” to the Program Submode No. for reading data. NOTE: Data of Submodes 5, 6 cannot be read. 2. To read out the data of programming operations without a Submode No., the following operation will read all the data together: 100 [AT/TL] To read the data of the following operations: • %+ and %- PRESET RATE • SELECTIVE ITEMIZER RATE • FOREIGN CURRENCY EXCHANGE RATE • TAX TABLE (For tax calculation test, refer to the next page.) 3. Zone destination is possible in reading the PLU TABLE: 104 NOTE: [ST] Zone-start [@/FOR] Zone-end PLU Code PLU Code [AT/TL] On depressing the [AT/TL] key, the programmed data will be printed. To abort printing once started, depress the [ITEM CORR] or [VOID] key. The reading operation is immediately stopped halfway. 7- 1 7. VERIFICATION OF PROGRAMMED DATA EO1-11152 7.1 Tax Calculation Test 7.1 Tax Calculation Test CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: X or SET Enter any amount. Displays the entered amount. Depress [TXBL TL] Displays the tax amount (Tax 1 + Tax 2 + Tax 3 + Tax 4) is displayed, issuing a receipt such as below. 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 021 3; 7$; 7$; 7$; 7$; Entered Amount Tax 1 amount calculated Tax 2 amount calculated Tax 3 amount calculated Tax 4 amount calculated NOTE: The print or non-print status of each calculated tax amount can be programmed. 7- 2 8. BAR CODE SYSTEM FOR EACH MODEL EO1-11152 8. BAR CODE SYSTEM FOR EACH MODEL 8. BAR CODE SYSTEM FOR EACH MODEL Symbols of Bar Code Components (applicable to any of the following tables) F ................. Flag Code M ................ Merchandise Maker Code I .................. Merchandise Item Code X................. Other type of Item Code or Price Value P................. Price Value C/D ............. Check Digit (on the entire code) C/DP........... Check Digit on Price Bar Code Type Table Read Code Type Symbol Marking Method 1 UPC Source 2 UPC Source 3 EAN JAN Source 4 EAN JAN Source 5 UPC Source 6 EAN JAN UPC Source 7 8 JAN UPC Version UPC-A Standard UPC-E Shortened EAN-13 JAN-13 Standard EAN-8 JAN-8 Shortened In-store Coupon Standard Coupon Standard Non-PLU In-store Non-PLU PLU 9, 10 11 UPC In-store LAC Bar Code Components F1 F2 M1 M2 M3 M4 M5 I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 C/D (F1 = 0 fixed, F2 = 0, 1, 3, 6 ~ 9) F2 X1 X2 X3 X4 X5 X6 C/D (F2 = 0 fixed, X1 = 0 ~ 9, X1 = 0: Not applicable to the Read Code Type 11) The method of converting the shortened type into the standard type is determined by a program option. F1 F2 M1 M2 M3 M4 M5 I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 C/D (F1 F2 = 30 ~ 97) F1 F2 M1 M2 M3 M4 I5 C/D (F1 F2 = 30 ~ 97) F1 F2 X1 X2 X3 X4 X5 X6 X7 X8 X9 X10 C/D (F1 = 0 fixed, F2 = 5, X9 X10 = Coupon Code.) F1 F2 X1 X2 X3 X4 X5 X6 X7 X8 X9 X10 C/D (F1 F2 = 98, 99) (X8 X9 X10 is the coupon amount.) Price 4 dig. C/DP. Item Code 5 dig.: F1 2 X1 X2 X3 X4 X5 C/DP P1 P2 P3 P4 C/D Price 5 dig. Item Code 5 dig.: F1 2 X1 X2 X3 X4 X5 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 C/D Price 4 dig. Item Code 6 dig.: F1 2 X1 X2 X3 X4 X5 X6 P1 P2 P3 P4 C/D (F1 F2 = 02 fixed) The processing type (selection of Bar Code Components) is programmable. Non-PLU Price 4 dig. C/DP. Item Code 5 dig.: F1 F2 X1 X2 X3 X4 X5 C/DP P1 P2 P3 P4 C/D Non-PLU Price 5 dig. Item Code 5 dig. F1 F2 X1 X2 X3 X4 X5 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 C/D Non-PLU Price 4 dig. Item Code 6 dig. F1 F2 X1 X2 X3 X4 X5 X6 P1 P2 P3 P4 C/D F1 F2 X1 X2 X3 X4 X5 X6 X7 X8 X9 X10 C/D (F1 F2 = 04, 10 ~ 29) The processing type (selection of Bar Code Components) is programmable. -- reserved -F2 X1 X2 X3 X4 X5 X6 C/D (F2 X1 = 00 fixed; X2 X3 X4 X5 = 1000 ~ 7999; X6 = 5 ~ 9) 8- 1 3. M/S LEVEL OPERATOR’S GUIDE EO1-11152 MA-1595-1 SERIES TABLE OF CONTENTS Page 1. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1- 1 2. SYSTEM CONFIGURATION ------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1- 1 3. HARDWARE DESCRIPTION ------------------------------------------------------------------------ 3- 1 3.1 Operator Display Indications of Master-Satellite System---------------------------------------- 3- 1 4. ADDITIONAL FUNCTION KEY AND REGISTERING PROCEDURE -------------------- 4- 1 1. INTRODUCTION EO1-11152 1. INTRODUCTION 1. INTRODUCTION Making the most of the functions of the previously described MA-1595 standalone, the MA-1595 can be developed into a master-satellite system. For Master-Satellite, a Batch-consolidation or Scanning system of a maximum of 16 terminals can be built. By connecting a PC, the system can also be expanded into a transaction data capture system. Operational functions on each terminal ECR basically stay the same as on a standalone ECR, except those deleted, changed, or added for this M/S system use which are described later. 2. SYSTEM CONFIGURATION PC TCP/IP Master Terminal Backup Master Terminal Remote Slip Printer Remote Slip Printer Scanner Scanner Scale Scale EFT EFT RS-232C Satellite Terminal RS-232C UDP Satellite Terminal Remote Slip Printer Scanner Satellite Terminal Remote Slip Printer Remote Slip Printer Scanner Scanner Scale Scale Scale EFT EFT EFT RS-232C RS-232C RS-232C Batch-consolidation System: Max. 16 terminals Master Terminal ... 1 unit Backup Master Terminal ... 1 unit Satellite Terminal ... Max. 14 units or Master Terminal ... 1 unit Satellite Terminal ... Max. 14 units Scanning System: Remote Slip Printer: Scanner: Scale: System including Backup Master Terminal System not including Backup Master Terminal Max. 4 terminals TM-U295 (EPSON) PSC-6000/2500 SL-47 1- 1 3. HARDWARE DESCRIPTION EO1-11152 3.1 Operator Display Indications of Master-Satellite System 3. HARDWARE DESCRIPTION 3.1 Operator Display Indications of Master-Satellite System Display Indications during In-line Services The followings are displayed in the 16-digit dot windows, 10-digit 7-segment window, and IN-LINE Lamp of the Operator Display panel during in-line services. < Master Terminal > Blink DPT In-line Job No. Mode Indication X Number of ECRs unserviced (( )) ECR No. now serviced at the time of collecting read/reset data TL ST Illuminated • IN-LINE Lamp 1) Illuminated during RTR declaration “ON” 2) Extinguished during RTR declaration “OFF” 3) Blinking during ULL operations • Mode Indication 5 4 3 2 1 RTR/SET Mode: P RTR/X Mode: X RTR/Z Mode: Z < Satellite Terminals or Backup Master Terminal > • IN-LINE Lamp 1) Illuminated during “Hold” condition 2) Extinguished after completing in-line services 3) Blinking during in-line services Error Messages The following table shows the Error Codes and Messages to be displayed on in-line terminals, in addition to those displayed on Standalone ECRs. IN-LINE ERROR CODE AND MESSAGE TABLE (to be added to the table for the Standalone Level) Error Message (Standard Setting) FILE BUSY IRC CONNECT ERR MASTER IS BUSY PLEASE BACK UP TRANS BUFF FULL Cause of Error A designated file is already occupied by other terminal. Transmission cannot be executed due to the connection error (Disconnection of the line, or Master Terminal’s power is OFF, etc.) An inquiry file is being used. RTR Declaration cannot be canceled due to the Backup Error Satellite Transaction Buffer is full. 3- 1 4. ADDITIONAL FUNCTION KEY AND REGISTERING PROCEDURE EO1-11152 4. ADDITIONAL FUNCTION KEY AND REGISTERING PROCEDURE 4. ADDITIONAL FUNCTION KEY AND REGISTERING PROCEDURE The following is the key that can be installed on the Master Terminal of an in-line system, in addition to the standalone specifications, and the registering procedure using the key. RTR RTR (Register-to-Register) DECLARATION Key ([RTR]) By depressing the [RTR] key on the Master Terminal, various in-line jobs (DLLs, Consolidated Read/Reset Report takings, etc.) can be performed. PROCEDURE ON A MASTER TERMINAL FOR RTR DECLARATION Mode Lock: SET, REG, X, Z, MGR or - /Anytime outside a sale Depress [RTR] NOTES: 1. While a PC job is under way ( a command of ULL, DLL, or Read/Reset from the PC), this RTR Declaration is not possible. Similarly, while this RTR Declaration is on, no PC jobs are possible. 2. While the RTR Declaration is on, no transaction entries in “REG”, “MGR”, or “ - “ mode are possible. 3. While the RTR Declaration is on, no Backup Data Check is performed. 4. While the RTR Declaration is on, the following are jobs to be allowed: • Programming Operations • DLL Operations (DLL to Satellite Terminals) • Consolidated Read/Reset Report takings • Manual Copying of Backup Data 5. The [RTR] key can be programmed to require Manager Intervention. 6. If the option “Auto Data Copying feature” is selected for Copying of Backup Data, the RTR Declaration is not possible while a backup data update process is under way. 7. If the option “Compulsion of Data Sending to PC” is selected, the RTR Declaration is not possible until sending the reset data (the consolidation data) to PC is completed. By depressing the [RTR] key on the Master Terminal when the RTR Declaration is on, the RTR Declaration ON status is canceled. PROCEDURE ON A MASTER TERMINAL FOR RTR DECLARATION CANCEL Mode Lock: SET, REG, X, Z, MGR or - / RTR Declaration is ON Depress [RTR] NOTE: If the Backup Error Flag is ON (the standard error message is “PLEASE BACK UP”), it means that manual copying of Backup Data is required, and therefore the RTR Declaration Cancel is not accepted until copying is completed. 4- 1 4. M/S LEVEL MANAGER’S GUIDE EO1-11152 MA-1595-1 SERIES TABLE OF CONTENTS Page 1. DAILY OPERATION FLOW -------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1- 1 2. OPERATIONS BEFORE IN-LINE SERVICE ---------------------------------------------------- 2- 1 2.1 2.2 2.3 Terminal Open Check ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2- 1 Terminal Designation ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2- 2 Terminal Condition Check ------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2- 3 3. RESERVATION ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 3- 1 3.1 3.2 3.3 Reservation Function ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 3- 1 Report Reservation Print Format---------------------------------------------------------------------- 3- 3 Operations Relative To Reservation ----------------------------------------------------------------- 3- 4 4. READ AND RESET REPORTS --------------------------------------------------------------------- 4- 1 4.1 4.2 4.3 Terminal Reports------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4- 1 In-Line Reports -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4- 2 Operations After In-Line Report Takings ------------------------------------------------------------ 4- 9 5. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS ------------------------------------------------------------------- 5- 1 5.1 5.2 5.3 Programming Operations Common with Standalone ECR Level------------------------------ 5- 1 Programming Operations Added for In-line Terminals ------------------------------------------- 5- 2 Verification of Programmed Data --------------------------------------------------------------------- 5- 5 6. DLL (Down-Line-Loading) OPERATIONS ------------------------------------------------------ 6- 1 7. DEPARTMENT AND PLU MAINTENANCE ----------------------------------------------------- 7- 1 7.1 7.2 7.3 PLU Table Addition/Change/Deletion with DLL---------------------------------------------------- 7- 2 Department Preset Price Setting or Changing with DLL (Submode 72) --------------------- 7- 3 PLU Price Changing with DLL (Submode 73)------------------------------------------------------ 7- 4 8. INQUIRIES ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8- 1 8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 PLU Inquiries ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8- 1 Customer File (Check Track) Inquiries -------------------------------------------------------------- 8- 1 Credit Card No. Inquiries to the Negative Check File -------------------------------------------- 8- 2 Cashier Occupy Inquiries ------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8- 2 9. BACKUP FUNCTION ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9- 1 10. DATA CAPTURE FUNCTION --------------------------------------------------------------------- 10- 1 11. MASTER AND BACKUP MASTER ALTERNATION---------------------------------------- 11- 1 12. TRANSMISSION ERROR--------------------------------------------------------------------------- 12- 1 12.1 Cause of Error ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 12- 1 12.2 Error Display --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 12- 1 12.3 Error Canceling Process ------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 12- 2 13. OTHER OPERATIONS RELATING TO IN-LINE SERVICE ------------------------------- 13- 1 13.1 13.2 13.3 13.4 13.5 Time Out -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 13- 1 Suspending----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 13- 2 Retry ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 13- 2 Incomplete Ending-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 13- 2 Cancel ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 13- 3 1. DAILY OPERATION FLOW EO1-11152 1. DAILY OPERATION FLOW 1. DAILY OPERATION FLOW In a Master-Satellite System, a certain order of jobs on the Master and Satellite terminals are provided. If the necessary jobs are not proceeded in the correct order, sale entries may not be operated or report collections may not be possible. The following chart shows the basic daily operation flow on the Master and Satellite terminals. MASTER TERMINAL SATELLITE TERMINALS Turn ON the power of every ECR in the in-line system. First turn ON the power of the Master terminal, and then the power of each Satellite terminals. Operate TERMINAL OPEN CHECK to check all the terminals are correctly connected (Chapter 2): Mode Lock: X/RTR Declaration: ON 80 [AT/TL] Operate DATE AND TIME DLL to synchronize the date and time of Satellite terminals to that of the Master terminal (Chapter 6): Mode Lock: SET/RTR Declaration: ON 505 [AT/TL] STORE OPEN Sign-ON, Sale Entries, Sign-OFF Refer to the OPERATOR’S GUIDE for the Standalone Level. Read (X) Report Takings on Individual Terminals Refer to Section 5 in this manual and MANAGER’S GUIDE for the Standalone Level. In-line Read Report Takings on Master Terminal. Refer to Section 4.2 in this manual. (To be continued on the next page.) 1- 1 1. DAILY OPERATION FLOW EO1-11152 1. DAILY OPERATION FLOW (Continued from the preceding page.) (MASTER TERMINAL) (SATELLITE TERMINALS) STORE CLOSE Sign OFF on all the terminals (including the Master Terminal) when all the sale entries for the day are over. In-line Reset Report Takings on Master Terminal. (Refer to Section 4.2.) The HOLD condition of the terminal cannot be released for some reason, an ENFORCED CLEAR OF HOLD CONDITION can be operated on individual terminals. (Refer to Section 4.3.) CONSOLIDATED REPORT DATA READ If programmed data changes are necessary: PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS (Chapter 5) DLL OPERATIONS (Chapter 6) DEPARTMENT AND PLU MAINTENANCE (Chapter 7) Turn OFF the power of every terminal to end the business for the day. 1- 2 2. OPERATIONS BEFORE IN-LINE SERVICE EO1-11152 2.1 Terminal Open Check 2. OPERATIONS BEFORE IN-LINE SERVICE Before entering in-line service operations (In-line Report takings, DLLs, etc.), the following operations are available if necessary. 2.1 Terminal Open Check This operation sends a dummy text to those terminals set in the TERMINAL CONNECTION TABLE, and prints out the Register Nos. of the disconnected terminals (i.e. terminals not responding). CONDITION Any time outside a sale (operable on Master Terminal) OPERATION Mode Lock: X and IN-LINE Lamp illuminated 80 [AT/TL] Master Terminal Receipt Print When the check result is normal: Prints the Report Name only. When any error status is found: Prints the Register Nos. of the terminals not connected properly, as well as the Report Name. 7( 7(&& 6725( 7(& 6725( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 681 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 681 127B&211(&7 127B&211(&7 ∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗ ∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗ ∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗ ∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗ 70 70 2- 1 2. OPERATIONS BEFORE IN-LINE SERVICE EO1-11152 2.2 Terminal Designation 2.2 Terminal Designation This operation can be performed before any in-line service operation. When this operation is skipped, no specific terminals are designated, i.e., the in-line service operations will be performed to all the terminals. CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET, X, or Z (depending on the in-line service operations to follow) RTR Declaration ON Status (i.e., the IN-LINE Lamp should be illuminated) To be operated on the Master Terminal only. [#] |Store/Register No.| [#] [AT/TL] Enter the Store/Register No. (Max. 6 digits) of the Terminal subject to the in-line service operations to follow. Repeat for other terminals if more are subject to the in-line service operation. NOTE: The Terminal Designation once declared by the above operation will be canceled by changing the position of the Mode Lock, or by RTR Declaration Cancel, or by turning OFF and ON the power of the terminal. The designation is automatically canceled on completion of the operation to follow or when a new designation is operated. ex.) To designate the following Terminal out of two terminals in the system: Terminal ID No.3: Store/Register No. 333303 (IP Address: 192.168.0.251) Mode Lock: SET (if operated before DLLs) The RTR Declaration must be ON (i.e., the IN-LINE Lamp must be illuminated; if not, depress the [RTR] key to declare RTR status). [#] 333303 [#] [AT/TL] (Issues a receipt, printing the Store/Register Nos. of the terminals designated in the above operation.) 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 3 70 2- 2 2. OPERATIONS BEFORE IN-LINE SERVICE EO1-11152 2.3 Terminal Condition Check 2.3 Terminal Condition Check This operation checks the condition of the designated terminals, and prints out the status responded from the terminals. CONDITION Any time outside a sale (operable on Master Terminal) OPERATION Mode Lock: X and IN-LINE Lamp illuminated 81 [AT/TL] Master Terminal Receipt Print 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 70B&+(&. ∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗ 2. ∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗ 70 2- 3 Status Symbol OK: The terminal condition is normal. ?: No response (power-OFF, etc.) BUSY: The terminal is busy (during a sale, etc.). Blank: Other statuses 3. RESERVATION EO1-11152 3.1 Reservation Function 3. RESERVATION 3.1 Reservation Function This function is applied only to a system with the CVS spec. selected as the program option. Performing the following reservations on the Master Terminal forces the Satellite Terminals to copy the relevant report data into the communication buffers. Therefore, the Master Terminal can consolidate report data of the Satellite Terminals, and issue an in-line report even while the Satellite Terminals sign off, and perform sales entries. TABLE OF RESERVATION OPERATIONS RTR Declaration: ON Mode Lock Report Name COMBINATION REPORTS • Combination 1 Read: Key Operation Daily GT Daily GT Daily GT Daily GT Daily GT Daily GT X X X X X X Z Z Z Z Z Z 600 [AT/TL] 700 [AT/TL] 601 [AT/TL] 701 [AT/TL] 602 [AT/TL] 702 [AT/TL] 600 [AT/TL] 700 [AT/TL] 601 [AT/TL] 701 [AT/TL] 602 [AT/TL] 702 [AT/TL] Daily GT Daily GT X X Z Z 603 [AT/TL] 703 [AT/TL] 603 [AT/TL] 703 [AT/TL] CASHIER REPORTS (for the Floating Cashier feature) • Individual Cashier Read: Daily X • Individual Cashier Reset: GT Daily X Z GT Daily GT Daily GT Z X X Z Z 604 [#] |Cashier ID Code| [AT/TL] (2 digit manager-assign code) Start with 704 instead of 604 in the above pattern. 604 [#] |Cashier ID Code| [AT/TL] (2 digit manager-assign code) Start with 704 instead of 604 in the above pattern. 604 [AT/TL] 704 [AT/TL] 604 [AT/TL] 704 [AT/TL] • Combination 2 Read: • Combination 3 Read: • Combination 1 Reset: • Combination 2 Reset: • Combination 3 Reset: FINANCIAL REPORTS • Financial Read: • Financial Reset: • All store All Cashier Read: • All store All Cashier Reset: (to be continued on next page) 3- 1 3. RESERVATION EO1-11152 3.1 Reservation Function TABLE OF RESERVATION OPERATIONS (continued) RTR Declaration: ON Mode Lock Report Name SALESPERSON REPORTS (Daily only) • All-store All Salesperson Read • All-store All Salesperson Reset CREDIT CARD COMPANY SALES REPORTS • Credit Card Company Daily Sales Read: GT • Credit Card Company Daily Sales Reset: GT DEPARTMENT GROUP REPORTS (Read only) • Department Group Read: Daily GT MEDIA SALES AND IN-DRAWER READ (Daily only) HOURLY RANGE REPORTS • Hourly Read (Daily only) • Hourly Reset (Daily only) DEPARTMENT REPORTS • All Department Read: Daily GT • All Department Reset: Daily GT ALL MEDIA SALES TOTAL AND CASH-INDRAWER READ (Daily only) PLU REPORTS (For the feature “PLU to be inquired to the Center File.”) (Daily only) • All PLU Read • All PLU Reset • Zone PLU Read • Zone PLU Reset PLU GROUP REPORTS • PLU Group Read: • PLU Group Reset: X Z 605 [AT/TL] 605 [AT/TL] X X Z Z 606 [AT/TL] 706 [AT/TL] 606 [AT/TL] 706 [AT/TL] X X 608 [AT/TL] 708 [AT/TL] X 609 [AT/TL] X Z 610 [AT/TL] 610 [AT/TL] X X Z Z 611 [AT/TL] 711 [AT/TL] 611 [AT/TL] 711 [AT/TL] X 612 [AT/TL] X Z X 613 [AT/TL] 613 [AT/TL] 613 [#] → |Zone-start PLU Code| [@/FOR] → |Zone-end PLU Code| [AT/TL] 613 [#] → |Zone-start PLU Code| [@/FOR] → |Zone-end PLU Code| [AT/TL] Z Daily GT Daily GT Key Operation 624 [AT/TL] 724 [AT/TL] 624 [AT/TL] 724 [AT/TL] X X Z Z (to be continued on next page) 3- 2 3. RESERVATION EO1-11152 3.2 Report Reservation Print Format TABLE OF RESERVATION OPERATIONS (continued) RTR Declaration: ON Report Name Mode Lock CUSTOMER FILE REPORTS (for Check Track Memory type only) • All Files Read • All Files Reset • Zone Files Read X Z X • Zone Files Reset Z NOTES: 3.2 Key Operation 615 [AT/TL] 615 [AT/TL] 615 [#] → |Zone-start File Code| [@/FOR] → |Zone-end File Code| [AT/TL] 615 [#] → |Zone-start File Code| [@/FOR] → |Zone-end File Code| [AT/TL] 1. Reservation function is unavailable when the Satellite Terminals perform the transactions in “SET”, “X” and “Z” modes. 2. Reservation function is only an operation to copy report data into the communication buffer. Therefore, actual report cannot be issued by this function. To issue a report, key operation to issue it is further necessary on the Master Terminal. Refer to the next chapter “4. READ AND RESET REPORTS” regarding key operation to issue a report. 3. When Reservation operation is performed before the data is set in the communication buffer, “DT R” will be printed. When the reservation reset is performed under the condition that the reset data is in the communication buffer, “DT Z” will be printed. Report Reservation Print Format 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 5(6(59(' ∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗ ∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗ ;;;; ;;;; ;;;; ∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗ -21(6 70 RTR Symbol Reservation Symbol Report Name RTR Symbol Register No. and Status OK: Normal status ?: No response BUSY: The terminal is busy Blank: Other statuses DT_R: Already reserved DT_Z: Reset data exists 3- 3 3. RESERVATION EO1-11152 3.3 Operations Relative To Reservation 3.3 Operations Relative To Reservation The following operations are available only to a system with the CVS spec. selected. READ OF INFORMATION ALREADY COPIED IN COMMUNICATION BUFFER This operation issues report names of which sales data have been already copied in the communication buffer. Mode Lock: X OPERATION ON ANY TERMINAL: 96 [AT/TL] NOTE: The following contents are printed. • Distinction of report (Read or Reset) • Transaction name ENFORCED CLEAR OF COMMUNICATION BUFFER This operation forcibly clears the content already copied in the communication buffer. Mode Lock: Z OPERATION ON ANY TERMINAL: 9998 [AT/TL] NOTE: This operation should be performed only when malfunction of PC or Master Terminal occurs. Therefore, the memory content is not guaranteed if this operation is performed when a system is normal. 3- 4 4. READ AND RESET REPORTS EO1-11152 4.1 Terminal Reports 4. READ AND RESET REPORTS 4.1 Terminal Reports Since most reports are taken as in-line reports on the Master Terminal, some of the reports which are available on the individual standalone ECR basis cannot be taken on Master or Satellite ECRs of the in-line system. The following are the reports which are listed in the MANAGER’S GUIDE for the standalone level but cannot be taken on any ECRs of the in-line system. Other reports not listed below can be taken even in the in-line system. (Before taking those reports, however, please read the next section 4.2 IN-LINE REPORTS.) TERMINAL REPORTS that cannot be taken on any ECRs of the in-line system DAILY REPORTS GT REPORTS Report Name Report Name CASHIER READ AND RESET REPORTS (when adopting the Floating Cashier Feature) • Individual Cashier Read • Individual Cashier Reset • All Cashier Read • All Cashier Reset PLU READ AND RESET REPORTS (when programming PLU data in the Center File) • Individual PLU Read • Zone PLU Read • Zone PLU Reset • All PLU Read • All PLU Reset • Inactive PLU Read CUSTOMER FILE READ REPORTS (for Check Track Memory type only) • Individual File Read • Zone Files Read • All Files Read • Zero-balance Files Read • Debit-balance Files Read • Credit-balance Files Read CASHIER GT READ AND RESET REPORTS (when adopting the Floating Cashier Feature) • Individual Cashier GT Read • Individual Cashier GT Reset • All Cashier GT Read • All Cashier GT Reset PLU GT READ AND RESET REPORTS (when programming PLU data in the Center File) • Individual PLU GT Read • Zone PLU GT Read • Zone PLU GT Reset • All PLU GT Read • All PLU GT Reset • Inactive PLU GT Read 4- 1 4. READ AND RESET REPORTS EO1-11152 4.2 In-Line Reports 4.2 In-Line Reports WARNING! When opening the cash drawer, be careful not to let the drawer hit any person. 4.2.1 In-Line Report Command Executions Before taking in-line reports, please note the following: 1) In-line Reset Reports (as well as In-line Read Reports) can be taken on the Master Terminal as long as the Satellite Terminals are in the idle state (“Signed OFF” condition in case of the cashier code entry type). To check status of all the terminals connected to the in-line, TERMINAL CONDITION CHECK can be operated (refer to Chapter 2). 2) When In-line Reports are taken, the power of each Satellite Terminal must be turned ON but the Mode Lock can be in any positions. The operation flow for taking In-line Reports is shown on the next page, and the table of In-line Reports is on the following pages. The key operation for each In-line Report is the same as the corresponding terminal report available on the standalone ECR. However, the key operation can be executed only on the Master Terminal while the [RTR] key is turned on. Conditions required on terminals for In-line Report takings: Read/Reset Reports (Daily or GT) Master Terminal: Any time outside a sale Satellite Terminals: (NOTE below) Lock Positions Required: Master Terminal: Satellite Terminals: NOTE: Mode Lock: X/RTR Declaration: ON Mode Lock: Z/RTR Declaration: ON Any positions Conditions required on the Satellite Terminals for in-line report takings depend on the system features. • Cashier code entry type with the CVS spec. selected ... Satellite Terminal during a Sign-OFF, SignON, and sales entries • Cashier code entry type without the CVS spec. ... Satellite Terminal during a Sign-OFF, and SignON with no sales entries performed • Cashier key type with the CVS spec. selected ... Satellite Terminal during idling, and sales entries • Cashier key type without CVS spec. ... Satellite Terminal during idling • When the CVS spec. is selected and there is no collected data, “NO-D” will be printed. When the collected data is not agreed, “NO-A” will be printed. 4- 2 4. READ AND RESET REPORTS EO1-11152 4.2 In-Line Reports OPERATION FLOW OF IN-LINE READ OR RESET REPORTS To be operated on the Master Terminal only Designating All Terminals Designating Some Terminals [#] |Store/Register No.| of the terminal to be designated (max. 6 digits) Repeat for all the terminals to be designated. Refer to Chapter 2. [#] [AT/TL] Report Taking Operation for Each Report (see the following pages) Refer to the following pages. Each Terminal’s Report Data Collection Process When the option “Individual Terminal Data Report Issue” is selected. (applicable to Financial Reports only) In other cases Each Terminal’s Data Print (from Master Terminal) Incomplete Ending: Uncollected Terminal’s Store/Register No. Print Normal Ending Consolidated Data Report End 4- 3 Also refer to Retry, Suspending, and Cancel operations. Refer to Chapter 13. 4. READ AND RESET REPORTS EO1-11152 4.2 In-Line Reports TABLE OF IN-LINE REPORT OPERATIONS RTR Declaration: ON Mode Lock Report Name COMBINATION REPORTS • Combination 1 Read: Key Operation Daily GT Daily GT Daily GT Daily GT Daily GT Daily GT X X X X X X Z Z Z Z Z Z [AT/TL] 200 [AT/TL] 1 [AT/TL] 201 [AT/TL] 2 [AT/TL] 202 [AT/TL] [AT/TL] 200 [AT/TL] 1 [AT/TL] 201 [AT/TL] 2 [AT/TL] 202 [AT/TL] Daily GT Daily GT X X Z Z 3 [AT/TL] 203 [AT/TL] 3 [AT/TL] 203 [AT/TL] CASHIER REPORTS (for the Floating Cashier feature) • Individual Cashier Read: Daily X • Individual Cashier Reset: GT Daily X Z GT Daily GT Daily GT Z X X Z Z 4 [#] |Cashier ID Code| [AT/TL] (2-digit manager-assign code) Start with 204 instead of 4 in the above pattern. 4 [#] |Cashier ID Code| [AT/TL] (2-digit manager-assign code) Start with 204 instead of 4 in the above pattern. 4 [AT/TL] 204 [AT/TL] 4 [AT/TL] 204 [AT/TL] X X Z Z 4 [AT/TL] 204 [AT/TL] 4 [AT/TL] 204 [AT/TL] X Z 5 [AT/TL] 5 [AT/TL] X X Z Z 6 [AT/TL] 206 [AT/TL] 6 [AT/TL] 206 [AT/TL] X X 8 [AT/TL] 208 [AT/TL] • Combination 2 Read: • Combination 3 Read: • Combination 1 Reset: • Combination 2 Reset: • Combination 3 Reset: FINANCIAL REPORTS • Financial Read: • Financial Reset: • All store All Cashier Read: • All store All Cashier Reset: CASHIER REPORTS (for the Non-Floating Cashier feature only) • Indiv. Terminal All Cashier Read: Daily GT • Indiv. Terminal All Cashier Reset: Daily GT SALESPERSON REPORTS (Daily only) • All-store All Salesperson Read • All-store All Salesperson Reset CREDIT CARD COMPANY SALES REPORTS • Credit Card Company Sales Read: Daily GT • Credit Card Company Sales Reset: Daily GT DEPARTMENT GROUP REPORTS (Read only) • Department Group Read: Daily GT (to be continued on next page) 4- 4 4. READ AND RESET REPORTS EO1-11152 4.2 In-Line Reports TABLE OF IN-LINE REPORT OPERATIONS (continued) RTR Declaration: ON Mode Lock Report Name MEDIA SALES AND IN-DRAWER READ (Daily only) HOURLY RANGE REPORTS • Hourly Read (Daily only) • Hourly Reset (Daily only) DEPARTMENT REPORTS • All Department Read: Daily GT • All Department Reset: Daily GT • Indiv. Department Read: Daily Key Operation X 9 [AT/TL] X Z 10 [AT/TL] 10 [AT/TL] X X Z Z X 11 [AT/TL] 211 [AT/TL] 11 [AT/TL] 211 [AT/TL] (Process Reports; NOTE on the next page) 11 [#] → [DEPT] (or |Code| [DP#]) → ([ST]) Repeat for required departments. GT ALL MEDIA SALES TOTAL AND CASH-INDRAWER READ (Daily only) PLU REPORTS (Reports marked with “*” are unavailable for the system with the feature “PLU to be inquired to the Center File.”) • All PLU Read: Daily GT* • All PLU Reset: Daily GT* • Zone PLU Read: Daily • Zone PLU Reset: • Individual PLU Read: X [AT/TL] (to end) Start with 211 instead of 11 in the above pattern. X 12 [AT/TL] X X Z Z X 13 [AT/TL] 213 [AT/TL] 13 [AT/TL] 213 [AT/TL] 13 [#] → |Zone-start PLU Code| [@/FOR] → |Zone-end PLU Code| [AT/TL] Start with 213 instead of 13 in the above pattern. 13 [#] → |Zone-start PLU Code| [@/FOR] → |Zone-end PLU Code| [AT/TL] Start with 213 instead of 13 in the above pattern. (Process Reports; NOTE on the next page) 13 [#] → |PLU Code| [PLU] → ([ST]) [AT/TL] GT* Daily X Z GT* Z Daily X GT* X Daily GT* X X Start with 213 instead of 13 in the above pattern. (Process Reports; NOTE on the next page) 13 [#] → 0 [AT/TL] Start with 213 instead of 13 in the above pattern. Daily GT Daily GT X X Z Z 24 [AT/TL] 224 [AT/TL] 24 [AT/TL] 224 [AT/TL] Repeat for required PLUs. • Inactive PLU Read: PLU GROUP REPORTS • PLU Group Read: • PLU Group Reset: (to be continued on next page) 4- 5 4. READ AND RESET REPORTS EO1-11152 4.2 In-Line Reports TABLE OF IN-LINE REPORT OPERATIONS (continued) RTR Declaration: ON Report Name CUSTOMER FILE READ (for Check Track Memory type only) • All Files Read • All Files Reset • Zone Files Read • Zone Files Reset • Individual File Read • Zero-balance Files Read • Credit-balance Files Read • Debit-balance Files Read NOTE: Mode Lock Key Operation 15 [AT/TL] X Z X Z X X X X 15 [#] → |Zone-start File Code| [@/FOR] |Zone-end File Code| [AT/TL] 15 [#] → |File Code| [@/FOR] → [AT/TL] 15 [#] → 0 [AT/TL] 15 [#] → 1 [AT/TL] 15 [#] → 2 [AT/TL] When the “Process Report” is marked, the report can only be taken after taking another report which consolidates the corresponding data to be based on. For further details, see the table and descriptions below. PROCESS REPORTS AND BASE REPORT DATA The following table shows which process reports are available after which report data collections. Reports Collection Required before Process Report takings (CONSOLIDATION MEMORY CAPTURE: NOTE 1) All Department Read Daily or All Department Reset Daily All Department Read GT or All Department Reset GT Any of the following PLU reports (NOTE 2) All PLU Read Daily Zone PLU Read Daily All PLU Reset Daily Zone PLU Reset Daily Any of the following PLU reports (NOTE 2) Process Reports available Individual Department Read Daily Individual Department Read GT Individual PLU Read Daily Inactive PLU Read Daily Individual PLU Read GT Inactive PLU Read GT All PLU Read GT Zone PLU Read GT All PLU Reset GT Zone PLU Reset GT NOTES: 1. CONSOLIDATION MEMORY CAPTURE: When an in-line read or reset report is taken on the Master Terminal, the consolidated data is automatically stored in the Consolidation Memory of the Master Terminal. The consolidated data stored there is not only used as the data for a Process Report but also sent to the PC by a command from the PC when a PC is connected. 2. The process reports will be outputted based on the report data previously collected. For example, when an “Inactive PLU Read” report is taken after a “Zone PLU Read”, only the inactive PLUs in the designated zone will be printed on the Inactive Read Report. (Only when the PLU is in a local file, a process report is printed. In this case, collection of data is required beforehand.) 4- 6 4. READ AND RESET REPORTS EO1-11152 4.2 In-Line Reports 3. When individual department reading (daily/GT) is performed, press the [OPEN] key before performing all department reading (daily/GT). Then, only the consolidated data is created to output the process report. 4.2.2 In-Line Report Print Format IN-LINE REPORT TYPE An in-line report can be classified into the following five types. 1. Collects data from each terminal to print a consolidation result: All Salesperson, Credit Card Company Sales, Department Group, Hourly Range, All Department, All/Zone PLU (Local File), and PLU Group Reports 2. Collects data from each terminal to print a collection result per terminal: Indiv. Terminal All Cashier Report (Non-floating Cashier) 3. Collects data from each terminal to print a collection result per terminal and then print the consolidation result: Financial, Media Sales & In-drawer and All Media Sales Total & Cash-in-drawer Reports 4. Creates a process data using consolidated data and prints a report: Indiv. Department, Indiv. PLU, and Inactive PLU Reports 5. Prints data in the center file possessed by the master terminal: Indiv./All Cashier (Floating Cashier), All/Zone/Indiv./Inactive PLU (Center File), and All/Indiv./Inactive/ Debit/Credit Customer File Reports The print format of each report is basically the same as the format of the corresponding standalone terminal report except that some indications are additionally printed as in-line operation job IDs. The following is print format example of the in-line report type 1 described above. 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 ∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗ RTR Symbol Report Name (When designating a zone, a zone range is printed.) For print items, refer to the similar report described in the Standalone section. = = = ;;;; ;;;; Register No., Reset Count (on Reset Report only) ∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗ -21(6 70 RTR Symbol Un finished register No. and status ?: No response BUSY: The terminal is busy Blank: Other statuses NO_D: No consolidation data exists. NO_A: Discord of consolidation data Consecutive No., Current Time 4- 7 Only for the CVS spec. 4. READ AND RESET REPORTS EO1-11152 4.2 In-Line Reports JOURNAL INDICATIONS ON INDIVIDUAL TERMINALS (when report data is collected) ∗ ; 70 ∗ Read Report Collection Indication Time of data collection Report ID No. (X is replaced by Z on reset reports.) ∗ = = 70 ∗ 70 Reset Report Collection Indication Time of Clear Command receiving JOURNAL INDICATIONS FOR A SYSTEM WITH THE CVS SPEC. SELECTED The following journal prints indicate that data in each table has copied into the communication buffer. (1) Copy of daily read data has completed. ; 70 Time of copy completion Report ID No. (2) Copy of daily reset data has completed. = = 70 70 Clear of the table has completed Time of copy completion and clear completion Report ID No. (3) Copy of GT read data has completed. ; 70 Time of copy completion Report ID No. (4) Copy of GT reset data has completed. = = 70 70 Clear of the table has completed Time of copy completion and clear completion Report ID No. 4- 8 4. READ AND RESET REPORTS EO1-11152 4.3 Operations After In-Line Report Takings 4.3 Operations After In-Line Report Takings The following operations are available after taking in-line reports. CONSOLIDATED REPORT DATA READ (REPRINT) This operation issues the report data which is remaining in the Consolidation Memory of the Master Terminal. Mode Lock: X/RTR Declaration: ON OPERATION ON MASTER TERMINAL: 90 [AT/TL] When no consolidated data are remaining in the memory, this read operation is unavailable. ENFORCED CLEAR OF HOLD CONDITION (on Individual Terminals) This can be operated when the HOLD condition on a terminal can by no means be cleared because the terminal cannot receive a Clear Command from the Master Terminal for some reason (the Master Terminal becomes down, etc. before completion of the reset report data collection). OPERATION ON ANY TERMINAL IN HOLD CONDITION: 9999 [AT/TL] Mode Lock: Z On operating this, the HOLD condition is cleared, and allowing any key-in operations. However, this operation is regarded as an emergent measure to cope with such a trouble as the Master Terminal becomes down, etc. and thus no other solutions can be chosen, because the sales data memory of those reports can no longer be collected by the Master Terminal. 4- 9 5. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 5.1 Programming Operations Common with Standalone ECR Level 5. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS The system should be programmed fully by your local TOSHIBA TEC representative at the time of delivery according to the user’s requirements so that daily operations can immediately start. However, some data must be added or changed daily or in a longer period. Since the volume of programming contents for the system is too large, this chapter and the following two chapters are provided as guide lines of the user’s daily programming and maintenance operations. If there are any unclear points or program data other than listed here must be changed or added, please contact your TOSHIBA TEC representative. Please also note that some programming operations introduced in the Standalone Level are modified or not available on in-line terminals. 5.1 Programming Operations Common with Standalone ECR Level The following is the table of programming operations which are introduced in the Manager’s Guide for the Standalone Level and can be operated on in-line terminals as well, with the Submode No. and operation sequence unchanged. However, on in-line terminals, these are usually operated on the Master Terminal only and down-line-loaded (DLLed) to all the Satellite Terminals. Therefore, if any program data is changed, a DLL is further necessary to load the new data (after the change) to all the Satellite Terminals (to be described in Chapter 6). PROGRAMMING JOB LIST *1 Master : Programming job to be available when the [RTR] key is activated on the Master Terminal *2 Satellite : Programming job to be available on the Backup Master Terminal and the Satellite Terminal when the [RTR] key is off on the Master Terminal Submode No. 1 2 4 5 6 8 15 20 25 26 27 31 35 40 No Submode Programming Job Store Name/Message and Commercial Message Programming Cashier Code and Name Programming PLU Table Programming Time Setting or Adjustment Date Setting or Adjustment Amount Limit Setting for Function Keys Customer File Code (Check Track No.) and Name Programming Salesperson Code and Name Programming Link PLU Table Programming Tare Table and General Unit Weight Setting PLU Preset-code Key Setting Display Message Programming Negative Amount Key Limit Amount Setting PLU Price Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Amount Setting Department Preset Price Setting or Changing PLU Preset Price Setting or Changing, Whole Package Quantity Changing %+ and %- Preset Rate Setting Preset Rate Setting for Selective Itemizers Foreign Currency Exchange Rate Setting Tax Table Programming Store/Register No. Setting 5- 1 O: Available Terminals *1 *2 Satellite Master O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O 5. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 5.2 Programming Operations Added for In-line Terminals 5.2 Programming Operations Added for In-line Terminals 5.2.1 Terminal Connection Table Setting (Submode 69) This submode is required for In-line services. The In-line ID No., Register No. and IP Address of each terminal (including the Master Terminal) can be programmed here. CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET and IN-LINE Lamp illuminated 69 [@/FOR] |In-line ID No.| [ST] 2 digits (01 to 16) (NOTES 1 & 2 below) |Store/Register No.| [#] Max. 6 digits 0 to 999999 (NOTE 2 below) * |IP Address| [#] 12 digits (NOTE 3 below) Repeat for other terminals to be connected, including the Master Terminal itself. (Max. 16 terminals) NOTES: 1. 2. 3. 4. 6. * For sequentially programming Inline ID Nos, the Inline ID specification can be skipped. In-line ID No.: Master Terminal ... 01 (fixed) Backup Master Terminal (if connected) ... 02 (fixed) Satellite Terminals ... 03 to 16 (max. 14 terminals) The In-line ID No. and Register No. of each terminal to be set here must be the same as those programmed for the terminal in IN-LINE TERMINAL ID SETTING (Submode 77) in this chapter and STORE/REGISTER NO. SETTING (no submode) in Chapter 6 of the Programming Manual for stand-alone level. IP Address: 12 digits (000.. 000 to 255.. 255) ex) To set the IP Address 192.168.0.252……….Enter 192168000252 To delete an individual terminal from the Terminal Connection Table, enter 0 in place of the Inline ID No., then enter Register No.. 69 [@/FOR] 5. [AT/TL] 0 [ST] |Store/Register No.| [#] [AT/TL] To delete the entire Terminal Connection Table once set, operate: 69 [@/FOR] 0 [AT/TL] If a deleting operation (individual or entire deletion) is performed, the files occupied by the deleted terminal(s) (such as Floating Cashier File, etc.) is canceled. Therefore, a deleting operation should be performed only when the system is to be re-built or a terminal is to be detached from the system. Example) To set Master Terminal and Satellite Terminal in the Connection Table (total of two terminals in the in-line system): Master Terminal In-line ID No. 1 Register No. 111101 Satellite Terminal In-line ID No. 3 Register No. 333303 IP Address 192.168.0.251 IP Address 192.168.0.253 Mode Lock SET and IN-LINE Lamp illuminated, enter 69, depress [@/FOR]. 01 [ST] (Master In-line ID No.) 111101 [#] (Master Register No.) 192168000251 [#] (Master IP Address) 03 [ST] (Satellite In-line ID No.) 333303 [#] (Satellite Register No.) 192168000253 [#] (Satellite IP Address) [AT/TL] (Complete this Submode) Key Operation: 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 5- 2 3 70 5. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 5.2 Programming Operations Added for In-line Terminals 5.2.2 In-line ID and LAN Network Setting (Submode 77) This submode is available for in-line terminals (including the master and backup master terminals). It must be operated separately on each terminal since the In-line ID should vary from terminal to terminal. The data sent in this submode is used as the in-line address of the terminal for in-line service operations. CONDITION Any time outside a sale for Master or Satellite OPERATION Mode Lock: SET and IN-LINE Lamp illuminated 77 [@/FOR] 1 [ST] | In-line ID | [#] Assign No. of 01 to 16 01: Master Terminal 02: Backup Master 03 to 16: Satellite Terminals 2 [ST] | Network Status | [#] Enter a maximum of eight-digit number composed of Bit Nos whose status must be selected to the “SET” status in the Network Status Table. (NOTE 1 on the next page) 3 [ST] | IP Address | [#] 12 digits (NOTE 2 on the next page) 4 [ST] | IP Address of Master Terminal | [#] 12 digits (NOTE 2 on the next page) 5 [ST] | Subnet Mask | [#] 12 digits (NOTE 2 on the next page) 6 [ST] | Default Gateway | [#] 12 digits (NOTE 2 on the next page) [AT/TL] 5- 3 5. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 5.2 Programming Operations Added for In-line Terminals NOTES: 1. Network Status Table Code Item 0 No Status 1 2 3 4 5 Default Gateway 6 Subnet Mask auto-setting 7 8 Set Reset Used Ineffective Not used Effective In the above table, only Code 5 and Code 6 can be set. Code 5: This code should be set before performing Default Gateway setting (6 [ST]). Code 6: When this code is set, the Subnet Mask setting (5 [ST]) will be effective. When this code is reset, the Subnet Mask auto-setting will be performed as follows. IP Address first section value Subnet Mask 0 to 127 255. 0. 0.0 128 to 191 255.255. 0.0 192 to 223 255.255.255.0 2. Self IP Address, IP Address of Master terminal, Subnet Mask, and Default Gateway are programmed with 12-digit value (000..000 to 255..254), respectively. Example) To program “192.168.0.250”, enter 192168000250. Initial setting values of the Self IP Address and the Default Gateway are as shown below. Self IP Address: 192.168.0.254 Default Gateway: 192.168.0.1 3. Never assign the same In-line ID to terminals on the same In-line system. Example) To assign Terminal ID No. 4 to the Terminal used as the Satellite Terminal of the in-line system: In-line ID No.: 04 Network Status: No Status IP Address: 192.168.0.200 IP Address of Master Terminal: 192.168.0.250 Subnet Mask: 255.255.255.0 (Default) Default Gateway: 192.168.0.1 (Default) 7(& 6725( Mode Lock SET and IN-LINE Lamp illuminated, enter 77, depress [@/FOR]. 1 [ST] 04 [#] (In-line ID No.) 2 [ST] 0 [#] (Network Status) 3 [ST] 192168000200 [#] (IP Address) 4 [ST] 192168000250 [#] (Master IP Address) [AT/TL] (Complete this Submode) Key Operation: 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ 681 3 70 5- 4 5. PROGRAMMING OPERATIONS EO1-11152 5.3 Verification of Programmed Data 5.3 Verification of Programmed Data The programmed data can be read for verification purposes. CONDITION Any time outside a sale (Sign OFF required under Cashier Signing Method) OPERATION Mode Lock: X or SET with IN-LINE Lamp Illuminated or extinguished. (Operable on any type of Terminal (Master, Backup Master, Satellites)) 1xx [AT/TL] Submode No. at programming 69: Terminal Connection Table Setting 77: In-line ID and LAN Network Setting NOTE: Verifications listed in the stand-alone level are also available on all the terminals of the in-line system. 5- 5 6. DLL (Down-Line-Loading) OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6. DLL (Down-Line-Loading) OPERATIONS 6. DLL (Down-Line-Loading) OPERATIONS In an in-line system (Master-Satellite system), most programming data are set on the Master Terminal and downline-loaded (DLL) to Satellite Terminals. The DLL operations introduced in this chapter are pure DLLs, i.e. merely loading the data programmed in the Master Terminal to Satellite Terminals. DLLs automatically performed with programmed data changes are introduced in the next chapter (Chapter 7). If any other DLLs not introduced in this and next chapters are required, ask your TOSHIBA TEC representative. Please also note that TERMINAL DESIGNATION (see Chapter 2) can be operated prior to a specific DLL operation, to designate Satellite Terminals that receive the DLL. DLL JOB LIST Submode No. 501 502 504 505 508 520 525 526 527 531 535 540 569 500 NOTE: DLL Job Store Name/Message and Commercial Message Programming Cashier Code and Name Programming PLU Table Programming Time/Date Setting Amount Limit Setting for Function Keys Salesperson Code and Name Programming Link PLU Table Programming Tare Table and General Unit Weight Setting PLU Preset-code Key Setting Display Message Programming Negative Amount Key Limit Amount Setting PLU Price Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Amount Setting Terminal Connection Table Setting %+ and %- Preset Rate Setting Preset Rate Setting for Selective Itemizers Foreign Currency Exchange Rate Setting Tax Table Programming DLL is possible only when the non-floating cashier feature is used. 6- 1 Remarks NOTE below 6. DLL (Down-Line-Loading) OPERATIONS EO1-11152 6. DLL (Down-Line-Loading) OPERATIONS CONDITION Terminals including the Master: Any time outside a sale (NOTE 1 below) (Sign-OFF condition is not necessary required for the Code Entry Method) OPERATION Satellite Terminals: Master Terminal: |5XX| [AT/TL] Any position if the power is ON Mode Lock: SET RTR Declaration: ON Submode No. PRINT FORMAT OF DLL OPERATIONS Master Terminal Receipt Satellite Terminals Journal 7(& 6725( 3($&+ '5,9( 3+21( ∗ 3;; 70 ∗ 2SHQ DP WR SP &ORVHG HYHU\ :HGQHVGD\ Time of receiving the DLL 681 5xx = Submode No. of the specific DLL operation 3;; ∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗ ∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗∗ ;;;; ;;;; ;;;; Un finished register No. and status ?: No response BUSY: The terminal is busy Blank: Other statuses 70 NOTES: 1. As for a system with the CVS spec. selected, DLL is unavailable when the Satellite Terminals perform sales data copy into the communication buffers. 2. For the Satellite Terminals being received the DLL data, the item entry is prohibited. (HOLD status) 6- 2 7. DEPARTMENT AND PLU MAINTENANCE EO1-11152 7. DEPARTMENT AND PLU MAINTENANCE 7. DEPARTMENT AND PLU MAINTENANCE In this chapter, adding, changing, or deleting operations related to Department Table and PLU Table program data are described. These are operated on the Master Terminal only. • For a system with the feature “PLU not to be inquired” selected All of these operations are immediately loaded into Satellite Terminals. • For a system with the feature “PLU to be inquired” selected PLU program data are immediately programmed in the center file of the Master Terminal, and Department Table data are immediately loaded into Satellite Terminals. TABLE OF DEPARTMENT AND PLU MAINTENANCE OPERATIONS Mode Submode page PLU TABLE ADDITION/CHANGE/DELETION WITH DLL............................... SET/RTR ....... 63 ........... 7-2 DEPARTMENT PRESET PRICE SETTING OR CHANGING WITH DLL........ SET/RTR ....... 72 ........... 7-3 PLU PRICE CHANGE WITH DLL .................................................................... SET/RTR ....... 73 ........... 7-4 7- 1 7. DEPARTMENT AND PLU MAINTENANCE EO1-11152 7.1 PLU Table Addition/Change/Deletion with DLL 7.1 PLU Table Addition/Change/Deletion with DLL • For a system with the feature “PLU not to be inquired” selected: The data entered on the Master Terminal is immediately loaded into the Satellite Terminals, item by item. • For a system with the feature “PLU to be inquired” selected: The data entered on the Master Terminal is immediately programmed in the center file owned by the Master Terminal itself. All the terminals: After PLU daily and GT Resets (when the feature “PLU not be inquired” is selected) CONDITION Master Terminal: Any time outside a sale (when the feature “PLU to be inquired” is selected) Mode Lock: SET and IN-LINE Lamp Illuminated OPERATION Barcode Scanning |Address Numbers| [#] 63 [@/FOR] |PLU Code| [PLU] for sequential-coded item only Address 1: Link Department |Department Code| [#] 1 [ST] (1 to 99) Address 2: PLU Name 2 [ST] Character Entries [ST] Max. 16 characters Address 3: Preset Price 3 [ST] Repeat for other PLUs. |Price| [#] (Max. 6 digits) Address 4: Status Code 1 4 [ST] |Status Codes to ON| [#] Address 5: Status Code 2 5 [ST] |Status Codes to ON| [#] Address 6: Tax Status 6 [ST] |Status Codes| [#] (Max. 4 digits) Repeat for any address within the same PLU by re-entry for correction. Address 7: Unit Price of Individual Split Package 7 [ST] |Unit Price| [#] (Max. 6 digits) Address 8: Whole Package Quantity 8 [ST] |Whole Package Quantity| [#] (Max. 2 digits) Address 9: PLU Group No. 9 [ST] |PLU Group No.| [#] (1 to 99; 0 to reset) Address 10: Link-PLU Table No. 10 [ST] |Link-PLU Table No.| [#] (1 to 99; 0 to reset) Address 11: Tare Table No. 11 [ST] |Tare Table No.| [#] (1 to 9; 0 to reset) Address 12: Unit Weight Code 12 [ST] |Unit Weight Code| [#] (1 to 11; 0 to reset) Address 13: Mix & Match Group No. 13 [ST] |Mix & Match Group No.| [#] (1 to 255; 0 to reset) Address 14: Tare 2 Rate 14 [ST] |Tare 2 Rate| [#] (0.01 to 99.99%; 0 to reset) Address 15: Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Code 15 [ST] |Dollar Discount/Extra Charge Code| [#] (1 to 99; 0 to reset) [AT/TL] (To complete this submode.) Operation procedure surrounded by this line is the same as the operation in Submode 4. 7- 2 7. DEPARTMENT AND PLU MAINTENANCE EO1-11152 7.2 Department Preset Price Setting or Changing with DLL (Submode 72) Deletion CONDITION The sales data of the required PLUs are zero and all terminals are outside a sale, programming, or report taking operations. (when the feature “PLU not to be inquired” is selected.) The sale data of the required PLUs are zero and any time outside a sale for Master. (when the feature “PLU to be inquired” is selected) OPERATION Mode Lock: SET and IN-LINE Lamp illuminated 63 [@/FOR] [ITEM CORR] | PLU code | [PLU] [ST] [AT/TL] Repeatable for other PLUs to be deleted. NOTES: 1. Up to 100 PLUs can be added/changed/deleted once. 2. The DLL is possible while a sales transaction is being performed in the Satellite Terminal. 7.2 Department Preset Price Setting or Changing with DLL (Submode 72) This submode is used to newly set or change a preset price to required departments, and loads the price data into Satellite Terminals. CONDITION Any time outside a sale OPERATION Mode Lock: SET and IN-LINE Lamp illuminated | New Preset Price | [DEPT] Max. 6 digits; 0 to 999999 (Department Preset Code Key) (result: $0.00 to $9999.99) 72 [@/FOR] [AT/TL] | Dept. Code | [DP#] | New Preset Price | [#] Max. 2 digits; 1 to 99 Max. 6 digits; 0 to 999999 (result: $0.00 to $9999.99) * Repeatable for other departments NOTES: * For sequentially programming the department, the Dept Code specification can be skipped. 1. When the [AT/TL] key is depressed in the above operation, it sends a DLL-start command to the designated terminals, makes the terminals HOLD condition, and executes DLL. After DLL is completed, it sends a DLL-end command to each terminal and releases the HOLD condition. 2. When zero is entered as the New Preset Price value, the department is set with a zero price. When the new Preset Price entry is skipped and the [DEPT] or [#] is simply depressed, it will be an open-price department. 7- 3 7. DEPARTMENT AND PLU MAINTENANCE EO1-11152 7.3 PLU Price Changing with DLL (Submode 73) 7.3 PLU Price Changing with DLL (Submode 73) This submode is used to change prices of PLUs existent in the PLU Table files, and into immediately load the data into Satellite Terminals. CONDITION Any time outside a sale for Master or Satellite. (only when the feature “PLU not to be inquired” is selected) OPERATION Mode Lock: SET and IN-LINE Lamp illuminated 73 [@/FOR] Barcode Scanning Can be skipped (for non-split Pricing type or when Whole Package Quantity is 1.) | PLU code | [PLU] | New Whole Package Quantity | [ST] Max. 2 digits; 0 to 99 Repeatable from here for sequentially programming PLU codes. | New Preset Price | [#] [AT/TL] Max. 6 digits; 0 to 999999 (result: $0.00 to $9999.99) to make open-price PLU Repeat for other PLUs NOTES: 1. 2. 3. When the [AT/TL] key is depressed in the above operation, it sends a DLL-start command to the designated terminals. A maximum of 100 PLUs’ prices can be changed in one operation sequence of this submode. When zero is entered as the New Preset Price value, the PLU is set with a zero price. When the New Preset Price entry is skipped and the [#] is simply depressed, it will be an open-price PLU. 7- 4 8. INQUIRIES EO1-11152 8.1 PLU Inquiries 8. INQUIRIES This chapter describes various inquiries made from each terminal to the Master Terminal and affect data (sales data updating). 8.1 PLU Inquiries When the feature “PLUs to be inquired” is selected and a PLU is entered in a sale (entered manually or through a barcode) on each terminal, the terminal inquires the PLU to the Master Terminal. The inquired Master Terminal searches the PLU code in the PLU Main Table and the PLU Additional Table. When the PLU exists, the Master Terminal responds the price, name, and other required data to the inquiring terminal. When the applicable PLU code does not exist in the Master Terminal, the message “CODE ERROR” (standard program; programmable) is displayed on the inquiring terminal. PLU URGENT MAINTENANCE When the inquired PLU code does not exist in the Master Terminal, the PLU can be programmed into the Master Terminal (and the Backup Master Terminal) along with its sale entry on the terminal by entering the linked Department and the price. The PLU thus entered is temporarily programmed in the PLU Additional Table. AFFECT When a PLU entry is determined on a terminal, the terminal sends an AFFECT text to the Master Terminal (and Backup Master Terminal), and updates the sales data of the Master Terminal (and Backup Master Terminal). NOTE: When the PLU Urgent Maintenance is not possible resulting from the PLU Additional File is full, the error message “PROGRAM ERROR” (standard program; programmable) is displayed on the inquiring terminal. 8.2 Customer File (Check Track) Inquiries When the feature “Customer File (Check Track)” (instead of PB Manual Entry) is selected and a PICK UP BALANCE (by [PICK UP BAL]) is entered on a terminal, the terminal inquires the entered Customer File Code to the Master Terminal. The inquired Master Terminal searches the Customer File Code in the Customer File Table. When the Customer File Code exists, the Master Terminal responds the name and the previous balance of the Customer File to the inquiring terminal. NEW CUSTOMER FILE INQUIRIES When a NEW CUSTOMER FILE (by [CODE OPEN] key) is entered on a terminal, the terminal inquires the new Customer File code entered to the Master Terminal. The Master Terminal confirms that the inquired Customer File code does not exist, then adds it to the Customer File table, and responds to the inquiring terminal that the code has been additionally set. (If a Backup Master is connected, the code inquiry to and additional setting in the Backup Master Terminal occur at the same time.) AFFECT When a Customer File entry is determined on a terminal, the terminal sends an AFFECT text to the Master Terminal (and Backup Master Terminal), and updates the sales data of the Master Terminal (and Backup Master Terminal). NOTES: 1. When the applicable file code does not exist on a Customer File Code inquiry (by [PICK UP BAL]) or when the applicable file code exists on a New Customer File Code inquiry (by [CODE OPEN]), the message “CODE ERROR” (standard program; programmable) is displayed on the inquiring terminal. 2. When the addition of new customer file code is not possible resulting from the Customer File is full, the error message “PROGRAM ERROR” (standard program; programmable) is displayed on the inquiring terminal. 8- 1 8. INQUIRIES EO1-11152 8.3 Credit Card No. Inquiries to the Negative Check File 8.3 Credit Card No. Inquiries to the Negative Check File When the “Negative Card Check” feature is selected by program option, each terminal inquires to the Master Terminal whether the entered Credit Card No. is acceptable or not. The Master Terminal, thus inquired, searches the Card No. in the Negative Card File. When the applicable Card No. exists in the Negative Card File, the Master Terminal responds to the inquiring terminal the response message “CALL MANAGER” (standard program; programmable) displayed in the Dotdisplay Windows with the Error Status Code (programmable) in the 7-segment Windows on the inquiring terminal to indicate that the Card No. is not acceptable. 8.4 Cashier Occupy Inquiries When the “Floating Cashier” feature is selected and a Cashier Code is entered on a terminal, the terminal inquires the cashier code corresponding to cashier code entered to the Master Terminal. The Master Terminal searches the Cashier Table of the Cashier No. in the Cashier File. When the the Cashier No. exists and its table is not occupied by any other terminal, the Master Terminal makes the cashier in the occupied status and sends the cashier table to the inquiring terminal. When the Cashier No. does not exist in the Master Terminal’s Cashier File, the Master Terminal responds the message “CODE ERROR” (standard program; programmable) to the inquiring terminal. When the Cashier Table is occupied by another terminal, the message “OCCUPY” (standard program; programmable) is responded instead. AFFECT When a sale entry is determined (i.e. finalized) on a terminal, the terminal sends AFFECT text to the Master Terminal (and Backup Master Terminal) and updates the sales data (in the Cashier Table) of the Master Terminal (and Backup Master Terminal). CASHIER CANCEL INQUIRES (OCCUPY CANCEL) When a Sign-OFF is operated on a terminal, the terminal inquires a CASHIER CANCEL to the Master Terminal. The Master Terminal cancels the occupied status of the applicable cashier. 8- 2 9. BACKUP FUNCTION EO1-11152 9. BACKUP FUNCTION 9. BACKUP FUNCTION (ONLY WHEN THE BACKUP MASTER IS CONNECTED) (1) Function • By connecting the Backup Master Terminal, the various files stored in the Master Terminal can be backed up. • The terminal assigned to ID No. 2 will function as a Backup Master Terminal. By programming ID No. 2 in the terminal connection table and downloading this data to each terminal, the system will function as a system in which the Backup Master Terminal is connected. • By changing terminal ID from 2 to 1, the Backup Master Terminal will function as the Master Terminal. < Files to be Backed Up > PLU Main Table (When the PLU inquiry function is used) PLU Additional Table (When the PLU inquiry function is used) Link PLU Table (When the PLU inquiry function is used) Cashier Table (When the floating cashier system is used) Customer File (Check Track) Table Negative Card Table Program data Sales data Program data Sales data Program data Program data Sales data Program data Sales data Program data NOTES: 1. Data capture (DC) transaction files are not backed up. 2. The tables (center files) managed by the Master Terminal and used by each terminal via inquiries and PC transmission information tables are backed up. • Sales data is backed up on a real-time basis. When sales data of the Master Terminal is updated, sales data of the Backup Master Terminal is updated at the same time. • Backup data check function: Correspondence between the center files and backup data is checked every certain period of time. • Backup data update process: When an error occurs in backup data, the following processing methods can be selected according to the program option setting. (1) Automatic data copy When the version of the center file stored in the Master Terminal is different from that stored in the Backup Master Terminal, registration jobs are automatically prohibited, the backup data is properly exchanged. While updating the backup data, each inquiry from the terminals may result in a “MASTER IS BUSY” error. (2) Manual data copy When the version of the center file stored in the Master Terminal is different from that of data stored in the Backup Master Terminal, the Master Terminal gives a short beep at the timing of issuing the long receipt to warn that the data is not backed up properly. The operator should update the backup data manually. 9- 1 9. BACKUP FUNCTION EO1-11152 9. BACKUP FUNCTION (2) Procedure 1) Changing Program Data (DLL from the PC) DLL Data PC Backup Data M BM Response • Response When various center files from the PC are received via DLL, the Master Terminal backs up program data and sales data of the Backup Master Terminal automatically and sends the result to the PC. 2) Changing Program Data (Operated on the Master Terminal) Programming Operation • * * M When various center files are being programmed on the Master Terminal, the backup error flag of the relevant file is turned on. (At this time, backup data is not updated.) For details about the backup error flag, refer to 5) Backup Error Flag. For an explanation of the backup data update process, refer to 6) Backup Data Update Process. 3) Updating Sales Data • For details about updating sales data, refer to the explanation of each of the control functions described in Chapter 7. 4) Checking Backup Data Version Request M BM Version Data • • • The Master Terminal sends the version request command to the Backup Master Terminal every certain period of time and receives version information about the backup data. The Master Terminal checks correspondence between the version information received from the Backup Master Terminal and the center files (stored in the Master). If an abnormality is found, the backup error flag is turned on. When a master job is being performed on the Master Terminal ([RTR] key turned on), or a PC job is being performed backup data is not checked. 5) Backup Error Flag • When there is any difference between the data stored in the Master Terminal and the backup data stored in the Backup Master Terminal, the Master Terminal turns on the backup error flag of the file in which a difference was found. • There are following five cases when the backup error flag is turned on. 1. The Master Terminal changes the programming of the center files. 2. A version error is found at the backup data check. 3. The backup job fails after the center file has been downloaded from the PC. 4. Updating of the backup data fails after the center files have been reset. 5. Mergence of backup data is not correctly performed by PLU merge operation (when the feature “PLU to be inquired” is selected). 9- 2 9. BACKUP FUNCTION EO1-11152 9. BACKUP FUNCTION • While the backup error flag is on, the following operation is performed. 1. The Master Terminal gives a short beep at the timing when the long receipt is printed to warn that a backup error has occurred. 2. The RTR declaration cancel operation results in compulsory manual data copy error. (The error indication “PLEASE BACK UP” is displayed.) In this case, the RTR declaration is not canceled until the manual data copy operation is performed. • There are two timings cases the backup error flag is turned off. 1. The backup data is properly backed up according to the backup data update process. 2. The Backup Master Terminal (ID No. 2) is deleted from the terminal connection table. 6) Backup Data Update Process (This is a process required when the backup data stored in the Backup Master Terminal is not updated properly due to an error.) Backup Data M BM Response • * * * * * The method processing backup error is selected according to the program option setting. Even if the automatic data copy operation is selected, data copy can be performed manually. 1. Automatic data copy (program option) When the backup error flag is on (or turned on), the Master Terminal automatically sends to the Backup Master Terminal the file in which the error has occurred, and updates the backup data. 2. Manual data copy (program option) The backup data is updated by the manual operations of the operator. When the backup data is being updated, inquiries from terminals may result in a “MASTER IS BUSY” error. When a “MASTER IS BUSY” error occurs, clear the error using the [C] key. Then, update the backup data again after the master job (backup process) is complete. Only the files with the backup error flag turned on are sent to the Backup Master Terminal to update the backup data. When the master job is being done on the Master Terminal ([RTR] key is turned on), backup data is not checked or updated. If the backup error flag is on when the master job is complete on the Master Terminal ([RTR] key is turned off; the INLINE lamp is off), manual data copy becomes compulsory. 7) Manual Copy of Backup Data OPERATION ON MASTER TERMINAL: Mode Lock: Z and IN-LINE Lamp illuminated 900 [AT/TL] 9- 3 10. DATA CAPTURE FUNCTION EO1-11152 10. DATA CAPTURE FUNCTION 10. DATA CAPTURE FUNCTION (1) Function To make it possible to transfer data to the PC, the details of registration jobs performed on each terminal are pooled in the Master Terminal as transaction data. (2) Buffering Transaction Data When a terminal performs the finalize operation, transaction data entered in registrations is sent to the Master Terminal. The Master Terminal receives the transaction data and pools it in the transaction buffer. The transaction data is controlled usually in two buffers. One is for buffering transaction data and the other is for collecting data from the PC. (When one buffer becomes full, or when the collection request is issued from the PC, the buffer in use is released for the PC, and the other buffer is used for subsequent buffering.) (3) Collecting Transaction Data The transaction data stored in the Master Terminal is sent to the PC according to the request from the PC. If the buffer becomes full when the Master Terminal receives the transaction data request command from the PC, the transaction data of the full buffer is sent to the PC. If the buffer is not full, the transaction data in the buffer (the buffer used for buffering) is sent to the PC. (4) Processing when the Transaction Buffer is Full When transaction data is received from the terminal (Backup Master, Satellite Terminal), the Master Terminal checks the vacant area of the transaction buffer. If the received transaction data cannot be stored in the buffer, the Master Terminal sends to the terminal a response indicating that the buffer is full. The terminal receiving this response, performs journal printing indicating that the transaction data is missing. (5) Supplementary • Only when the transaction data capture function is selected by program option, transaction data can be sent/received and buffered. • There is no warning reporting the remaining capacity of the transaction buffer. • Once the transaction data collection command is issued, data in one buffer is collected. (When data in two buffers is required, this command should be issued twice.) 10- 1 11. MASTER AND BACKUP MASTER ALTERNATION EO1-11152 11. MASTER AND BACKUP MASTER ALTERNATION 11. MASTER AND BACKUP MASTER ALTERNATION The Backup Master Terminal can be changed to be used as the Master Terminal for an accident that the Master Terminal becomes down, etc. And the Master Terminal can be changed to be used as the Backup Master when it comes back from repair, etc. To switch from the Backup Master Terminal function to the Master Terminal function: 1. Disconnect the Master Terminal from the line. 2. When other terminals are in registration operation, finalize and cashier Sign-OFF, or Cashier Key to OFF operations should be performed. Since a transmission error occurs at this time, an inquiry job should be completed. 3. Perform the operation below for all the terminals excepting the Backup Master Terminal to be switched. Mode Lock: SET 9000 [AT/TL] By this key operation, the new Master Terminal will perform processing below. • Backup Master Terminal is deleted from the Terminal Connection Table. • In-line ID No. is changed from 02 to 01 (i.e. from Backup Master to Master). • Store/Register No. of the old Master Terminal is assigned. • IP Address of the old Master Terminal is assigned. 4. Assign the [RTR] key to desired key of the new Master Terminal. 5. Download the Terminal Connection Table. The following files are guaranteed when the recovery process is performed. If a file is used in another terminal when the Master Terminal goes down, however, data stored in the terminal is not guaranteed. • Files controlled in the Master Terminal (PLU file, cashier file, etc.) • PC transmission information The following files and data are lost when the Master Terminal goes down. • Transaction file for data capture • Files controlled locally on the Master Terminal • Data in the files which are used by other terminals when the Master Terminal goes down. 11- 1 12. TRANSMISSION ERROR EO1-11152 12.1 Cause of Error 12. TRANSMISSION ERROR When a terminal makes an inquiry but a communication error occurs for some reason and the inquiry to the other station is not possible, the message “IRC CONNECT ERR” (standard program; programmable) is displayed on that terminal and operation is stopped. When the Master Terminal cannot access the inquiring file because the Master Terminal is receiving DLL data, the backup data is being updated between the Master and the Backup Master terminals, etc., the message “MASTER IS BUSY” (standard program; programmable) is displayed and operation is stopped. 12.1 Cause of Error 12.1.1 “IRC CONNECT ERR” a) b) Communication with the other station is not possible due to a connection error (cable cut, Master Terminal’s Power-OFF, etc.). Communication was made, but due to a text error, the other station cannot recognize it correctly. 12.1.2 “MASTER IS BUSY” Cannot access the inquiring file due to the following causes: a) The Master Terminal is receiving DLL data from the PC. b) Programming operations are under way on the Master Terminal. c) Backup data updating process is under way. d) Read/Reset Report taking operation is under way on the Master Terminal. (inapplicable to a system with the CVS spec. selected) e) ULL operations are under way on the Master Terminal. f) In a system with the CVS spec. selected, copy of the relevant table into the communication buffer area is under way on the Master Terminal. 12.2 Error Display IRC CONNECT ERR < 16-digit Dot Windows > I R C C O N N E C T E R 0 1 Terminal ID of the other station MASTER IS BUSY < 16-digit Dot Windows > M NOTE: A S T E R I S B U S Y The display contents in the 7-segment portion remains the same as before the error occurrence. The error status will be canceled by the [C] key. 12- 1 12. TRANSMISSION ERROR EO1-11152 12.3 Error Canceling Process 12.3 Error Canceling Process There are two error-canceling processes in accordance with the inquiring job contents. Type 1: Depressing the [C] key will return to the statuses before the inquiry. Applicable Jobs: • PLU Inquiry • PLU Urgent Maintenance • Customer File (Check Track) Inquiry • Credit Card No. Inquiry to the Negative Check File • Cashier Occupy Inquiry Type 2: Depressing the [C] key will cancel the error status, displays the following message, and waits for RETRY or CANCEL. Applicable Jobs: • PLU Affect • Customer File Affect • Cashier Affect • Cashier Cancel Inquiry • Transaction Data Send < 16-digit Dot Windows > R E T R Y ? For Retry ................. [AT/TL] (Performs re-sending to the other station.) For Cancel .............. [@/FOR] → [ST] (Stops the inquiry, printing on journal “ ** X → ST ** “) NOTE: The “Cancel” in Type 2 above is for only the case the other station is in trouble which cannot be recovered by a Retry operation. 12- 2 13. OTHER OPERATIONS RELATING TO IN-LINE SERVICE EO1-11152 13.1 Time Out 13. OTHER OPERATIONS RELATING TO IN-LINE SERVICE The followings are other operations relating to in-line service operations. 13.1 Time Out A Time-Out condition arises when the Master Terminal is making an in-line service operation, such as X/Z report collection, DLL, etc. to the Satellite Terminals. The service timer is provided for servicing each of the Satellite Terminals, thus on exceeding the time limit, a Time-Out condition will occur. In this case, a “RETRY”, “SUSPENDING”, “INCOMPLETE ENDING”, or “CANCEL” operation will be accepted. ex. 1) In a system with a Master Terminal and 3 Satellite Terminals: Master Terminal Busy S1 Busy S2 S3 When a report collection is executed on the Master Terminal, a series of data collections from each terminal (S1 to S3) will be performed, but services for S1 and S2 will be skipped due to their “busy” conditions. Thereafter, services will again be attempted to S1 and S2. As a limit of 30 seconds is provided for servicing each terminal, the total service time in this case will be 30 sec. x 2 units = 60 sec. If data collection is successfully done from S1 within this time limit, servicing S2 follows for the rest of the time, and on reaching the time limit, the Time-Out condition arises, displaying on the Master Terminal the number of not-yet collected terminal(s) and the Store/Register No. of the last serviced terminal. On this stage, the operator may only go on to “SUSPENDING” (to wait for a while until S2 clears the “busy” condition), or to “RETRY” (to execute collection service to S2 again, expecting that S2 has already cleared the “busy” condition), or to “INCOMPLETE ENDING” (to abandon the service to S2 and end with collection of the data of so-far collected terminals only), or to “CANCEL” operation. If “RETRY” is operated, the service time now is 30 seconds because only one terminal remains uncollected. ex. 2) Master Terminal Busy S1 No response (Power OFF) S2 S3 In this case, S2 is in a “No response” condition and S1 is in a “busy” condition. As only one terminal is responding with some kind of status, a time out limit of 30 seconds is given (the “No response” status is not subject to the service timer). However, if S2 turns into a “Power ON” condition, it will also be subject to the service timer. 13- 1 13. OTHER OPERATIONS RELATING TO IN-LINE SERVICE EO1-11152 13.2 Suspending 13.2 Suspending This is to be operated for the purpose of suspending an in-line service being executed, when any terminals remain unserviced, and of going on to a “RETRY”, “INCOMPLETE ENDING”, or “CANCEL” operation as the next step. OPERATION ON MASTER TERMINAL: (Same Lock positions as the in-line job being performed) Depress [ITEM CORR] until the key-in tone is generated. DESCRIPTION: The SUSPENDING operation is allowed any time during an in-line service procedure. If suspending by the [ITEM CORR] key is accepted, the Master Terminal’s display indicates the number of unserviced terminals. (SUSPENDING of a service execution of one terminal is not possible). Now a “RETRY” or “INCOMPLETE ENDING” operation can be selected as the next step. (When no key-in operations are made in about 10 seconds after a SUSPENDING operation, a RETRY process will automatically be executed.) 13.3 Retry This is to be operated for the purpose of re-attempting the in-line service that has been stopped due to “TIME OUT” or that has just been suspended by “SUSPENDING” operation. OPERATION ON MASTER TERMINAL: (Same Lock positions as the in-line job being performed) Depress [AT/TL]. DESCRIPTION: The in-line service will again be attempted to the unserviced terminals. This operation is possible any number of times after a “TIME OUT” condition or a “SUSPENDING” operation as long as any terminals remain unserviced. (When no key-in operations are made in about 10 seconds after a SUSPENDING operation, a RETRY process will automatically be executed.) 13.4 Incomplete Ending This is to be operated to abandon services to unserviced terminals, and ends the in-line service with the services to service-completed terminals only. OPERATION ON MASTER TERMINAL: (Same Lock positions as the in-line job being performed) Depress [NS]. DESCRIPTION: If an in-line service being executed does not seem to end normally due perhaps to some abnormal status of any Satellite Terminals after “TIME OUT”, “SUSPENDING”, and/or “RETRY” operations, the [NS] key can be depressed to end the in-line service with only the service-completed terminals serviced and the unserviced terminals remaining unserviced. In case of In-line X or Z Report Collection sequences, reports of only the service-completed terminals will be issued. As part of the print out, the Store/Register No. of the terminal and its status will be printed. 13- 2 13. OTHER OPERATIONS RELATING TO IN-LINE SERVICE EO1-11152 13.5 Cancel Status Print Format 1R QQQQQQ " Store/Register No. Status Symbol ?: No response (power off, etc.) BUSY: The terminal is busy (during a sale, etc.) Blank: Other statuses 13.5 Cancel This can be operated when a SUSPENDING condition arises due to a TIME OUT or a SUSPENDING operation. The entire in-line service being performed is cancelled. This operation is effective to in-line read report operations but not to any in-line reset report operations. OPERATION ON MASTER TERMINAL: (Mode Lock: X) Depress [@/FOR]. DESCRIPTION: The CANCEL symbol is printed as in the following. CANCEL Print Format 13- 3 E PRINTED IN MALAYSIA EO1-11152D
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.6 Linearized : No Page Mode : UseOutlines XMP Toolkit : 3.1-702 Create Date : 2005:07:18 14:02:12Z Creator Tool : PSCRIPT.DRV Version 4.0 Modify Date : 2005:11:22 15:42:46-05:00 Metadata Date : 2005:11:22 15:42:46-05:00 Producer : Acrobat Distiller 3.01 for Windows Keywords : MA-1595-1 Series "Owner's Manual" (EO1-11152D) (ma1595om) November 2005 Format : application/pdf Title : MA-1595-1 Series "Owner's Manual" (EO1-11152D) (ma1595om) November 2005 Description : MA-1595-1 Series "Owner's Manual" (EO1-11152D) (ma1595om) November 2005 Creator : Toshiba TEC Subject : MA-1595-1 Series "Owner's Manual" (EO1-11152D) (ma1595om) November 2005 Document ID : uuid:9dbbdb4d-f67b-48d3-8701-ae104366c200 Instance ID : uuid:00cf5d08-4dfc-4caf-8da8-a5d47085dffb Has XFA : No Page Count : 236 Page Layout : SinglePage Author : Toshiba TECEXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools